CYPRESS CY8C20X34_08

PSoC CY8C20x34 TRM
PSoC® CY8C20x34
PSoC® CY8C20x24
Technical Reference Manual (TRM)
Document No. 001-13033 Rev. *A
Cypress Semiconductor
198 Champion Court
San Jose, CA 95134-1709
Phone (USA): 800.858.1810
Phone (Intnl): 408.943.2600
http://www.cypress.com
[+] Feedback
Copyrights
Copyrights
Copyright © 2006-2008 Cypress Semiconductor Corporation. All rights reserved.
PSoC® is a registered trademark and CapSense™, PSoC Designer™, Programmable System-on-Chip™, and PSoC
Express™ are trademarks of Cypress Semiconductor Corporation (Cypress), along with Cypress® and Cypress Semiconductor™. All other trademarks or registered trademarks referenced herein are the property of their respective owners.
The information in this document is subject to change without notice and should not be construed as a commitment by
Cypress. While reasonable precautions have been taken, Cypress assumes no responsibility for any errors that may appear
in this document. No part of this document may be copied or reproduced in any form or by any means without the prior written
consent of Cypress. Made in the U.S.A.
Disclaimer
Any Source Code (software and/or firmware) is owned by Cypress Semiconductor Corporation (Cypress) and is protected by
and subject to worldwide patent protection (United States and foreign), United States copyright laws and international treaty
provisions. Cypress hereby grants to licensee a personal, non-exclusive, non-transferable license to copy, use, modify, create
derivative works of, and compile the Cypress Source Code and derivative works for the sole purpose of creating custom software and or firmware in support of licensee product to be used only in conjunction with a Cypress integrated circuit as specified in the applicable agreement. Any reproduction, modification, translation, compilation, or representation of this Source
Code except as specified above is prohibited without the express written permission of Cypress.
Disclaimer: CYPRESS MAKES NO WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WITH REGARD TO THIS MATERIAL, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Cypress reserves the right to make changes without further notice to the materials described
herein. Cypress does not assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit described herein.
Cypress does not authorize its products for use as critical components in life-support systems where a malfunction or failure
may reasonably be expected to result in significant injury to the user. The inclusion of Cypress’ product in a life-support systems application implies that the manufacturer assumes all risk of such use and in doing so indemnifies Cypress against all
charges.
PSoC Device and User Module Data Sheets contain performance specifications and characterizations for critical parameters.
Cypress Semiconductor does not recommend that you use unspecified or uncharacterized functions. If you need a device
feature that is not completely specified or characterized, contact the Cypress PSoC Marketing organization through the support web site at http://www.cypress.com/support
Use may be limited by and subject to the applicable Cypress software license agreement.
Flash Code Protection
Note the following details of the Flash code protection features on Cypress devices.
Cypress products meet the specifications contained in their particular Cypress Data Sheets. Cypress believes that its family of
products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, regardless of how they are used. There may be
methods, unknown to Cypress, that can breach the code protection features. Any of these methods, to our knowledge, would
be dishonest and possibly illegal. Neither Cypress nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of
their code. Code protection does not mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.”
Cypress is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code. Code protection is constantly
evolving. We at Cypress are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our products.
2
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Contents Overview
Section A: Overview
1.
Section B: PSoC Core
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
13
Pin Information .................................................................................................................... 19
23
CPU Core (M8C) ................................................................................................................. 25
RAM Paging ........................................................................................................................ 31
Supervisory ROM (SROM) ................................................................................................... 37
Interrupt Controller .............................................................................................................. 45
General Purpose IO (GPIO) ................................................................................................. 51
Internal Main Oscillator (IMO) .............................................................................................. 57
Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO) ..................................................................................... 59
Sleep and Watchdog ........................................................................................................... 61
Section C: CapSense System
69
10. CapSense Module ............................................................................................................... 71
11. IO Analog Multiplexer .......................................................................................................... 81
12. Comparators ....................................................................................................................... 83
Section D: System Resources
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
87
Digital Clocks ...................................................................................................................... 89
I2C Slave ........................................................................................................................... 95
Internal Voltage References .............................................................................................. 105
System Resets .................................................................................................................. 107
POR and LVD .................................................................................................................... 113
Serial Peripheral Interface ................................................................................................. 115
Programmable Timer ......................................................................................................... 129
Section E: Registers
133
20. Register Reference ........................................................................................................... 137
Section F: Glossary
195
Index
211
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
3
[+] Feedback
Contents Overview
4
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Contents
Section A: Overview
13
Document Organization ......................................................................................................................13
Top-Level Architecture .........................................................................................................................14
PSoC Core ..............................................................................................................................14
CapSense System ..................................................................................................................14
System Resources ..................................................................................................................14
Getting Started ....................................................................................................................................16
Support ...................................................................................................................................16
Product Upgrades ...................................................................................................................16
Development Kits ...................................................................................................................16
Document History ................................................................................................................................16
Documentation Conventions ..............................................................................................................17
Register Conventions ............................................................................................................17
Numeric Naming ....................................................................................................................17
Units of Measure ..................................................................................................................17
Acronyms ...............................................................................................................................18
1.
Pin Information .................................................................................................................. 19
1.1
Pinouts ...................................................................................................................................19
1.1.1
16-Pin Part Pinout..................................................................................................19
1.1.2
24-Pin Part Pinout ................................................................................................20
1.1.3
32-Pin Part Pinout .................................................................................................21
1.1.4
48-Pin OCD Part Pinout ........................................................................................22
Section B: PSoC Core
23
Top Level Core Architecture ................................................................................................................23
Core Register Summary ......................................................................................................................24
2.
CPU Core (M8C) ................................................................................................................. 25
2.1
Overview ..................................................................................................................................25
2.2
Internal Registers ..................................................................................................................25
2.3
Address Spaces .....................................................................................................................25
2.4
Instruction Set Summary..........................................................................................................26
2.5
Instruction Formats ................................................................................................................28
2.5.1
One-Byte Instructions ............................................................................................28
2.5.2
Two-Byte Instructions.............................................................................................28
2.5.3
Three-Byte Instructions..........................................................................................29
2.6
Register Definitions .................................................................................................................30
2.6.1
CPU_F Register ....................................................................................................30
2.6.2
Related Registers ..................................................................................................30
3.
RAM Paging ....................................................................................................................... 31
3.1
Architectural Description .........................................................................................................31
3.1.1
Basic Paging .........................................................................................................31
3.1.2
Stack Operations ...................................................................................................32
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
5
[+] Feedback
Contents
3.2
6
3.1.3
Interrupts ...............................................................................................................32
3.1.4
MVI Instructions .................................................................................................... 32
3.1.5
Current Page Pointer ............................................................................................ 32
3.1.6
Index Memory Page Pointer ................................................................................. 33
Register Definitions ................................................................................................................. 34
3.2.1
CUR_PP Register ................................................................................................. 34
3.2.2
STK_PP Register ................................................................................................. 34
3.2.3
IDX_PP Register .................................................................................................. 35
3.2.4
MVR_PP Register ................................................................................................ 35
3.2.5
MVW_PP Register ................................................................................................ 36
3.2.6
Related Registers .................................................................................................. 36
4.
Supervisory ROM (SROM) ................................................................................................. 37
4.1
Architectural Description ......................................................................................................... 37
4.1.1
Additional SROM Feature...................................................................................... 38
4.1.2
SROM Function Descriptions ............................................................................... 38
4.1.2.1
SWBootReset Function ....................................................................... 38
4.1.2.2
HWBootReset Function ....................................................................... 39
4.1.2.3
ReadBlock Function ............................................................................ 39
4.1.2.4
WriteBlock Function............................................................................. 40
4.1.2.5
EraseBlock Function............................................................................ 40
4.1.2.6
ProtectBlock Function.......................................................................... 40
4.1.2.7
TableRead Function ........................................................................... 41
4.1.2.8
EraseAll Function ................................................................................ 41
4.1.2.9
Checksum Function............................................................................. 41
4.1.2.10 Calibrate0 Function ............................................................................. 41
4.1.2.11 Calibrate1 Function ............................................................................. 42
4.1.2.12 WriteAndVerify Function...................................................................... 42
4.2
Register Definitions ................................................................................................................ 42
4.2.1
Related Registers .................................................................................................. 42
4.3
Clocking Strategy..................................................................................................................... 42
4.3.1
DELAY Parameter ................................................................................................. 42
4.3.2
CLOCK Parameter ................................................................................................ 43
5.
Interrupt Controller ........................................................................................................... 45
5.1
Architectural Description.......................................................................................................... 45
5.1.1
Posted versus Pending Interrupts.......................................................................... 46
5.2
Application Overview ............................................................................................................... 47
5.3
Register Definitions ................................................................................................................. 48
5.3.1
INT_CLR0 Registers ............................................................................................ 48
5.3.2
INT_MSK0 Register ..............................................................................................49
5.3.3
INT_SW_EN Register ........................................................................................... 49
5.3.4
INT_VC Register .................................................................................................. 50
5.3.5
Related Registers .................................................................................................. 50
6.
General Purpose IO (GPIO) ............................................................................................... 51
6.1
Architectural Description.......................................................................................................... 51
6.1.1
General Description ............................................................................................... 51
6.1.2
Digital IO ...............................................................................................................52
6.1.3
Analog and Digital Inputs ...................................................................................... 52
6.1.4
Port 1 Distinctions.................................................................................................. 52
6.1.5
GPIO Block Interrupts .......................................................................................... 52
6.1.5.1
Interrupt Modes ................................................................................... 54
6.1.6
Data Bypass .......................................................................................................... 54
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Contents
6.2
Register Definitions .................................................................................................................55
6.2.1
PRTxDR Registers ................................................................................................55
6.2.2
PRTxIE Registers .................................................................................................55
6.2.3
PRTxDMx Registers .............................................................................................56
6.2.4
IO_CFG Register ..................................................................................................56
7.
Internal Main Oscillator (IMO) ........................................................................................... 57
7.1
Architectural Description ..........................................................................................................57
7.2
Application Overview ...............................................................................................................57
7.2.1
Trimming the IMO ..................................................................................................57
7.2.2
Engaging Slow IMO ...............................................................................................57
7.3
Register Definitions .................................................................................................................58
7.3.1
IMO_TR Register ..................................................................................................58
7.3.2
Related Registers ..................................................................................................58
8.
Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO) .................................................................................. 59
8.1
Architectural Description ..........................................................................................................59
8.2
Register Definitions .................................................................................................................59
8.2.1
ILO_TR Register ...................................................................................................59
9.
Sleep and Watchdog.......................................................................................................... 61
9.1
Architectural Description ..........................................................................................................61
9.1.1
Sleep Timer .........................................................................................................61
9.2
Application Overview ...............................................................................................................62
9.3
Register Definitions .................................................................................................................63
9.3.1
RES_WDT Register ..............................................................................................63
9.3.2
SLP_CFG Register ...............................................................................................63
9.3.3
Related Registers ..................................................................................................63
9.4
Timing Diagrams ......................................................................................................................64
9.4.1
Sleep Sequence.....................................................................................................64
9.4.2
Wakeup Sequence.................................................................................................65
9.4.3
Bandgap Refresh ...................................................................................................66
9.4.4
Watchdog Timer.....................................................................................................66
9.5
Power Modes ...........................................................................................................................67
Section C: CapSense System
69
Top Level CapSense Architecture .......................................................................................................69
CapSense Register Summary .............................................................................................................70
10. CapSense Module .............................................................................................................. 71
10.1
Architectural Description ..........................................................................................................71
10.1.1
Types of CapSense Approaches ...........................................................................71
10.1.1.1 Relaxation Oscillator............................................................................71
10.1.1.2 IDAC ....................................................................................................72
10.1.2
CapSense Counter ................................................................................................72
10.1.3
Timer ......................................................................................................................73
10.1.3.1 Operation .............................................................................................73
10.2
Register Definitions .................................................................................................................74
10.2.1
CS_CR0 Register .................................................................................................74
10.2.2
CS_CR1 Register .................................................................................................75
10.2.3
CS_CR2 Register .................................................................................................75
10.2.4
CS_CR3 Register .................................................................................................76
10.2.5
CS_CNTL Register ...............................................................................................76
10.2.6
CS_CNTH Register ...............................................................................................76
10.2.7
CS_STAT Register ................................................................................................77
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
7
[+] Feedback
Contents
10.3
10.2.8
CS_TIMER Register ............................................................................................. 77
10.2.9
CS_SLEW Register ..............................................................................................78
10.2.10
IDAC_D Register .................................................................................................. 78
Timing Diagrams...................................................................................................................... 79
11. IO Analog Multiplexer ....................................................................................................... 81
11.1
Architectural Description ......................................................................................................... 81
11.2
Application Overview ............................................................................................................... 81
11.3
Register Definitions ................................................................................................................. 82
11.3.1
AMUX_CFG Register ........................................................................................... 82
11.3.2
MUX_CRx Registers ............................................................................................ 82
12. Comparators ..................................................................................................................... 83
12.1
Architectural Description ......................................................................................................... 83
12.2
Register Definitions ................................................................................................................. 84
12.2.1
CMP_RDC Register ............................................................................................. 84
12.2.2
CMP_MUX Register ............................................................................................. 85
12.2.3
CMP_CR0 Register ..............................................................................................85
12.2.4
CMP_CR1 Register ..............................................................................................86
12.2.5
CMP_LUT Register ..............................................................................................86
Section D: System Resources
87
Top Level System Resources Architecture .......................................................................................... 87
System Resources Register Summary ................................................................................................ 88
13. Digital Clocks .................................................................................................................... 89
13.1
Architectural Description.......................................................................................................... 89
13.1.1
Internal Main Oscillator ......................................................................................... 89
13.1.2
Internal Low Speed Oscillator ............................................................................... 89
13.1.3
External Clock ...................................................................................................... 90
13.1.3.1 Switch Operation ................................................................................. 90
13.2
Register Definitions ................................................................................................................. 92
13.2.1
OUT_P1 Register ................................................................................................. 92
13.2.2
OSC_CR0 Register ............................................................................................ 93
13.2.3
OSC_CR2 Register ............................................................................................ 94
13.2.4
Related Registers .................................................................................................. 94
14. I2C Slave .......................................................................................................................... 95
14.1
Architectural Description.......................................................................................................... 95
14.1.1
Basic I2C Data Transfer ........................................................................................ 96
14.2
Application Overview ............................................................................................................... 96
14.2.1
Slave Operation .................................................................................................... 96
14.3
Register Definitions ................................................................................................................. 98
14.3.1
I2C_CFG Register ................................................................................................ 98
14.3.2
I2C_SCR Register ................................................................................................ 99
14.3.3
I2C_DR Register ................................................................................................101
14.4
Timing Diagrams....................................................................................................................101
14.4.1
Clock Generation .................................................................................................101
14.4.2
Basic IO Timing ...................................................................................................102
14.4.3
Status Timing .......................................................................................................102
14.4.4
Slave Stall Timing ...............................................................................................103
8
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Contents
15. Internal Voltage References ............................................................................................ 105
15.1
Architectural Description ........................................................................................................105
15.2
Register Definitions ...............................................................................................................106
15.2.1
BDG_TR Register ...............................................................................................106
16. System Resets ................................................................................................................. 107
16.1
Architectural Description ........................................................................................................107
16.2
Pin Behavior During Reset.....................................................................................................107
16.2.1
GPIO Behavior on Power Up ...............................................................................107
16.2.2
GPIO Behavior on External Reset .......................................................................108
16.3
Register Definitions ...............................................................................................................108
16.3.1
CPU_SCR1 Register ..........................................................................................108
16.3.2
CPU_SCR0 Register ..........................................................................................109
16.4
Timing Diagrams ...................................................................................................................110
16.4.1
Power On Reset ..................................................................................................110
16.4.2
External Reset ....................................................................................................110
16.4.3
Watchdog Timer Reset .......................................................................................110
16.4.4
Reset Details........................................................................................................112
16.5
Power Modes ........................................................................................................................112
17. POR and LVD ................................................................................................................... 113
17.1
Architectural Description ........................................................................................................113
17.2
Register Definitions ...............................................................................................................113
17.2.1
VLT_CR Register ................................................................................................113
17.2.2
VLT_CMP Register .............................................................................................114
18. Serial Peripheral Interface .............................................................................................. 115
18.1
Architectural Description ........................................................................................................115
18.1.1
SPI Protocol Function .........................................................................................115
18.1.1.1 SPI Protocol Signal Definitions ..........................................................116
18.1.2
SPI Master Function ...........................................................................................116
18.1.2.1 Usability Exceptions...........................................................................116
18.1.2.2 Block Interrupt....................................................................................116
18.1.3
SPI Slave Function .............................................................................................116
18.1.3.1 Usability Exceptions...........................................................................117
18.1.3.2 Block Interrupt....................................................................................117
18.1.4
Input Synchronization ..........................................................................................117
18.2
Register Definitions ...............................................................................................................117
18.2.1
SPI_TXR Register ...............................................................................................117
18.2.2
SPI_RXR Register ..............................................................................................117
18.2.2.1 SPI Master Data Register Definitions ................................................118
18.2.2.2 SPI Slave Data Register Definitions ..................................................118
18.2.3
SPI_CR Register .................................................................................................119
18.2.3.1 SPI Control Register Definitions ........................................................119
18.2.4
SPI_CFG Register ..............................................................................................120
18.2.4.1 SPI Configuration Register Definitions ..............................................120
18.3
Timing Diagrams ....................................................................................................................121
18.3.1
SPI Mode Timing .................................................................................................121
18.3.2
SPIM Timing ........................................................................................................122
18.3.3
SPIS Timing .........................................................................................................125
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
9
[+] Feedback
Contents
19. Programmable Timer....................................................................................................... 129
19.1
Architectural Description........................................................................................................129
19.1.1
Operation .............................................................................................................130
19.2
Register Definitions ...............................................................................................................131
19.2.1
PT_CFG Register ...............................................................................................131
19.2.2
PT_DATA1 Register ............................................................................................131
19.2.3
PT_DATA0 Register ............................................................................................131
Section E:
Registers
133
Register General Conventions ...........................................................................................................133
Register Mapping Tables ...................................................................................................................133
Register Map Bank 0 Table: User Space ............................................................................134
Register Map Bank 1 Table: Configuration Space .............................................................135
20. Register Reference ......................................................................................................... 137
20.1
Maneuvering Around the Registers .......................................................................................137
20.2
Register Conventions ..........................................................................................................137
20.3
Bank 0 Registers ..................................................................................................................138
20.3.1
PRTxDR .............................................................................................................138
20.3.2
PRTxIE ...............................................................................................................139
20.3.3
SPI_TXR .............................................................................................................140
20.3.4
SPI_RXR ............................................................................................................141
20.3.5
SPI_CR ...............................................................................................................142
20.3.6
AMUX_CFG ........................................................................................................143
20.3.7
CMP_RDC ..........................................................................................................144
20.3.8
CMP_MUX ..........................................................................................................145
20.3.9
CMP_CR0 ..........................................................................................................146
20.3.10
CMP_CR1 ..........................................................................................................147
20.3.11
CMP_LUT ...........................................................................................................149
20.3.12
CS_CR0 .............................................................................................................150
20.3.13
CS_CR1 .............................................................................................................151
20.3.14
CS_CR2 .............................................................................................................152
20.3.15
CS_CR3 .............................................................................................................153
20.3.16
CS_CNTL ...........................................................................................................154
20.3.17
CS_CNTH ...........................................................................................................155
20.3.18
CS_STAT ...........................................................................................................156
20.3.19
CS_TIMER .........................................................................................................157
20.3.20
CS_SLEW ..........................................................................................................158
20.3.21
PT_CFG .............................................................................................................159
20.3.22
PT_DATA1 .........................................................................................................160
20.3.23
PT_DATA0 .........................................................................................................161
20.3.24
CUR_PP .............................................................................................................162
20.3.25
STK_PP ..............................................................................................................163
20.3.26
IDX_PP ...............................................................................................................164
20.3.27
MVR_PP .............................................................................................................165
20.3.28
MVW_PP ............................................................................................................166
20.3.29
I2C_CFG ............................................................................................................167
20.3.30
I2C_SCR ............................................................................................................168
20.3.31
I2C_DR ...............................................................................................................169
20.3.32
INT_CLR0 ...........................................................................................................170
20.3.33
INT_MSK0 ..........................................................................................................172
20.3.34
INT_SW_EN .......................................................................................................173
20.3.35
INT_VC ...............................................................................................................174
10
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Contents
20.4
Section F:
20.3.36
RES_WDT ..........................................................................................................175
20.3.37
CPU_F ................................................................................................................176
20.3.38
IDAC_D ...............................................................................................................177
20.3.39
CPU_SCR1 .........................................................................................................178
20.3.40
CPU_SCR0 .........................................................................................................179
Bank 1 Registers ...................................................................................................................180
20.4.1
PRTxDM0 ...........................................................................................................180
20.4.2
PRTxDM1 ...........................................................................................................181
20.4.3
SPI_CFG .............................................................................................................182
20.4.4
MUX_CRx ...........................................................................................................183
20.4.5
IO_CFG ...............................................................................................................184
20.4.6
OUT_P1 ..............................................................................................................185
20.4.7
OSC_CR0 ...........................................................................................................186
20.4.8
OSC_CR2 ...........................................................................................................187
20.4.9
VLT_CR ..............................................................................................................188
20.4.10
VLT_CMP ...........................................................................................................189
20.4.11
IMO_TR ..............................................................................................................190
20.4.12
ILO_TR ...............................................................................................................191
20.4.13
BDG_TR .............................................................................................................192
20.4.14
SLP_CFG ............................................................................................................193
Glossary
Index
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
195
211
11
[+] Feedback
Contents
12
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section A: Overview
The PSoC® family consists of many Mixed-Signal Array with On-Chip Controller devices. As described in this Technical Reference Manual (TRM), the CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device does not have regular digital PSoC blocks and global interconnects
that are found in most PSoC devices. The CY8C20x34/24 devices have one analog resource and digital logic in addition to a
fast CPU, Flash program memory, and SRAM data memory to support various CapSense™ algorithms.
For the most up-to-date Ordering, Pinout, Packaging, or Electrical Specification information, refer to the PSoC device’s data
sheet. For the most current technical reference manual information, refer to the addendum. To obtain the newest product
documentation, go to the Cypress web site at http://www.cypress.com/psoc. This section contains this chapter:
■
Pin Information on page 19.
Document Organization
This manual is organized into sections and chapters, according to PSoC functionality. Each section contains a top-level architectural diagram and a register summary (if applicable). Most chapters within the sections have an introduction, an architectural/application description, register definitions, and timing diagrams. The sections are:
■
Overview – Presents the PSoC top-level architecture, helpful information to get started, and document history and conventions. The PSoC device pinouts are detailed in the Pin Information chapter.
■
PSoC Core – Describes the heart of the PSoC device in various chapters, beginning with an architectural overview and a
summary list of registers pertaining to the PSoC core.
■
CapSense System – Describes the configurable PSoC CapSense system in various chapters, beginning with an architectural overview and a summary list of registers pertaining to the CapSense system.
■
System Resources – Presents additional PSoC system resources, beginning with an overview and a summary list of
registers pertaining to system resources.
■
Registers – Lists all PSoC device registers in register mapping tables, and presents bit-level detail of each PSoC register
in its own Register Reference chapter. Where applicable, detailed register descriptions are located in each chapter.
■
Glossary – Defines the specialized terminology used in this manual. Glossary terms are presented in bold, italic font
throughout this manual.
■
Index – Lists the location of key topics and elements that constitute and empower the PSoC device.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
13
[+] Feedback
Section A: Overview
Top-Level Architecture
The PSoC block diagram on the next page illustrates the top-level architecture of the CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device. Each
major grouping in the diagram is covered in this manual in its own section: PSoC Core, CapSense System, and the System
Resources. Banding these three main areas together is the communication network of the system bus.
PSoC Core
CapSense System
The PSoC Core is a powerful engine that supports a rich
instruction set. It encompasses the SRAM for data storage,
an interrupt controller for easy program execution to new
addresses, sleep and watchdog timers, a regulated 3.0V
output option is provided for Port 1 IOs, and multiple clock
sources that include the IMO (internal main oscillator) and
ILO (internal low speed oscillator) for precision, programmable clocking.
The CapSense System is composed of comparators, reference drivers, IO multiplexers, and digital logic to support
various capsensing algorithms. Various reference selections
are provided. Digital logic is mainly comprised of counters
and timers.
The CPU core, called the M8C, is a powerful processor with
speeds up to 12 MHz. The M8C is a two MIPS 8-bit Harvard
architecture microprocessor. Within the CPU core are the
SROM and Flash memory components that provide flexible
programming. The smallest PSoC devices have a slightly
different analog configuration.
PSoC GPIOs provide connection to the CPU and the
CapSense resources of the device. Each pin’s drive mode
may be selected from four options, allowing great flexibility
in external interfacing. Every pin also has the capability to
generate a system interrupt on low level and change from
last read.
14
System Resources
The System Resources provide additional PSoC capability.
These system resources include:
■
Digital clocks to increase the flexibility of the PSoC
mixed-signal arrays.
■
I2C functionality for implementing I2C slave.
■
Internal voltage references that provide an absolute
value of 0.9V, 1.3V, and 1.8V to the CapSense subsystems.
■
Various system resets supported by the M8C.
■
Power-On-Reset (POR) circuit protection.
■
SPI master and slave functionality.
■
A programmable timer to provide periodic interrupts.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section A: Overview
PSoC Top-Level Block Diagram
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
3V
LDO
Port 0
PSoC CORE
SYSTEM BUS
Global Analog Interconnect
Supervisory ROM (SROM)
SRAM
Flash Nonvolatile Memory
CPU Core (M8C)
Interrupt
Controller
6/12 MHz Internal Main Oscillator (IMO)
Sleep and
Watchdog
Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO)
Multiple Clock Sources
CAPSENSE
SYSTEM
Analog
Reference
CapSense Module
Analog
Mux
Comparators
SYSTEM BUS
Digital
Clocks
I2C
Slave
Internal
Voltage
References
System
Resets
POR and
LVD
SPI
Master/
Slave
Programmable
Timer
SYSTEM RESOURCES
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
15
[+] Feedback
Section A: Overview
Getting Started
The quickest path to understanding PSoC is by reading the PSoC device’s data sheet and using the PSoC Designer Integrated Development Environment (IDE). This manual is useful for understanding the details of the PSoC integrated circuit.
Important Note: For the most up-to-date Ordering, Packaging, or Electrical Specification information, refer to the individual
PSoC device’s data sheet or go to http://www.cypress.com/psoc.
Support
Free support for PSoC products is available online at http://www.cypress.com. Resources include Training Seminars, Discussion Forums, Application Notes, PSoC Consultants, TightLink Technical Support Email/Knowledge Base, and Application
Support Technicians.
Technical Support can be reached at http://www.cypress.com/support/.
Product Upgrades
Cypress provides scheduled upgrades and version enhancements for PSoC Designer free of charge. You can order the
upgrades from your distributor on CD-ROM or download them directly from http://www.cypress.com under Software and Drivers. Also provided are critical updates to system documentation under Design Support > Design Resources > More
Resources or go to http://www.cypress.com.
Development Kits
Development Kits are available from authorized distributors. The Cypress Online Store contains development kits, C compilers, and all accessories for PSoC development. Go to the Cypress Online Store web site at http://www.cypress.com, click the
Online Store shopping cart icon at the bottom of the web page, and click PSoC (Programmable System-on-Chip) to view a
current list of available items.
Document History
This section serves as a chronicle of the PSoC Mixed-Signal Array Technical Reference Manual.
PSoC Technical Reference Manual History
Version/
Release Date
Version 1.0
Originator
Description of Change
VED
First release of the PSoC CY8C20x34 Technical Reference Manual. This release encompasses the CY8C20x34 PSoC
device.
VED
Update values in Table 16-1.
DSG
Added CY8C20x24 parts, revised Table 4-11, corrected IMO Trim voltage ranges in Chapter 7
September 22, 2006
001-13033 Rev. **
April 24, 2007
001-13033, Rev. *A
February 19, 2008
16
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section A: Overview
Documentation Conventions
Units of Measure
There are only four distinguishing font types used in this
manual, besides those found in the headings.
This table lists the units of measure used in this manual.
■
The first is the use of italics when referencing a document title or file name.
■
■
■
Units of Measure
Symbol
Unit of Measure
The second is the use of bold italics when referencing a
term described in the Glossary of this manual.
dB
decibels
Hz
hertz
The third is the use of Times New Roman font, distinguishing equation examples.
k
kilo, 1000
K
210, 1024
The fourth is the use of Courier New font, distinguishing code examples.
KB
1024 bytes
Kbit
1024 bits
kHz
kilohertz (32.000)
MHz
megahertz
Register Conventions
This table lists the register conventions that are specific to
this manual. A more detailed set of register conventions is
located in the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
Register Conventions
Convention
Example
Description
microampere
μF
microfarad
μs
microsecond
μV
microvolts
mA
milliampere
ms
millisecond
mV
millivolts
‘x’ in a register
name
PRTxIE
R
R : 00
Read register or bit(s)
ns
nanosecond
W
W : 00
Write register or bit(s)
pF
picofarad
O
RO : 00
Only a read/write register or bit(s).
L
RL : 00
Logical register or bit(s)
C
RC : 00
Clearable register or bit(s)
00
RW : 00
Reset value is 0x00 or 00h
XX
RW : XX
Register is not reset
0,
0,04h
Register is in bank 0
1,
1,23h
Register is in bank 1
x,
x,F7h
Register exists in register bank 0 and register bank 1
Empty, grayedout table cell
Multiple instances/address ranges of the
same register
μA
ppm
V
parts per million
volts
Reserved bit or group of bits, unless otherwise stated
Numeric Naming
Hexadecimal numbers are represented with all letters in
uppercase with an appended lowercase ‘h’ (for example,
‘14h’ or ‘3Ah’) and hexadecimal numbers may also be represented by a ‘0x’ prefix, the C coding convention. Binary
numbers have an appended lowercase ‘b’ (for example,
01010100b’ or ‘01000011b’). Numbers not indicated by an
‘h’ or ‘b’ are decimal.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
17
[+] Feedback
Section A: Overview
Acronyms
Acronyms (continued)
This table lists the acronyms that are used in this manual.
Acronyms
Acronym
ABUS
AC
ADC
API
BC
BR
BRA
BRQ
CBUS
CI
CMP
CO
CPU
CRC
CT
DAC
DC
DI
DMA
DO
ECO
FB
GIE
GPIO
ICE
IDE
ILO
IMO
Description
analog output bus
alternating current
analog-to-digital converter
Application Programming Interface
broadcast clock
bit rate
bus request acknowledge
bus request
comparator bus
carry in
compare
carry out
central processing unit
cyclic redundancy check
continuous time
digital-to-analog converter
direct current
digital or data input
direct memory access
digital or data output
external crystal oscillator
feedback
global interrupt enable
general purpose IO
in-circuit emulator
integrated development environment
internal low speed oscillator
internal main oscillator
IO
input/output
IOR
IO read
IOW
IO write
IPOR
imprecise power on reset
IRQ
interrupt request
ISR
interrupt service routine
ISSP
in system serial programming
IVR
interrupt vector read
LFSR
linear feedback shift register
LRb
last received bit
LRB
last received byte
LSb
least significant bit
LSB
least significant byte
LUT
look-up table
MISO
master-in-slave-out
MOSI
master-out-slave-in
MSb
most significant bit
MSB
most significant byte
PC
program counter
PCH
program counter high
18
Acronym
Description
PCL
program counter low
PD
power down
PMA
PSoC™ memory arbiter
POR
power on reset
PPOR
precision power on reset
PRS
pseudo random sequence
PSoC™
Programmable System-on-Chip™
PSSDC
power system sleep duty cycle
PWM
pulse width modulator
RAM
random access memory
RETI
return from interrupt
RO
relaxation oscillator
ROM
read only memory
RW
read/write
SAR
successive approximation register
SC
switched capacitor
SIE
serial interface engine
SE0
single-ended zero
SOF
start of frame
SP
stack pointer
SPI
serial peripheral interconnect
SPIM
serial peripheral interconnect master
SPIS
serial peripheral interconnect slave
SRAM
static random access memory
SROM
supervisory read only memory
SSADC
single slope ADC
SSC
supervisory system call
TC
terminal count
USB
universal serial bus
WDT
watchdog timer
WDR
watchdog reset
XRES
external reset
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
1. Pin Information
This chapter lists, describes, and illustrates all pins and pinout configurations for the CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device. For up-todate ordering, pinout, and packaging information, refer to the individual PSoC device’s data sheet or go to
http://www.cypress.com/psoc.
1.1
Pinouts
The CY8C20x34/24 PSoC devices are available in a variety of packages. Every port pin (labeled with a “P”), except for Vss
and Vdd in the following tables and illustrations, is capable of Digital IO.
1.1.1
16-Pin Part Pinout
Table 1-1: 16-Pin Part Pinout (QFN**)
IO
I
P2[5]
2
IO
I
P2[1]
3
IO
I
P1[7]
I2C SCL, SPI SS
4
IO
I
P1[5]
I2C SDA, SPI MISO
5
IO
I
P1[3]
SPI CLK
6
IO
I
P1[1]
TC CLK, I2C SCL, SPI MOSI
7
IO
I
Vss
Ground Connection
8
IO
I
P1[0]
TC DATA, I2C SDA
9
IO
I
P1[2]
10
IO
I
P1[4]
EXTCLK
XRES
Active high external reset with internal pull down
11
Reset
12
IO
I
P0[4]
13
IO
I
Vdd
14
IO
I
P0[7]
15
IO
I
P0[3]
16
IO
I
P0[1]
Description
Supply Voltage
Integration Cap
CY8C20234, CY8C20224 PSoC Device
P0[1], AI
P0[3], AI
P0[7], AI
Vdd
1
Name
16
15
14
13
Analog
AI, P2[5] 1
12
AI, P2[1] 2 QFN 11
(Top View)
10
AI, I2C SCL, SPI SS, P1[7] 3
9
AI, I2C SDA, SPI MISO, P1[5] 4
5
6
7
8
Digital
P0[4], AI
XRES
P1[4], AI, EXT CLK
P1[2], AI
AI, SPI CLK, P1[3]
TC CLK, I2C SCL, SPI MOSI P1[1]
Vss
AI, TC DATA, I2C SDA, P1[0]
Type
Pin
No.
LEGEND A = Analog, I = Input, O = Output, H = 5 mA High Output Drive.
* These are the ISSP pins, which are not High Z at POR (Power On Reset).
** The center pad on the QFN package should be connected to ground (Vss)
for best mechanical, thermal, and electrical performance. If not connected to
ground, it should be electrically floated and not connected to any other signal.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
19
[+] Feedback
Pin Information
1.1.2
24-Pin Part Pinout
Table 1-2. 24-Pin Part Pinout (QFN**)
Digital
Analog
1
IO
I
P2[5]
2
IO
I
P2[3]
3
IO
I
P2[1]
4
IOH
I
P1[7]
I2C SCL, SPI SS
5
IOH
I
P1[5]
I2C SDA, SPI MISO
6
IOH
I
P1[3]
SPI CLK
7
IOH
I
P1[1]
CLK*, I2C SCL, SPI MOSI
NC
No connection
9
Power
Ground connection
DATA*, I2C SDA
IOH
I
P1[0]
11
IOH
I
P1[2]
12
IOH
I
P1[4]
13
IOH
I
P1[6]
Input
XRES
Optional external clock input (EXTCLK)
Active high external reset with internal pull down
15
IO
I
P2[0]
16
IO
I
P0[0]
17
IO
I
P0[2]
18
IO
I
P0[4]
19
IO
I
P0[6]
Analog bypass
Vdd
Supply voltage
20
Power
21
IO
I
P0[7]
22
IO
I
P0[5]
23
IO
I
P0[3]
24
IO
I
P0[1]
CY8C20334, CY8C20324 PSoC Device
24
23
22
21
20
19
P0[1], AI
P0[3], AI
P0[5], AI
P0[7], AI
Vdd
P0[6], AI
Vss
10
14
Description
AI, P2[5]
AI, P2[3]
AI, P2[1]
AI, I2C SCL, SPI SS, P1[7]
AI, I2C SDA, SPI MISO, P1[5]
AI, SPI CLK, P1[3]
1
2
3
4
5
6
18
17
QFN 16
(Top View) 15
14
13
7
8
9
10
11
12
8
Name
P0[4], AI
P0[2], AI
P0[0], AI
P2[0], AI
XRES
P1[6], AI
AI, CLK*, I2C SCL, SPI MOSI, P1[1]
NC
Vss
AI, DATA*, I2C SDA, P1[0]
AI, P1[2]
AI, EXTCLK, P1[4]
Type
Pin
No.
Integrating input
LEGEND A = Analog, I = Input, O = Output, H = 5 mA High Output Drive.
* These are the ISSP pins, which are not High Z at POR (Power On Reset).
** The center pad on the QFN package should be connected to ground (Vss)
for best mechanical, thermal, and electrical performance. If not connected to
ground, it should be electrically floated and not connected to any other signal.
20
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Pin Information
1.1.3
32-Pin Part Pinout
Table 1-3. 32-Pin Part Pinout (QFN**)
Digital
Analog
1
IO
I
P0[1]
2
IO
I
P2[7]
3
IO
I
P2[5]
4
IO
I
P2[3]
5
IO
I
P2[1]
6
IO
I
P3[3]
7
IO
I
P3[1]
8
IOH
I
P1[7]
I2C SCL, SPI SS
9
IOH
I
P1[5]
I2C SDA, SPI MISO
10
IOH
I
P1[3]
SPI CLK
11
IOH
I
P1[1]
CLK*, I2C SCL, SPI MOSI
Power
Vss
Ground connection
13
IOH
I
P1[0]
DATA*, I2C SDA
14
IOH
I
P1[2]
15
IOH
I
P1[4]
16
IOH
I
P1[6]
17
Input
XRES
Optional external clock input (EXTCLK)
Active high external reset with internal
pull down
18
IO
I
P3[0]
19
IO
I
P3[2]
20
IO
I
P2[0]
21
IO
I
P2[2]
22
IO
I
P2[4]
23
IO
I
P2[6]
24
IO
I
P0[0]
25
IO
I
P0[2]
26
IO
I
P0[4]
27
IO
I
P0[6]
Analog bypass
Vdd
Supply voltage
28
Power
29
IO
I
P0[7]
30
IO
I
P0[5]
31
IO
I
P0[3]
Integrating input
Vss
Ground connection
32
Power
CY8C20434, CY8C20424 PSoC Device
AI, P0[1]
AI, P2[7]
AI, P2[5]
AI, P2[3]
AI, P2[1]
AI, P3[3]
AI, P3[1]
AI, I2C SCL, SPI SS, P1[7]
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Vss
P0[3], AI
P0[5], AI
P0[7], AI
Vdd
P0[6], AI
P0[4], AI
P0[2], AI
Description
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
QFN
(Top View)
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
12
Name
P0[0], AI
P2[6], AI
P2[4], AI
P2[2], AI
P2[0], AI
P3[2], AI
P3[0], AI
XRES
AI, I2C SDA, SPI MISO, P1[5]
AI, SPI CLK, P1[3]
AI, CLK*, I2C SCL, SPI MOSI, P1[1]
Vss
AI, DATA*, I2C SDA, P1[0]
AI, P1[2]
AI, EXTCLK, P1[4]
AI, P1[6]
Type
Pin
No.
LEGEND A = Analog, I = Input, O = Output, H = 5 mA High Output Drive.
* These are the ISSP pins, which are not High Z at POR (Power
On Reset).
** The center pad on the QFN package should be connected to
ground (Vss) for best mechanical, thermal, and electrical performance. If not connected to ground, it should be electrically
floated and not connected to any other signal.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
21
[+] Feedback
Pin Information
1.1.4
48-Pin OCD Part Pinout
Table 1-4. 48-Pin OCD Part Pinout (QFN**)
Digital
Analog
CY8C20000 OCD PSoC Device
2
IO
I
P0[1]
3
IO
I
P2[7]
4
IO
I
P2[5]
5
IO
I
P2[3]
6
IO
I
P2[1]
7
IO
I
P3[3]
8
IO
I
P3[1]
9
IOH
I
P1[7]
I2C SCL, SPI SS
10
IOH
I
I2C SDA, SPI MISO
NC
No internal connection
12
NC
No internal connection
13
NC
No internal connection
14
NC
No internal connection
15
IOH
I
P1[3]
SPI CLK
16
IOH
I
P1[1]
CLK*, I2C SCL, SPI MOSI
17
Power
18
19
Vss
Ground connection
CCLK
OCD CPU clock output
HCLK
OCD high speed clock output
20
IOH
I
P1[0]
DATA*, I2C SDA
21
IOH
I
P1[2]
22
NC
No internal connection
23
NC
No internal connection
24
NC
No internal connection
Optional external clock input (EXTCLK)
25
IOH
I
P1[4]
26
IOH
I
P1[6]
27
Input
XRES
28
IO
I
P3[0]
29
IO
I
P3[2]
30
IO
I
P2[0]
31
IO
I
P2[2]
32
IO
I
P2[4]
NC
Vss
P0[3], AI
P0[5], AI
P0[7], AI
OCDE
OCDO
Vdd
P0[6], AI
NC
NC
NC
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
1
2
3
4
5
6
OCD QFN
7
8
9
10
11
12
(Top View)
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
P1[5]
11
NC
AI, P0[1]
AI, P2[7]
AI, P2[5]
AI, P2[3]
AI, P2[1]
AI, P3[3]
AI, P3[1]
AI, I2C SCL, SPI SS, P1[7]
AI, I2C SDA, SPI MISO, P1[5]
NC
NC
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
No internal connection
Pin
No.
Power
Name
P2[0], AI
P3[2], AI
P3[0], AI
XRES
P1[6], AI
P1[4], EXTCLK, AI
Vdd
Description
IO
I
P2[6]
41
IO
I
P0[0]
42
OCDO
OCD even data IO
35
IO
I
P0[2]
43
OCDE
OCD odd data output
36
Supply voltage
IO
I
P0[4]
44
IO
I
P0[7]
37
NC
No internal connection
45
IO
I
P0[5]
38
NC
No internal connection
46
IO
I
P0[3]
Integrating input
39
NC
No internal connection
47
Vss
Ground connection
P0[6]
Analog bypass
48
NC
No internal connection
I
P0[0], AI
P2[6], AI
P2[4], AI
P2[2], AI
Active high external reset with internal
pull down
34
IO
P0[2], AI
NOT FOR PRODUCTION
33
40
P0[4], AI
NC
NC
AI, SPI CLK, P1[3]
AI, CLK*, I2C SCL, SPI MOSI, P1[1]
Vss
CCLK
HCLK
AI, DATA*, I2C SDA, P1[0]
AI, P1[2]
NC
NC
NC
NC
Description
Analog
1
Name
Digital
Pin
No.
Power
LEGEND A = Analog, I = Input, O = Output, NC = No Connection, H = 5 mA High Output Drive.
* ISSP pin which is not HiZ at POR.
** The center pad on the QFN package should be connected to ground (Vss) for best mechanical, thermal, and electrical performance. If not
connected to ground, it should be electrically floated and not connected to any other signal.
22
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section B: PSoC Core
The PSoC® Core section discusses the core components of a PSoC device with a base part number of CY8C20x34/24 and
the registers associated with those components. The core section covers the heart of the PSoC device, which includes the
M8C microcontroller; SROM, interrupt controller, GPIO, and SRAM paging; multiple clock sources such as IMO and ILO;
and sleep and watchdog functionality. This section contains these chapters:
■
CPU Core (M8C) on page 25.
■
General Purpose IO (GPIO) on page 51.
■
RAM Paging on page 31.
■
Internal Main Oscillator (IMO) on page 57.
■
Supervisory ROM (SROM) on page 37.
■
Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO) on page 59.
■
Interrupt Controller on page 45.
■
Sleep and Watchdog on page 61.
Top Level Core Architecture
The figure below illustrates the top-level architecture of the PSoC’s core. Each figure component is discussed in detail in this
section.
PSoC Core Block Diagram
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Port 0
3V
LDO
PSoC CORE
SYSTEM BUS
SRAM
Supervisory ROM (SROM)
Interrupt
Controller
Flash Nonvolatile Memory
CPU Core (M8C)
6/12 MHz Internal Main Oscillator (IMO)
Sleep and
Watchdog
Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO)
Multiple Clock Sources
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
23
[+] Feedback
Section B: PSoC Core
Core Register Summary
This table lists all the PSoC registers for the CPU core in address order within their system resource configuration. The
grayed bits are reserved bits. If these bits are written, always write them with a value of ‘0’. For the core registers, the first ‘x’
in some register addresses represents either bank 0 or bank 1. These registers are listed throughout this manual in bank 0,
even though they are also available in bank 1.
Summary Table of the Core Registers
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
Carry
Zero
GIE
RL : 02
M8C REGISTER (page 25)
x,F7h
CPU_F
PgMode[1:0]
XIO
0,D0h
CUR_PP
Page Bit
RW : 00
0,D1h
STK_PP
Page Bit
RW : 00
0,D3h
IDX_PP
Page Bit
RW : 00
0,D4h
MVR_PP
Page Bit
RW : 00
0,D5h
MVW_PP
Page Bit
RW : 00
0,DAh
INT_CLR0
I2C
Sleep
SPI
GPIO
Timer
CapSense
Analog
V Monitor
RW : 00
0,E0h
INT_MSK0
I2C
Sleep
SPI
GPIO
Timer
CapSense
Analog
V Monitor
RW : 00
0,E1h
INT_SW_EN
ENSWINT
RW : 00
0,E2h
INT_VC
0,00h
PRT0DR
Data[7:0]
RW : 00
0,01h
PRT0IE
Interrupt Enables[7:0]
RW : 00
0,04h
PRT1DR
Data[7:0]
RW : 00
0,05h
PRT1IE
Interrupt Enables[7:0]
RW : 00
0,08h
PRT2DR
Data[7:0]
RW : 00
0,09h
PRT2IE
Interrupt Enables[7:0]
RW : 00
0,0Ch
PRT3DR
Data[7:0]
RW : 00
0,0Dh
PRT3IE
Interrupt Enables[7:0]
RW : 00
1,00h
PRT0DM0
Drive Mode 0[7:0]
RW : 00
1,01h
PRT0DM1
Drive Mode 1[7:0]
RW : FF
1,04h
PRT1DM0
Drive Mode 0[7:0]
RW : 00
1,05h
PRT1DM1
Drive Mode 1[7:0]
RW : FF
1,08h
PRT2DM0
Drive Mode 0[7:0]
RW : 00
1,09h
PRT2DM1
Drive Mode 1[7:0]
RW : FF
1,0Ch
PRT3DM0
Drive Mode 0[7:0]
RW : 00
1,0Dh
PRT3DM1
Drive Mode 1[7:0]
RW : FF
1,DCh
IO_CFG
1,E8h
IMO_TR
1,E9h
ILO_TR
0,E3h
RES_WDT
1,EBh
SLP_CFG
RAM PAGING (SRAM) REGISTERS (page 31)
INTERRUPT CONTROLLER REGISTERS (page 45)
Pending Interrupt[7:0]
RC : 00
GENERAL PURPOSE IO (GPIO) REGISTERS (page 51)
REG_EN
IOINT
RW : 00
INTERNAL MAIN OSCILLATOR (IMO) REGISTER (page 57)
Trim[7:0]
W : 00
INTERNAL LOW SPEED OSCILLATOR (ILO) REGISTER (page 59)
Bias Trim[1:0]
Freq Trim[3:0]
W : 00
SLEEP AND WATCHDOG REGISTERS (page 61)
WDSL_Clear[7:0]
W : 00
PSSDC[1:0]
RW : 00
LEGEND
L The and f, expr; or f, expr; and xor f, expr instructions can be used to modify this register.
x An “x” before the comma in the address field indicates that this register can be accessed or written to no matter what bank is used.
C Clearable register or bit(s).
R Read register or bit(s).
W Write register or bit(s).
24
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
2. CPU Core (M8C)
This chapter explains the CPU Core, called the M8C, and its associated register. It covers the internal M8C registers, address
spaces, instruction set and formats. For additional information concerning the M8C instruction set, refer to the PSoC
Designer Assembly Language User Guide available at the Cypress web site (http://www.cypress.com/psoc). For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
2.1
Overview
The M8C is a two MIPS 8-bit Harvard architecture microprocessor. Selectable processor clock speeds up to 12 MHz
allow you to adjust the M8C to a particular application’s performance and power requirements. The M8C supports a rich
instruction set that allows for efficient low level language
support.
2.2
Internal Registers
The M8C has five internal registers that are used in program
execution. The registers are:
■
■
■
■
■
Accumulator (A)
Index (X)
Program Counter (PC)
Stack Pointer (SP)
Flags (F)
All of the internal M8C registers are eight bits in width,
except for the PC which is 16 bits wide. When reset, A, X,
PC, and SP are reset to 00h. The Flag register (F) is reset to
02h, indicating that the Z flag is set.
With each stack operation, the SP is automatically incremented or decremented so that it always points to the next
stack byte in RAM. If the last byte in the stack is at address
FFh, the stack pointer will wrap to RAM address 00h. It is
the firmware developer’s responsibility to ensure that the
stack does not overlap with user-defined variables in RAM.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
With the exception of the F register, the M8C internal registers are not accessible via an explicit register address. The
internal M8C registers are accessed using these instructions:
■ MOV A, expr
■ MOV X, expr
■ SWAP A, SP
■ OR F, expr
■ JMP LABEL
The F register is read by using address F7h in either register
bank.
2.3
Address Spaces
The M8C has three address spaces: ROM, RAM, and registers. The ROM address space includes the supervisory
ROM (SROM) and the Flash. The ROM address space is
accessed through its own address and data bus.
The ROM address space is composed of the Supervisory
ROM and the on-chip Flash program store. Flash is organized into 64-byte blocks. Program store page boundaries
are not a concern, since the M8C automatically increments
the 16-bit PC on every instruction. This process makes the
block boundaries invisible to user code. Instructions occurring on a 256-byte Flash page boundary (with the exception
of JMP instructions) incur an extra M8C clock cycle as the
upper byte of the PC is incremented.
The register address space is used to configure the PSoC
microcontroller’s programmable blocks. It consists of two
banks of 256 bytes each. To switch between banks, the XIO
bit in the Flag register is set or cleared (set for Bank1,
cleared for Bank0). The common convention is to leave the
bank set to Bank0 (XIO cleared), switch to Bank1 as necessary (set XIO), then switch back to Bank0.
25
[+] Feedback
CPU Core (M8C)
2.4
Instruction Set Summary
The instruction set is summarized in both Table 2-1 and Table 2-2 (in numeric and mnemonic order, respectively), and serves
as a quick reference. If more information is needed, the Instruction Set Summary tables are described in detail in the PSoC
Designer Assembly Language User Guide (refer to the http://www.cypress.com/psoc web site).
Opcode Hex
Cycles
8
2 OR [X+expr], A
Z
5A
5
2 MOV [expr], X
2 ADD A, expr
C, Z
2E
9
3 OR [expr], expr
Z
5B
4
1 MOV A, X
02
6
2 ADD A, [expr]
C, Z
2F 10
3 OR [X+expr], expr
Z
5C
4
1 MOV X, A
03
7
2 ADD A, [X+expr]
C, Z
30
9
1 HALT
5D
6
2 MOV A, reg[expr]
Z
04
7
2 ADD [expr], A
C, Z
31
4
2 XOR A, expr
Z
5E
7
2 MOV A, reg[X+expr]
Z
05
8
2 ADD [X+expr], A
C, Z
32
6
2 XOR A, [expr]
Z
5F 10
3 MOV [expr], [expr]
06
9
Flags
Instruction Format
Flags
Bytes
Cycles
2D
4
Instruction Format
Bytes
Opcode Hex
1 SSC
01
Bytes
00 15
Cycles
Opcode Hex
Table 2-1. Instruction Set Summary Sorted Numerically by Opcode
Instruction Format
Flags
Z
3 ADD [expr], expr
C, Z
33
7
2 XOR A, [X+expr]
Z
60
5
2 MOV reg[expr], A
07 10
3 ADD [X+expr], expr
C, Z
34
7
2 XOR [expr], A
Z
61
6
2 MOV reg[X+expr], A
08
4
1 PUSH A
35
8
2 XOR [X+expr], A
Z
62
8
3 MOV reg[expr], expr
09
4
2 ADC A, expr
C, Z
36
9
3 XOR [expr], expr
Z
63
9
3 MOV reg[X+expr], expr
0A
6
2 ADC A, [expr]
C, Z
37 10
3 XOR [X+expr], expr
Z
64
4
1 ASL A
C, Z
0B
7
2 ADC A, [X+expr]
C, Z
38
5
2 ADD SP, expr
65
7
2 ASL [expr]
C, Z
0C
7
2 ADC [expr], A
C, Z
39
5
2 CMP A, expr
66
8
2 ASL [X+expr]
C, Z
0D
8
2 ADC [X+expr], A
C, Z
3A
7
2 CMP A, [expr]
67
4
1 ASR A
C, Z
0E
9
3 ADC [expr], expr
C, Z
3B
8
2 CMP A, [X+expr]
68
7
2 ASR [expr]
C, Z
0F 10
3 ADC [X+expr], expr
C, Z
3C
8
3 CMP [expr], expr
69
8
2 ASR [X+expr]
C, Z
10
4
1 PUSH X
3D
9
3 CMP [X+expr], expr
6A
4
1 RLC A
C, Z
11
4
2 SUB A, expr
C, Z
3E 10
2 MVI A, [ [expr]++ ]
6B
7
2 RLC [expr]
C, Z
12
6
2 SUB A, [expr]
C, Z
3F 10
2 MVI [ [expr]++ ], A
6C
8
2 RLC [X+expr]
C, Z
13
7
2 SUB A, [X+expr]
C, Z
40
4
1 NOP
6D
4
1 RRC A
C, Z
14
7
2 SUB [expr], A
C, Z
41
9
3 AND reg[expr], expr
Z
6E
7
2 RRC [expr]
C, Z
15
8
2 SUB [X+expr], A
C, Z
42 10
3 AND reg[X+expr], expr
Z
6F
8
2 RRC [X+expr]
C, Z
16
9
3 SUB [expr], expr
C, Z
43
3 OR reg[expr], expr
Z
70
4
2 AND F, expr
C, Z
17 10
3 SUB [X+expr], expr
C, Z
44 10
3 OR reg[X+expr], expr
Z
71
4
2 OR F, expr
C, Z
18
5
1 POP A
45
3 XOR reg[expr], expr
Z
72
4
2 XOR F, expr
C, Z
19
4
2 SBB A, expr
C, Z
46 10
3 XOR reg[X+expr], expr
Z
73
4
1 CPL A
Z
1A
6
2 SBB A, [expr]
C, Z
47
8
3 TST [expr], expr
Z
74
4
1 INC A
C, Z
Z
9
9
if (A=B) Z=1
if (A<B) C=1
Z
1B
7
2 SBB A, [X+expr]
C, Z
48
9
3 TST [X+expr], expr
Z
75
4
1 INC X
C, Z
1C
7
2 SBB [expr], A
C, Z
49
9
3 TST reg[expr], expr
Z
76
7
2 INC [expr]
C, Z
1D
8
2 SBB [X+expr], A
C, Z
4A 10
3 TST reg[X+expr], expr
Z
77
8
2 INC [X+expr]
C, Z
1E
9
3 SBB [expr], expr
C, Z
4B
5
1 SWAP A, X
Z
78
4
1 DEC A
C, Z
1F 10
3 SBB [X+expr], expr
C, Z
4C
7
2 SWAP A, [expr]
Z
79
4
1 DEC X
C, Z
20
5
1 POP X
4D
7
2 SWAP X, [expr]
7A
7
2 DEC [expr]
C, Z
21
4
2 AND A, expr
Z
4E
5
1 SWAP A, SP
7B
8
2 DEC [X+expr]
C, Z
22
6
2 AND A, [expr]
Z
4F
4
1 MOV X, SP
23
7
2 AND A, [X+expr]
Z
50
4
2 MOV A, expr
24
7
2 AND [expr], A
Z
51
5
2 MOV A, [expr]
25
8
2 AND [X+expr], A
Z
52
6
2 MOV A, [X+expr]
26
9
Z
7C 13
3 LCALL
Z
7D
7
3 LJMP
Z
7E 10
1 RETI
Z
7F
8
1 RET
5
2 JMP
3 AND [expr], expr
Z
53
5
2 MOV [expr], A
8x
27 10
3 AND [X+expr], expr
Z
54
6
2 MOV [X+expr], A
9x 11
2 CALL
28 11
1 ROMX
Z
55
8
3 MOV [expr], expr
Ax
5
2 JZ
29
4
2 OR A, expr
Z
56
9
3 MOV [X+expr], expr
Bx
5
2 JNZ
2A
6
2 OR A, [expr]
Z
57
4
2 MOV X, expr
Cx
5
2 JC
2B
7
2 OR A, [X+expr]
Z
58
6
2 MOV X, [expr]
Dx
5
2 JNC
2C
7
2 OR [expr], A
Z
59
7
2 MOV X, [X+expr]
Ex
7
2 JACC
Note 1
Interrupt acknowledge to Interrupt Vector table = 13 cycles.
Note 2
The number of cycles required by an instruction is increased by one for instructions that span
256 byte page boundaries in the Flash memory space.
26
Fx 13
2 INDEX
C, Z
Z
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CPU Core (M8C)
Bytes
Cycles
Bytes
Opcode Hex
Cycles
Opcode Hex
09 4
2
ADC A, expr
C, Z
76
7
2
INC [expr]
C, Z
20
5
1
POP X
0A 6
2
ADC A, [expr]
C, Z
77
8
2
INC [X+expr]
C, Z
18
5
1
POP A
0B 7
2
ADC A, [X+expr]
C, Z
Fx 13 2
INDEX
Z
10
4
1
PUSH X
0C 7
2
ADC [expr], A
C, Z
Ex 7
2
JACC
08
4
1
PUSH A
0D 8
2
ADC [X+expr], A
C, Z
Cx 5
2
JC
7E 10 1
RETI
0E 9
3
ADC [expr], expr
C, Z
8x
5
2
JMP
7F
8
1
RET
0F 10 3
ADC [X+expr], expr
C, Z
Dx 5
2
JNC
6A
4
1
RLC A
C, Z
01 4
2
ADD A, expr
C, Z
Bx 5
2
JNZ
6B
7
2
RLC [expr]
C, Z
02 6
2
ADD A, [expr]
C, Z
Ax 5
2
JZ
6C
8
2
RLC [X+expr]
C, Z
03 7
2
ADD A, [X+expr]
C, Z
7C 13 3
LCALL
28 11 1
ROMX
Z
04 7
2
ADD [expr], A
C, Z
7D 7
3
LJMP
6D
4
1
RRC A
C, Z
05 8
2
ADD [X+expr], A
C, Z
4F 4
1
MOV X, SP
6E
7
2
RRC [expr]
C, Z
06 9
3
ADD [expr], expr
C, Z
50 4
2
MOV A, expr
Z
6F
8
2
RRC [X+expr]
C, Z
07 10 3
ADD [X+expr], expr
C, Z
51 5
2
MOV A, [expr]
Z
19
4
2
SBB A, expr
C, Z
38
5
2
ADD SP, expr
52 6
2
MOV A, [X+expr]
Z
1A
6
2
SBB A, [expr]
C, Z
21
4
2
AND A, expr
Z
53 5
2
MOV [expr], A
1B
7
2
SBB A, [X+expr]
C, Z
22
6
2
AND A, [expr]
Z
54 6
2
MOV [X+expr], A
1C
7
2
SBB [expr], A
C, Z
23
7
2
AND A, [X+expr]
Z
55 8
3
MOV [expr], expr
1D
8
2
SBB [X+expr], A
C, Z
24
7
2
AND [expr], A
Z
56 9
3
MOV [X+expr], expr
1E
9
3
SBB [expr], expr
C, Z
25
8
2
AND [X+expr], A
Z
57 4
2
MOV X, expr
1F 10 3
SBB [X+expr], expr
C, Z
26
9
3
AND [expr], expr
Z
58 6
2
MOV X, [expr]
00 15 1
SSC
27 10 3
AND [X+expr], expr
Z
59 7
2
MOV X, [X+expr]
11
4
2
SUB A, expr
C, Z
70
4
2
AND F, expr
C, Z
5A 5
2
MOV [expr], X
12
6
2
SUB A, [expr]
C, Z
41
9
3
AND reg[expr], expr
Z
5B 4
1
MOV A, X
13
7
2
SUB A, [X+expr]
C, Z
42 10 3
AND reg[X+expr], expr
Z
5C 4
1
MOV X, A
14
7
2
SUB [expr], A
C, Z
64
4
1
ASL A
C, Z
5D 6
2
MOV A, reg[expr]
Z
15
8
2
SUB [X+expr], A
C, Z
65
7
2
ASL [expr]
C, Z
5E 7
2
MOV A, reg[X+expr]
Z
16
9
3
SUB [expr], expr
C, Z
66
8
2
ASL [X+expr]
C, Z
5F 10 3
MOV [expr], [expr]
17 10 3
SUB [X+expr], expr
C, Z
67
4
1
ASR A
C, Z
60 5
2
MOV reg[expr], A
4B
5
1
SWAP A, X
Z
68
7
2
ASR [expr]
C, Z
61 6
2
MOV reg[X+expr], A
4C
7
2
SWAP A, [expr]
Z
69
8
2
ASR [X+expr]
C, Z
62 8
3
MOV reg[expr], expr
4D
7
2
SWAP X, [expr]
9x
11 2
CALL
63 9
3
MOV reg[X+expr], expr
4E
5
1
SWAP A, SP
Z
39
5
2
CMP A, expr
3E 10 2
MVI A, [ [expr]++ ]
47
8
3
TST [expr], expr
Z
3A
7
2
CMP A, [expr]
3F 10 2
MVI [ [expr]++ ], A
48
9
3
TST [X+expr], expr
Z
3B
8
2
CMP A, [X+expr]
40 4
1
NOP
49
9
3
TST reg[expr], expr
Z
3C
8
3
CMP [expr], expr
29 4
2
OR A, expr
Z
4A 10 3
TST reg[X+expr], expr
Z
3D
9
3
CMP [X+expr], expr
2A 6
2
OR A, [expr]
Z
72
4
2
XOR F, expr
C, Z
73
4
1
CPL A
Z
2B 7
2
OR A, [X+expr]
Z
31 4
2
XOR A, expr
Z
78
4
1
DEC A
C, Z
2C 7
2
OR [expr], A
Z
32 6
2
XOR A, [expr]
Z
79
4
1
DEC X
C, Z
2D 8
2
OR [X+expr], A
Z
33 7
2
XOR A, [X+expr]
Z
7A
7
2
DEC [expr]
C, Z
2E 9
3
OR [expr], expr
Z
34 7
2
XOR [expr], A
Z
7B
8
2
DEC [X+expr]
C, Z
2F 10 3
OR [X+expr], expr
Z
35 8
2
XOR [X+expr], A
Z
30
9
1
HALT
43 9
OR reg[expr], expr
Z
36 9
3
XOR [expr], expr
Z
74
4
1
INC A
C, Z
44 10 3
OR reg[X+expr], expr
Z
37 10 3
XOR [X+expr], expr
Z
75
4
1
INC X
C, Z
71 4
OR F, expr
C, Z
45
XOR reg[expr], expr
Z
XOR reg[X+expr], expr
Z
Bytes
Cycles
Opcode Hex
Table 2-2. Instruction Set Summary Sorted Alphabetically by Mnemonic
Instruction Format
Flags
if (A=B) Z=1
if (A<B) C=1
Instruction Format
3
2
Flags
Z
Z
Note 1 Interrupt acknowledge to Interrupt Vector table = 13 cycles.
Instruction Format
9
3
46 10 3
Flags
Z
C, Z
Note 2 The number of cycles required by an instruction is increased by one for instructions that span
256 byte page boundaries in the Flash memory space.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
27
[+] Feedback
CPU Core (M8C)
2.5
Instruction Formats
The M8C has a total of seven instruction formats that use
instruction lengths of one, two, and three bytes. All instruction bytes are retrieved from the program memory (Flash),
using an address and data bus that are independent from
the address and data buses used for register and RAM
access.
While examples of instructions are given in this section,
refer to the PSoC Designer Assembly Language User Guide
for detailed information on individual instructions.
2.5.1
One-Byte Instructions
Many instructions, such as some of the MOV instructions,
have single-byte forms because they do not use an address
or data as an operand. As shown in Table 2-3, one-byte
instructions use an 8-bit opcode. The set of one-byte
instructions can be divided into four categories, according to
where their results are stored.
Table 2-3. One-Byte Instruction Format
Byte 0
8-Bit Opcode
The first category of one-byte instructions are those that do
not update any registers or RAM. Only the one-byte NOP
and SSC instructions fit this category. While the program
counter is incremented as these instructions execute, they
do not cause any other internal M8C registers to update, nor
do these instructions directly affect the register space or the
RAM address space. The SSC instruction causes SROM
code to run, which modifies RAM and the M8C internal registers.
The second category contains only the two PUSH instructions. The PUSH instructions are unique because they are
the only one-byte instructions that modifies a RAM address.
These instructions automatically increment the SP.
The third category contains only the HALT instruction. The
HALT instruction is unique because it is the only a one-byte
instruction that modifies a user register. The HALT instruction modifies user register space address FFh (CPU_SCR0
register).
2.5.2
Two-Byte Instructions
The majority of M8C instructions are two bytes in length.
While it is possible to divide these instructions into categories identical to the one-byte instructions, this does not provide a useful distinction between the three two-byte
instruction formats that the M8C uses.
Table 2-4. Two-Byte Instruction Formats
Byte 0
Byte 1
4-Bit Opcode 12-Bit Relative Address
8-Bit Opcode
8-Bit Data
8-Bit Opcode
8-Bit Address
The first two-byte instruction format, shown in the first row of
Table 2-4, is used by short jumps and calls: CALL, JMP,
JACC, INDEX, JC, JNC, JNZ, JZ. This instruction format
uses only four bits for the instruction opcode, leaving 12 bits
to store the relative destination address in a two’s-complement form. These instructions can change program execution to an address relative to the current address by -2048 or
+2047.
The second two-byte instruction format, shown in the second row of Table 2-4, is used by instructions that employ the
Source Immediate addressing mode (see the PSoC
Designer Assembly Language User Guide). The destination
for these instructions is an internal M8C register, while the
source is a constant value. An example of this type of
instruction is ADD A, 7.
The third two-byte instruction format, shown in the third row
of Table 2-4, is used by a wide range of instructions and
addressing modes. Here is a list of the addressing modes
that use this third two-byte instruction format:
■
■
■
■
■
■
Source Direct (ADD A, [7])
Source Indexed (ADD A, [X+7])
Destination Direct (ADD [7], A)
Destination Indexed (ADD [X+7], A)
Source Indirect Post Increment (MVI A, [7])
Destination Indirect Post Increment (MVI [7], A)
For more information on addressing modes see the PSoC
Designer Assembly Language User Guide.
The final category for one-byte instructions are those that
cause updates of the internal M8C registers. This category
holds the largest number of instructions: ASL, ASR, CPL,
DEC, INC, MOV, POP, RET, RETI, RLC, ROMX, RRC,
SWAP. These instructions can cause the A, X, and SP registers or SRAM to update.
28
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CPU Core (M8C)
2.5.3
Three-Byte Instructions
The three-byte instruction formats are the second most
prevalent instruction formats. These instructions need three
bytes because they either move data between two
addresses in the user-accessible address space (registers
and RAM) or they hold 16-bit absolute addresses as the
destination of a long jump or long call.
Table 2-5. Three-Byte Instruction Formats
Byte 0
Byte 1
Byte 2
8-Bit Opcode
16-Bit Address (MSB, LSB)
8-Bit Opcode
8-Bit Address
8-Bit Data
8-Bit Opcode
8-Bit Address
8-Bit Address
The first instruction format, shown in the first row of
Table 2-5, is used by the LJMP and LCALL instructions.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
These instructions change program execution unconditionally to an absolute address. The instructions use an 8-bit
opcode, leaving room for a 16-bit destination address.
The second three-byte instruction format, shown in the second row of Table 2-5, is used by these two addressing
modes:
■
■
Destination Direct Source Immediate (ADD [7], 5)
Destination Indexed Source Immediate (ADD [X+7], 5)
The third three-byte instruction format, shown in the third
row of Table 2-5, is for the Destination Direct Source Direct
addressing mode, which is used by only one instruction.
This instruction format uses an 8-bit opcode followed by two
8-bit addresses. The first address is the destination address
in RAM, while the second address is the source address in
RAM. Here is an example of this instruction:
MOV [7], [5]
29
[+] Feedback
CPU Core (M8C)
2.6
Register Definitions
The register shown here is associated with the CPU Core (M8C). The register description has an associated register table
showing the bit structure. The grayed out bits in the table are reserved bits and are not detailed in the register description that
follows. Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’.
2.6.1
Address
x,F7h
CPU_F Register
Name
Bit 7
CPU_F
Bit 6
Bit 5
PgMode[1:0]
Bit 4
Bit 3
XIO
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
Carry
Zero
GIE
RL : 02
LEGEND
L The AND F, expr; OR F, expr; and XOR F, expr flag instructions can be used to modify this register.
x An “x” before the comma in the address field indicates that this register can be read or written to no matter what bank is used.
The M8C Flag Register (CPU_F) provides read access to
the M8C flags.
flag-logic opcodes (for example, OR F, 4). See the PSoC
Designer Assembly Language User Guide for more details.
Bits 7 and 6: PgMode[1:0]
Bit 1: Zero
PgMode determines how the CUR_PP, STK_PP, and
IDX_PP registers are used in forming effective RAM
addresses for Direct Address mode and Indexed Address
mode operands. PgMode also determines whether the stack
page is determined by the STK_PP or IDX_PP register.
(See the “Register Definitions” on page 34 in the RAM Paging chapter.)
The Zero flag bit is set or cleared in response to the result of
several instructions. It can also be manipulated by the flaglogic opcodes (for example, OR F, 2). See the PSoC
Designer Assembly Language User Guide for more details.
Bit 4: XIO
The IO Bank Select bit, also known as the register bank
select bit, is used to select the register bank that is active for
a register read or write. This bit allows the PSoC device to
have 512 8-bit registers and can be thought of as the ninth
address bit for registers. The address space accessed when
the XIO bit is set to ‘0’ is called the user space, while the
address space accessed when the XIO bit is set to ‘1’ is
called the configuration space.
Bit 0: GIE
The state of the Global Interrupt Enable bit determines
whether interrupts (by way of the interrupt request (IRQ)) will
be recognized by the M8C. This bit is set or cleared by the
user using the flag-logic instructions (for example, OR F, 1).
GIE is also cleared automatically when an interrupt is processed, after the flag byte has been stored on the stack,
preventing nested interrupts. If desired, the bit can be set in
an interrupt service routine (ISR).
For GIE=1, the M8C samples the IRQ input for each instruction. For GIE=0, the M8C ignores the IRQ.
For additional information, refer to the CPU_F register on
page 176.
Bit 2: Carry
The Carry flag bit is set or cleared in response to the actions
of several instructions. It can also be manipulated by the
2.6.2
Related Registers
These registers are related to the M8C block:
■
CPU_SCR1 register on page 178.
■
CPU_SCR0 register on page 179.
30
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
3. RAM Paging
This chapter explains the PSoC device’s use of RAM Paging and its associated registers. For a complete table of the RAM
paging registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the Core Registers” on page 24. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers
in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
3.1
Architectural Description
The M8C is an 8-bit CPU with an 8-bit memory address bus.
The memory address bus allows the M8C to access up to
256 bytes of SRAM, to increase the amount of available
SRAM and preserve the M8C assembly language. The
CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device has 256 bytes of SRAM with
two pages of memory.
To take full advantage of the paged memory architecture of
the PSoC device, several registers must be used and two
CPU_F register bits must be managed. However, the Power
On Reset (POR) value for all of the paging registers and
CPU_F bits is zero. This places the PSoC device in a mode
identical to existing PSoC devices with only 256 bytes of
SRAM. It is not necessary to understand all of the Paging
registers to take advantage of the additional SRAM available in some devices. Very simple modifications to the reset
state of the memory paging logic can be made to begin to
take advantage of the additional SRAM pages.
3.1.1
To increase the amount of SRAM, the M8C accesses memory page bits. The memory page bits are located in the
CUR_PP register and allow for selection of one of eight
SRAM pages. In addition to setting the page bits, Page
mode must be enabled by setting the CPU_F[7] bit. If Page
mode is not enabled, the page bits are ignored and all nonstack memory access is directed to Page 0.
Once Page mode is enabled and the page bits are set, all
instructions that operate on memory access the SRAM page
indicated by the page bits. The exceptions to this are the
instructions that operate on the stack and the MVI instructions: PUSH, POP, LCALL, RETI, RET, CALL, and MVI. See
the description of Stack Operations and MVI Instructions
below for a more detailed discussion.
Figure 3-1. Data Memory Organization
The memory paging architecture consists of five areas:
■
■
■
■
■
Stack Operations
Interrupts
MVI Instructions
Current Page Pointer
Indexed Memory Page Pointer
The first three of these areas have no dependency on the
CPU_F register's PgMode bits and are covered in the next
subsections after Basic Paging. The function of the last two
depend on the CPU_F PgMode bits and are covered last.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Basic Paging
00h
Page 0
SRAM
256 Bytes
FFh
Page 1
SRAM
256 Bytes
Page 2
SRAM
256 Bytes
ISR
31
[+] Feedback
RAM Paging
3.1.2
Stack Operations
As mentioned previously, the paging architecture's reset
state puts the PSoC in a mode that is identical to that of a
256 byte PSoC device. Therefore, upon reset, all memory
accesses are set to Page 0. The SRAM page that stack
operations use is determined by the value of the three least
significant bits (LSb) of the stack page pointer register
(STK_PP). Stack operations have no dependency on the
PgMode bits in the CPU_F register. Stack operations are
those that use the Stack Pointer (SP) to calculate their
affected address. Refer to the PSoC Designer Assembly
Language User Guide for more information on all M8C
instructions.
Treat stack memory accesses as a special case. If they are
not, the stack could be fragmented across several pages. To
prevent the stack from fragmenting, all instructions that
operate on the stack automatically use the page indicated
by the STK_PP register. Therefore, if a CALL is encountered in the program, the PSoC device automatically pushes
the program counter onto the stack page indicated by
STK_PP. Once the program counter is pushed, the SRAM
paging mode automatically switches back to the pre-call
mode. All other stack operations, such as RET and POP, follow the same rule as CALL. The stack is confined to a single
SRAM page and the Stack Pointer wraps from 00h to FFh
and FFh to 00h. The user code must ensure that the stack is
not damaged due to stack wrapping.
Because the value of the STK_PP register can be changed
at any time, it is theoretically possible to manage the stack in
such a way as to allow it to grow beyond one SRAM page or
manage multiple stacks. However, the only supported use of
the STK_PP register is when its value is set prior to the first
stack operation and not changed again.
3.1.3
Interrupts
Interrupts, in a multi-page SRAM PSoC device, operate the
same as interrupts in a 256-byte PSoC device. However,
because the CPU_F register is automatically set to 0x00 on
an interrupt and because of the non-linear nature of interrupts in a system, other parts of the PSoC memory paging
architecture can be affected.
Interrupts are an abrupt change in program flow. If no special action is taken on interrupts by the PSoC device, the
interrupt service routine (ISR) could be thrown into any
SRAM page. To prevent this problem, the special addressing modes for all memory accesses, except for stack and
MVI, are disabled when an ISR is entered. The special
addressing modes are disabled when the CUP_F register is
cleared. At the end of the ISR, the previous SRAM addressing mode is restored when the CPU_F register value is
restored by the RETI instruction.
32
All interrupt service routine code starts execution in SRAM
Page 0. If it is necessary for the ISR to change to another
SRAM page, it can be accomplished by changing the values
of the CPU_F[7:6] bits to enable the special SRAM addressing modes. However, any change made to the CUR_PP,
IDX_PP, or STK_PP registers persists after the ISR returns.
Therefore, the ISR should save the current value of any
paging register it modifies and restore its value before the
ISR returns.
3.1.4
MVI Instructions
MVI instructions use data page pointers of their own
(MVR_PP and MVW_PP). This allows a data buffer to be
located away from other program variables, but accessible
without changing the Current Page Pointer (CUR_PP).
An MVI instruction performs three memory operations. Both
forms of the MVI instruction access an address in SRAM
that holds the data pointer (a memory read 1st access),
incrementing that value and then storing it back in SRAM (a
memory write 2nd access). This pointer value must reside in
the current page, just as all other non-stack and nonindexed operations on memory must. However, the third
memory operation uses the MVx_PP register. This third
memory access can be either a read or a write, depending
on which MVI instruction is used. The MVR_PP pointer is
used for the MVI instruction that moves data into the accumulator. The MVW_PP pointer is used for the MVI instruction that moves data from the accumulator into SRAM. The
MVI pointers are always enabled, regardless of the state of
the Flag register page bits (CPU_F register).
3.1.5
Current Page Pointer
The Current Page Pointer is used to determine which SRAM
page should be used for all memory accesses. Normal
memory accesses are those not covered by other pointers
including all non-stack, non-MVI, and non-indexed memory
access instructions. The normal memory access instructions
have the SRAM page they operate on determined by the
value of the CUR_PP register. By default, the CUR_PP register has no affect on the SRAM page that is used for normal
memory access, because all normal memory access is
forced to SRAM Page 0.
The upper bit of the PgMode bits in the CPU_F register
determine whether or not the CUR_PP register affects normal memory access. When the upper bit of the PgMode bits
is set to ‘0’, all normal memory access is forced to SRAM
Page 0. This mode is automatically enabled when an Interrupt Service Routine (ISR) is entered. This is because,
before the ISR is entered, the M8C pushes the current value
of the CPU_F register onto the stack and then clears the
CPU_F register. Therefore, by default, any normal memory
access in an ISR is guaranteed to occur in SRAM Page 0.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
RAM Paging
When the RETI instruction is executed to end the ISR, the
previous value of the CPU_F register is restored, restoring
the previous page mode. Note that this ISR behavior is the
default and that the PgMode bits in the CPU_F register can
be changed while in an ISR. If the PgMode bits are changed
while in an ISR, the pre-ISR value is still restored by the
RETI; but if the CUR_PP register is changed in the ISR, the
ISR is also required to restore the value before executing
the RETI instruction.
When the upper bit of the PgMode bits is set to ‘1’, all normal memory access is forced to the SRAM page indicated
by the value of the CUR_PP register. Table 3-1 gives a summary of the PgMode bit values and the corresponding Memory Paging mode.
3.1.6
Index Memory Page Pointer
The source indexed and destination indexed addressing
modes to SRAM are treated as a unique addressing mode
in a PSoC device with more than one page of SRAM. An
example of an indexed addressing mode is the MOV A,
[X+expr] instruction. Note that register access also has
indexed addressing; however, those instructions are not
affected by the SRAM paging architecture.
Important Note If you are not using assembly to program a
PSoC device, be aware that the compiler writer may restrict
the use of some memory paging modes. Review the conventions in your compiler’s user guide for more information
on restrictions or conventions associated with memory paging modes.
Indexed SRAM accesses operate in one of three modes:
■ Index memory access modes are forced to SRAM
Page 0.
■ Index memory access modes are directed to the SRAM
page indicated by the value in the STK_PP register.
■ Index memory access is forced to the SRAM page indicated by the value in the IDX_PP register.
The mode is determined by the value of the PgMode bits in
the CPU_F register. However, the final SRAM page that is
used also requires setting either the Stack Page Pointer
(STK_PP) register or the Index Page Pointer (IDX_PP) register. The table below shows the three indexed memory
access modes. The third column of the table is provided for
reference only.
After reset, the PgMode bits are set to 00b. In this mode,
index memory accesses are forced to SRAM Page 0, just as
they would be in a PSoC device with only 256 bytes of
SRAM. This mode is also automatically enabled when an
interrupt occurs in a PSoC device and is therefore considered the default ISR mode. This is because before the ISR
is entered, the M8C pushes the current value of the CPU_F
register on to the stack and then clears the CPU_F register.
Therefore, by default, any indexed memory access in an
ISR is guaranteed to occur in SRAM Page 0. When the
RETI instruction is executed to end the ISR, the previous
value of the CPU_F register is restored and the previous
page mode is then also restored. Note that this ISR behavior
is the default and that the PgMode bits in the CPU_F register may be changed while in an ISR. If the PgMode bits are
changed while in an ISR, the pre-ISR value is still restored
by the RETI; but if the STK_PP or IDX_PP registers are
changed in the ISR, the ISR is also required to restore the
values before executing the RETI instruction.
The most likely PgMode bit change, while in an ISR, is from
the default value of 00b to 01b. In the 01b mode, indexed
memory access is directed to the SRAM page indicated by
the value of the STK_PP register. By using the PgMode, the
value of the STK_PP register is not required to be modified.
The STK_PP register is the register that determines which
SRAM page the stack is located on. The 01b paging mode is
intended to provide easy access to the stack, while in an
ISR, by setting the CPU_X register (just X in the instruction
format) equal to the value of SP using the MOV X, SP
instruction.
The two previous paragraphs covered two of the three
indexed memory access modes: STK_PP and forced to
SRAM Page 0. Note, as shown in Table 3-1, that the
STK_PP mode for indexed memory access is available
under two PgMode settings. The 01b mode is intended for
ISR use and the 11b mode is intended for non-ISR use. The
third indexed memory access mode requires the PgMode
bits to be set to 10b. In this mode indexed memory access is
forced to the SRAM page indicated by the value of the
IDX_PP register.
Table 3-1. CPU_F PgMode Bit Modes
CPU_F
PgMode
BIts
Current
SRAM Page
Indexed
SRAM Page
00b
0
0
01b
0
STK_PP
10b
CUR_PP
IDX_PP
11b
CUR_PP
STK_PP
Typical Use
ISR*
ISR with variables on stack
* Mode used by SROM functions initiated by the SSC instruction.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
33
[+] Feedback
RAM Paging
3.2
Register Definitions
The registers listed here are associated with RAM Paging and are in address order. The register descriptions have an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. The grayed out bits in the tables are reserved bits and are not
detailed in the register descriptions. Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For a complete table of RAM Paging registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the Core Registers” on page 24.
3.2.1
Address
0,D0h
CUR_PP Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
The Current Page Pointer Register (CUR_PP) is used to set
the effective SRAM page for normal memory accesses in a
multi-SRAM page PSoC device.
Address
0,D1h
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
Page Bit
RW : 00
See the MVR_PP and MVW_PP register descriptions for
more information. For additional information, refer to the
CUR_PP register on page 162.
STK_PP Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
STK_PP
The Stack Page Pointer Register (STK_PP) is used to set
the effective SRAM page for stack memory accesses in a
multi-SRAM page PSoC device.
Bit 0: Page Bit. This bit has the potential to affect two
types of memory access.
The purpose of this register is to determine which SRAM
page the stack is stored on. In the reset state, this register's
value is 0x00 and the stack will therefore be in SRAM Page
0. However, if the STK_PP register value is changed, the
next stack operation will occur on the SRAM page indicated
by the new STK_PP value. Therefore, the value of this register should be set early in the program and never be
changed. If the program changes the STK_PP value after
34
Bit 2
The source indirect post increment and destination indirect
post increment addressing modes, better know as MVI, are
only partially affected by the value of the CUR_PP register.
For MVI instructions, the pointer address is in the SRAM
page indicated by CUR_PP, but the address pointed to may
be in another SRAM page.
Bit 0: Page Bit. This bit affects the SRAM page that is
accessed by an instruction when the CPU_F[7:0] bits have a
value of either 10b or 11b. Source indexed and destination
indexed addressing modes, as well as stack instructions,
are never affected by the value of the CUR_PP register.
(See the STK_PP and IDX_PP registers for more information.)
3.2.2
Bit 3
CUR_PP
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
Page Bit
RW : 00
the stack has grown, the program must ensure that the
STK_PP value is restored when needed.
Note The impact that the STK_PP register has on the stack
is independent of the SRAM Paging bits in the CPU_F register.
The second type of memory accesses that the STK_PP register affects are indexed memory accesses when the
CPU_F[7:6] bits are set to 11b. In this mode, source indexed
and destination indexed memory accesses are directed to
the stack SRAM page, rather than the SRAM page indicated
by the IDX_PP register or SRAM Page 0.
For additional information, refer to the STK_PP register on
page 163.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
RAM Paging
3.2.3
Address
0,D3h
IDX_PP Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
The Index Page Pointer Register (IDX_PP) is used to set
the effective SRAM page for indexed memory accesses in a
multi-SRAM page PSoC device.
Address
0,D4h
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
Page Bit
RW : 00
When CPU_F[7:6] is set to 10b and an indexed memory
access is made, the access is directed to the SRAM page
indicated by the value of the IDX_PP register.
See the STK_PP register description for more information
on other indexed memory access modes. For additional
information, refer to the IDX_PP register on page 164.
Bits 0: Page Bit. This bit allows instructions, which use the
source indexed and destination indexed address modes, to
operate on an SRAM page that is not equal to the current
SRAM page. However, the effect this register has on
indexed addressing modes is only enabled when the
CPU_F[7:6] is set to 10b.
3.2.4
Bit 3
IDX_PP
MVR_PP Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
MVR_PP
The MVI Read Page Pointer Register (MVR_PP) is used to
set the effective SRAM page for MVI read memory accesses
in a multi-SRAM page PSoC device.
Bit 0: Page Bit. This bit is only used by the MVI A, [expr]
instruction, not to be confused with the MVI [expr], A instruction covered by the MVW_PP register. This instruction is
considered a read because data is transferred from SRAM
to the microprocessor's A register (CPU_A).
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
Page Bit
RW : 00
least significant bits in this register. However, the pointer for
the MVI A, [expr] instruction is always located in the current
SRAM page. See the PSoC Designer Assembly Language
User Guide for more information on the MVI A, [expr]
instruction.
The function of this register and the MVI instructions are
independent of the SRAM Paging bits in the CPU_F register.
For additional information, refer to the MVR_PP register on
page 165.
When an MVI A, [expr] instruction is executed in a device
with more than one page of SRAM, the SRAM address that
is read by the instruction is determined by the value of the
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
35
[+] Feedback
RAM Paging
3.2.5
Address
0,D5h
MVW_PP Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
MVW_PP
The MVI Write Page Pointer Register (MVW_PP) is used to
set the effective SRAM page for MVI write memory
accesses in a multi-SRAM page PSoC device.
Bit 0: Page Bit. This bit is only used by the MVI [expr], A
instruction, not to be confused with the MVI A, [expr] instruction covered by the MVR_PP register. This instruction is
considered a write because data is transferred from the
microprocessor's A register (CPU_A) to SRAM.
3.2.6
■
36
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
Page Bit
RW : 00
When an MVI [expr], A instruction is executed in a device
with more than one page of SRAM, the SRAM address that
is written by the instruction is determined by the value of the
least significant bits in this register. However, the pointer for
the MVI [expr], A instruction is always located in the current
SRAM page. See the PSoC Designer Assembly Language
User Guide for more information on the MVI [expr], A
instruction.
The function of this register and the MVI instructions are
independent of the SRAM Paging bits in the CPU_F register.
For additional information, refer to the MVW_PP register on
page 166.
Related Registers
“CPU_F Register” on page 30.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
4.
Supervisory ROM (SROM)
This chapter discusses the Supervisory ROM (SROM) functions. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order,
refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
4.1
Architectural Description
The SROM holds code that is used to boot the PSoC
device, calibrate circuitry, and perform Flash operations.
The functions provided by the SROM are called from code
stored in the Flash or by device programmers.
Table 4-1. List of SROM Functions
Function Code
The SROM is used to boot the part and provide interface
functions to the Flash banks. (Table 4-1 lists the SROM
functions.) The SROM functions are accessed by executing
the Supervisory System Call instruction (SSC) which has an
opcode of 00h. Before executing the SSC, the M8C’s accumulator needs to load with the desired SROM function code
from Table 4-1.
Attempting to access undefined functions causes a HALT.
The SROM functions execute code with calls; therefore, the
functions require stack space. With the exception of Reset,
all of the SROM functions have a parameter block in
SRAM that you must configure before executing the SSC.
Table 4-2 lists all possible parameter block variables. The
meaning of each parameter, with regards to a specific
SROM function, is described later in this chapter. Because
the SSC instruction clears the CPU_F PgMode bits, all
parameter block variable addresses are in SRAM Page 0.
The CPU_F value is automatically restored at the end of the
SROM function.
The MVR_PP and the MVW_PP pointers are not disabled
by clearing the CPU_F PgMode bits. Therefore, the
POINTER parameter is interpreted as an address in the
page indicated by the MVI page pointers, when the supervisory operation is called. This allows the data buffer used in
the supervisory operation to be located in any SRAM page.
(See the RAM Paging chapter on page 31 for more details
regarding the MVR_PP and MVW_PP pointers.)
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Function Name
Stack Space
Needed
Page
00h
SWBootReset
0
38
01h
ReadBlock
7
39
02h
WriteBlock
10
40
03h
EraseBlock
9
40
06h
TableRead
3
41
07h
CheckSum
3
41
08h
Calibrate0
4
41
09h
Calibrate1
3
42
0Ah
WriteAndVerify
7
42
0Fh
HWBootReset
3
39
Note ProtectBlock (described on page 40) and EraseAll (described on page
41) SROM functions are not listed in the table above because they depend
upon external programming.
Table 4-2. SROM Function Variables
Variable Name
KEY1 / RETURN CODE
SRAM Address
0,F8h
KEY2
0,F9h
BLOCKID
0,FAh
POINTER
0,FBh
CLOCK
0,FCh
Reserved
0,FDh
DELAY
0,FEh
Reserved
0,FFh
Two important variables that are used for all functions are
KEY1 and KEY2. These variables are used to help discriminate between valid SSCs and inadvertent SSCs. KEY1 must
always have a value of 3Ah, while KEY2 must have the
same value as the stack pointer when the SROM function
begins execution. This would be the SP (Stack Pointer)
value when the SSC opcode is executed, plus three. For all
SROM functions except SWBootReset, if either of the keys
do not match the expected values, the M8C will halt. The
SWBootReset function does not check the key values. It
only checks to see if the accumulator’s value is 0x00.
37
[+] Feedback
Supervisory ROM (SROM)
The following code example puts the correct value in KEY1
and KEY2. The code is preceded by a HALT, to force the
program to jump directly into the setup code and not accidentally run into it.
1.
halt
2. SSCOP: mov [KEY1], 3ah
3.
mov X, SP
4.
mov A, X
5.
add A, 3
6.
mov [KEY2], A
4.1.1
Additional SROM Feature
The SROM has this additional feature.
Return Codes: These aid in the determination of success
or failure of a particular function. The return code is stored in
KEY1’s position in the parameter block. The CheckSum and
TableRead functions do not have return codes because
KEY1’s position in the parameter block is used to return
other data.
Table 4-3. SROM Return Code Meanings
Return Code Value
Description
00h
Success
01h
Function not allowed due to level of protection on
the block.
02h
Software reset without hardware reset.
03h
Fatal error, SROM halted.
Note Read, write, and erase operations may fail if the target
block is read or write protected. Block protection levels are
set during device programming and cannot be modified from
code in the PSoC device.
4.1.2
4.1.2.1
SROM Function Descriptions
SWBootReset Function
See “System Resets” on page 107 for more information on
what events causes the SWBootReset function to execute.
The SWBootReset function is executed whenever the
SROM is entered with an M8C accumulator value of 00h;
the SRAM parameter block is not used as an input to the
function. This happens, by design, after a hardware reset
because the M8C's accumulator is reset to 00h or when
user code executes the SSC instruction with an accumulator
value of 00h.
If the checksum of the calibration data is valid, the
SWBootReset function ends by setting the internal M8C registers to 00h, writing 00h to most SRAM addresses in SRAM
Page 0, and then begins to execute user code at address
0000h. (See Table 4-4 and the following paragraphs for
more information on which SRAM addresses are modified.)
If the checksum is not valid, an internal reset is executed
and the boot process starts over. If this condition occurs, the
internal reset status bit (IRESS) is set in the CPU_SCR1
register.
In PSoC devices with more than 256 bytes of SRAM, no
SRAM is modified by the SWBootReset function in SRAM
pages numbered higher than ‘0’.
Table 4-4 documents the value of all the SRAM addresses in
Page 0 after a successful SWBootReset. A value of “xx”
indicates that the SRAM address is not modified by the
SWBootReset function. A hex value indicates that the
address should always have the indicated value after a successful SWBootReset. A “??” indicates that the value, after
a SWBootReset, is determined by the value of the IRAMDIS
bit in the CPU_SCR1 register. If IRAMDIS is not set, these
addresses will be initialized to 00h. If IRAMDIS is set, these
addresses will not be modified by a SWBootReset after a
watchdog reset.
The IRAMDIS bit allows the preservation of variables even if
a watchdog reset (WDR) occurs. The IRAMDIS bit is reset
by all system resets except watchdog reset. Therefore, this
bit is only useful for watchdog resets and not general resets.
The SROM function SWBootReset is responsible for transitioning the device from a reset state to running user code.
38
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Supervisory ROM (SROM)
Table 4-4. SRAM Map Post SWBootReset (00h)
Address
0x0_
0x1_
0x2_
0x3_
0x4_
0x5_
0x6_
0x7_
0x8_
0x9_
0xA_
0xB_
0xC_
0xD_
0xE_
0xF_
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
0x00
0x00
0x00
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
Address
Type
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
KEY1
0,F8h
RAM
3Ah
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
KEY2
0,F9h
RAM
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
Stack Pointer value+3, when SSC is
executed.
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
??
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
0x00
??
??
0x00
0x02
xx
0x00
0x00
0xn
xx
0x00
0x00
Address F8h is the return code byte for all SROM functions
(except Checksum and TableRead); for this function, the
only acceptable values are 00h and 02h. Address FCh is the
fail count variable. After POR (Power on Reset), WDR, or
XRES (External Reset), the variable is initialized to 00h by
the SROM. Each time the checksum fails, the fail count is
incremented. Therefore, if it takes two passes through
SWBootReset to get a good checksum, the fail count is 01h.
4.1.2.2
The HWBootReset function only requires that the CPU_A,
KEY1, and KEY2 be setup correctly. As with all other SROM
functions, if the setup is incorrect, the SROM executes a
HALT. Then, either a POR, XRES, or WDR is needed to
clear the HALT. See the System Resets chapter on
page 123 for more information.
HWBootReset Function
The HWBootReset function forces a hardware reset of the
PSoC. A hardware rest causes all registers to return to their
POR state. Then, the SROM SWBootReset function executes, followed by Flash code execution beginning at
address 0x0000.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Table 4-5. HWBootReset Parameters (0Fh)
Name
4.1.2.3
Description
ReadBlock Function
The ReadBlock function reads 64 contiguous bytes from
Flash: a block. The CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device has 8 KB
of Flash and therefore has 128 64-byte blocks. Valid block
IDs are 0x00 to 0x7F.
Table 4-6. Flash Memory Organization
PSoC Device
Amount of
Flash
Amount of
SRAM
Number of
Blocks
per Bank
Number of
Banks
8 KB
512 Bytes
128
1
CY8C20x34/24
The first thing the ReadBlock function does is to check the
protection bits to determine if the desired BLOCKID is readable. If read protection is turned on, the ReadBlock function
exits setting the accumulator and KEY2 back to 00h. KEY1
has a value of 01h indicating a read failure.
If read protection is not enabled, the function reads 64 bytes
from the Flash using a ROMX instruction and stores the
results in SRAM using an MVI instruction. The 64 bytes are
stored in SRAM, beginning at the address indicated by the
value of the POINTER parameter. When the ReadBlock
completes successfully, the accumulator, KEY1, and KEY2
will all have a value of 00h.
Note A MVI [expr], A is used to store the Flash block contents in SRAM; thus, you can the MVW_PP register to indicate which SRAM pages receive the data.
Table 4-7. ReadBlock Parameters (01h)
Name
Address
Type
MVW_PP
0,D5h
Register
Description
MVI write page pointer register
KEY1
0,F8h
RAM
3Ah
KEY2
0,F9h
RAM
Stack Pointer value+3, when SSC is
executed.
BLOCKID
0,FAh
RAM
Flash block number
POINTER
0,FBh
RAM
Addresses in SRAM where returned
data should be stored.
39
[+] Feedback
Supervisory ROM (SROM)
4.1.2.4
WriteBlock Function
The WriteBlock function stores data in the Flash. Data
moves 64 bytes at a time from SRAM to Flash using this
function. Before doing a write, you must successfully complete an EraseAll or an EraseBlock.
The first thing the WriteBlock function does is check the protection bits and determine if the desired BLOCKID is writeable. If write protection is turned on, the WriteBlock function
will exit, setting the accumulator and KEY2 back to 00h.
KEY1 will have a value of 01h, indicating a write failure.
Write protection is set when the PSoC device is programmed externally and cannot be changed through the
SSC function.
The BLOCKID of the Flash block, where the data is stored,
must be determined and stored at SRAM address FAh. Valid
block IDs are 0x00 to 0x7F.
An MVI A, [expr] instruction is used to move data from
SRAM into Flash. Therefore, the MVI read pointer (MVR_PP
register) can be used to specify which SRAM page data is
pulled from. Using the MVI read pointer and the parameter
blocks POINTER value allows the SROM WriteBlock function to move data from any SRAM page into any Flash
block.
The SRAM address, of the first of the 64 bytes to be stored
in Flash, must be indicated using the POINTER variable in
the parameter block (SRAM address FBh).
Finally, the CLOCK and DELAY value must be set correctly.
The CLOCK value determines the length of the write pulse
that will be used to store the data in the Flash. The CLOCK
and DELAY values are dependent on the CPU speed and
must be set correctly. Refer to “Clocking Strategy” on
page 42 for additional information.
Table 4-8. WriteBlock Parameters (02h)
Name
EraseBlock Function
The EraseBlock function is used to erase a block of 64 contiguous bytes in Flash.
The first thing the EraseBlock function does is check the
protection bits and determine if the desired BLOCKID is
writeable. If write protection is turned on, the EraseBlock
function exits, setting the accumulator and KEY2 back to
00h. KEY1 has a value of 01h, indicating a write failure.
To set up the parameter block for the EraseBlock function,
store the correct key values in KEY1 and KEY2. The block
number to erased must be stored in the BLOCKID variable,
and the CLOCK and DELAY values must be set based on
the current CPU speed. For more information on setting the
CLOCK and DELAY values, see “Clocking Strategy” on
page 42.
Table 4-9. EraseBlock Parameters (03h)
Address
Type
KEY1
Name
0,F8h
RAM
3Ah
KEY2
0,F9h
RAM
Stack Pointer value+3, when SSC is
executed.
BLOCKID
0,FAh
RAM
Flash block number
CLOCK
0,FCh
RAM
Clock divider used to set the erase
pulse width.
DELAY
0,FEh
RAM
For a CPU speed of 12 MHz set to
56h.
4.1.2.6
Description
ProtectBlock Function
The PSoC devices offer Flash protection on a block-byblock basis. Table 4-10 lists the protection modes available.
In the table, ER and EW are used to indicate the ability to
perform external reads and writes (that is, by an external
programmer). For internal writes, IW is used. Internal reading is always permitted by way of the ROMX instruction. The
ability to read by way of the SROM ReadBlock function is
indicated by SR.
Address
Type
MVR_PP
0,D4h
Register
KEY1
0,F8h
RAM
3Ah
In this table, note that all protection is removed by EraseAll.
KEY2
0,F9h
RAM
Stack Pointer value+3, when SSC is
executed.
Table 4-10. Protect Block Modes
BLOCKID
0,FAh
RAM
Flash block number
POINTER
0,FBh
RAM
First of 64 addresses in SRAM, where
the data to be stored in Flash is located
prior to calling WriteBlock.
CLOCK
DELAY
40
0,FCh
0,FEh
RAM
RAM
Description
4.1.2.5
MVI read page pointer register.
Clock divider used to set the write pulse
width.
Mode
Settings
Description
In PSoC Designer
00b
SR ER EW IW
Unprotected
U = Unprotected
01b
SR ER EW IW
Read protect
F = Factory upgrade
10b
SR ER EW IW
Disable external write
R = Field upgrade
11b
SR ER EW IW
Disable internal write
W = Full protection
For a CPU speed of 12 MHz set to 56h.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Supervisory ROM (SROM)
4.1.2.7
4.1.2.8
TableRead Function
The TableRead function gives the user access to part-specific data stored in the Flash during manufacturing. The
Flash for these tables is separate from the program Flash
and is not directly accessible.
One of the uses of the TableRead function is to retrieve the
values needed to optimize Flash programming for temperature. More information about how to use these values is in
the section titled “Clocking Strategy” on page 42.
EraseAll Function
The EraseAll function performs a series of steps that
destroys the user data in the Flash banks and resets the
protection block in each Flash bank to all zeros (the unprotected state). This function is only executed by an external
programmer. If EraseAll is executed from code, the M8C will
HALT without touching the Flash or protections. See
Table 4-11.
Table 4-11. Flash Tables with Assigned Values in Flash Bank 0
F8h
F9h
Table 0
Silicon ID
Table 1
Voltage
Reference Trim
for 3.3V
FAh
IMO Trim
for 3.3V
reg[1,E8]
reg[1,EA]
Table 2
Voltage
Reference Trim
for 2.7V
IMO Trim
12 MHz
Vdd = 2.7V
reg[1,EA]
Table 3
4.1.2.9
M (cold)
FBh
FDh
Room
Temperature
Calibration
for 3.3V
Hot
Temperature
Calibration
for 3.3V
Voltage
Reference Trim
for 5V
Room
Temperature
Calibration
for 2.7V
Hot
Temperature
Calibration
for 2.7V
IMO Slow Trim
6 MHz
Vdd = 3.3V
B (cold)
Mult (cold)
Checksum Function
The 16-bit checksum is returned in KEY1 and KEY2. The
parameter KEY1 holds the lower 8 bits of the checksum and
the parameter KEY2 holds the upper 8 bits of the checksum.
Table 4-12. Checksum Parameters (07h)
Address
Type
KEY1
0,F8h
RAM
3Ah
Description
KEY2
0,F9h
RAM
Stack Pointer value+3, when SSC is
executed.
BLOCKID
0,FAh
RAM
Number of Flash blocks to calculate
checksum on.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
FEh
Room
Temperature
Calibration
for 5V
IMO Trim
for 5V
reg[1,E8]
reg[1,EA]
M (hot)
The Checksum function calculates a 16-bit checksum over a
user specifiable number of blocks, within a single Flash
bank starting at block zero. The BLOCKID parameter is
used to pass in the number of blocks to checksum. A
BLOCKID value of ‘1’ calculates the checksum of only block
0, while a BLOCKID value of ‘0’ calculates the checksum of
the entire Flash bank.
Name
FCh
B (hot)
4.1.2.10
IMO Slow Trim
6 MHz
Vdd = 2.7V
Mult (hot)
FFh
Hot
Temperature
Calibration
for 5V
IMO Slow Trim
6 MHz
Vdd = 5.0V
00h
01h
Calibrate0 Function
The Calibrate0 function transfers the calibration values
stored in a special area of the Flash to their appropriate registers. This function may be executed at any time to set all
calibration values back to their 5V values. However, it is
unnecessary to call this function. This function is simply documented for completeness. 3.3V calibration values are
accessed by way of the TableRead function, which is
described in the section titled “TableRead Function” on
page 41.
Table 4-13. Calibrate0 Parameters (08h)
Address
Type
KEY1
Name
0,F8h
RAM
3Ah
Description
KEY2
0,F9h
RAM
Stack Pointer value+3, when SSC is
executed.
41
[+] Feedback
Supervisory ROM (SROM)
4.1.2.11
Calibrate1 Function
While the Calibrate1 function is a completely separate function from Calibrate0, they perform the same task, which is to
transfer the calibration values stored in a special area of the
Flash to their appropriate registers. What is unique about
Calibrate1 is that it calculates a checksum of the calibration
data and, if that checksum is determined as invalid,
Calibrate1 causes a hardware reset by generating an internal reset. If this occurs, it is indicated by setting the Internal
Reset Status bit (IRESS) in the CPU_SCR1 register.
The Calibrate1 function uses SRAM to calculate a checksum of the calibration data. The POINTER value is used to
indicate the address of a 30-byte buffer used by this function. When the function completes, the 30 bytes are set to
00h.
An MVI A, [expr] and an MVI [expr], A instruction are used to
move data between SRAM and Flash. Therefore, the MVI
write pointer (MVW_PP) and the MVI read pointer
(MVR_PP) must be specified to the same SRAM page to
control the page of RAM used for the operations.
Calibrate1 was created as a subfunction of SWBootReset
and the Calibrate1 function code was added to provide
direct access. For more information on how Calibrate1
works, see the “SWBootReset Function” on page 38.
This function may be executed at any time to set all calibration values back to their 5V values. However, it is unnecessary to call this function. This function is simply documented
for completeness. This function has no argument to select
between 5V and 3.3V calibration values; therefore, it always
defaults to 5V values. 3.3V calibration values are accessed
by way of the TableRead function, which is described in the
section titled “TableRead Function” on page 41.
Table 4-14. Calibrate1 Parameters (09h)
Address
Type
KEY1
Name
0,F8h
RAM
3Ah
Description
KEY2
0,F9h
RAM
Stack Pointer value+3, when SSC is
executed.
POINTER
0,FBh
RAM
First of 30 SRAM addresses used by
this function.
MVR_PP
0,D4h
Register
MVI write page pointer
MVW_PP
0,D5h
Register
MVI read page pointer
4.1.2.12
WriteAndVerify Function
The WriteAndVerify function works exactly the same as the
WriteBlock function with one exception. Once the write operation has completed, the SROM will then read back the contents of Flash and compare those values against the values
in SRAM thus verifying that the write was successful. The
write and verify is one SROM operation; therefore, the
SROM is not exited until the verify is completed.
42
The parameters for this block are identical to the WriteBlock
(see “WriteBlock Parameters (02h)” on page 40). If the verify
operation fails, the 0x04 error code will be returned at SRAM
address 0xF8. If the write fails, the 0x01 error code returns
at SRAM address 0xF8.
Table 4-15. WriteAndVerify Parameters (0Ah)
Name
Address
Type
Description
KEY1
0,F8h
RAM
3Ah
KEY2
0,F9h
RAM
Stack Pointer value+3, when SSC is
executed.
BLOCKID
0,FAh
RAM
Flash block number.
POINTER
0,FBh
RAM
First of 64 addresses in SRAM, where
the data to be stored in Flash is located
prior to calling WriteBlock.
CLOCK
0,FCh
RAM
Clock divider used to set the write pulse
width.
DELAY
0,FEh
RAM
For a CPU speed of 12 MHz set to 56h.
4.2
Register Definitions
This chapter has no register detail information because
there are no registers directly assigned to the Supervisory
ROM.
4.2.1
■
■
■
■
Related Registers
“STK_PP Register” on page 34.
“MVR_PP Register” on page 35.
“MVW_PP Register” on page 36.
“CPU_SCR1 Register” on page 108.
4.3
Clocking Strategy
Successful programming and erase operations, on the
Flash, require you to set the CLOCK and DELAY parameters correctly. To determine the proper value for the DELAY
parameter only, you must consider CPU speed. Use three
factors to determine the proper value for CLOCK: operating
temperature, CPU speed, and characteristics of the individual device. Equations and additional information on calculating the DELAY and CLOCK values follow.
4.3.1
DELAY Parameter
To determine the proper value for the DELAY parameter,
you must consider CPU speed during a Flash operation.
Equation 1 displays the equation for calculating DELAY
based on a CPU speed value. In this equation the units for
CPU are hertz (Hz).
–6
100 × 10 ⋅ CPU – 80
DELAY = ----------------------------------------------------------,
13
Equation 1
3MHz ≤ CPU ≤ 12MHz
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Supervisory ROM (SROM)
Equation 2 shows the calculation of the DELAY value for a
CPU speed of 12 MHz. The numerical result of this calculation should be rounded to the nearest whole number. In the
case of a 12 MHz CPU speed, the correct value for DELAY
is 86 (0x56).
–6
6
× 10 ⋅ 12 × 10 – 80
DELAY = 100
--------------------------------------------------------------13
4.3.2
Equation 2
CLOCK Parameter
The CLOCK parameter must be calculated using different
equations for erase and write operations. The erase value
for CLOCK must be calculated first. In Equation 3, the erase
CLOCK value is indicated by a subscript E after the word
CLOCK. In Equation 5, the write CLOCK value is indicated
by a subscript W after the word CLOCK.
Before either CLOCK value can be calculated, the values for
M, B, and Mult must be determined. These are device specific values that are stored in the Flash Table 3 and are
accessed by way of the TableRead SROM function (see the
“TableRead Function” on page 41). If the operating temperature is at or below 0°C, use the cold values. For operating
temperatures at or above 0°C, use the hot values. See
Table 4-11 for more information.
2M ⋅ T
CLOCK E = B – ---------------256
Equation 3
Using the correct values for B, M, and T, in the equation
above, is required to achieve the endurance specifications
of the Flash. However, for device programmers where this
calculation is difficult to perform, the equation is simplified by
setting T to 0°C and using the hot value for B and M. This
simplification is acceptable only if the total number of erase
write cycles are kept to less than 10 and the operation is
performed near room temperature. When T is set to ‘0’,
Equation 3 simplifies to.
CLOCK E = B
Equation 4
Once a value for the erase CLOCK value is determined, the
write CLOCK value can be calculated. The equation to calculate the CLOCK value for a write is.
CLOCK E ⋅ Mult
CLOCK W = ---------------------------------------64
Equation 5
In this equation, the correct value for Mult must be determined, based upon temperature, in the same way that the B
and M values were determined for Equation 3.
Equations for calculating the correct value of CLOCK for
write operations are first introduced with the assumption that
the CPU speed is 12 MHz. The equation for calculating the
CLOCK value for an erase Flash operation is shown in
Equation 3. In this equation the T has units of °C.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
43
[+] Feedback
Supervisory ROM (SROM)
44
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
5. Interrupt Controller
This chapter presents the Interrupt Controller and its associated registers. The interrupt controller provides a mechanism for a
hardware resource in PSoC mixed-signal array devices, to change program execution to a new address without regard to the
current task being performed by the code being executed. For a complete table of the Interrupt Controller registers, refer to
the “Summary Table of the Core Registers” on page 24. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to
the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
5.1
Architectural Description
A block diagram of the PSoC Interrupt Controller is shown in Figure 5-1, illustrating the concepts of posted interrupts and
pending interrupts.
Figure 5-1. Interrupt Controller Block Diagram
Priority
Encoder
Interrupt Taken
or
Interrupt Vector
INT_CLRx:n Write
Posted
Interrupt
M8C Core
Interrupt
Source
(Timer,
GPIO, etc.)
D
... ...
R
1
Interrupt
Request
Pending
Interrupt
Q
CPU_F[0]
GIE
INT_MSKx
Mask Bit Setting
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
45
[+] Feedback
Interrupt Controller
The sequence of events that occur during interrupt processing are.
1. An interrupt becomes active, either because (a) the
interrupt condition occurs (for example, a timer expires),
(b) a previously posted interrupt is enabled through an
update of an interrupt mask register, or (c) an interrupt is
pending and GIE is set from ‘0’ to ‘1’ in the CPU Flag
register.
2. The current executing instruction finishes.
3. The internal interrupt routine executes, taking 13 cycles.
During this time, these actions occur:
■ The PCH, PCL, and Flag register (CPU_F) are
pushed onto the stack (in that order).
■ The CPU_F register is then cleared. Since this clears
the GIE bit to ‘0’, additional interrupts are temporarily
disabled.
■ The PCH (PC[15:8]) is cleared to zero.
■ The interrupt vector is read from the interrupt controller and its value is placed into PCL (PC[7:0]). This
sets the program counter to point to the appropriate
address in the interrupt table (for example, 001Ch for
the GPIO interrupt).
4. Program execution vectors to the interrupt table. Typically, a LJMP instruction in the interrupt table sends execution to the user's interrupt service routine (ISR) for this
interrupt. (See “Instruction Set Summary” on page 26.)
5. The ISR executes. Note that interrupts are disabled
since GIE = 0. In the ISR, interrupts can be re-enabled if
desired by setting GIE = 1 (take care to avoid stack overflow in this case).
6. The ISR ends with a RETI instruction. This pops the Flag
register, PCL, and PCH from the stack, restoring those
registers. The restored Flag register re-enables interrupts since GIE = 1 again.
7. Execution resumes at the next instruction, after the one
that occurred before the interrupt. However, if there are
more pending interrupts, the subsequent interrupts are
processed before the next normal program instruction.
Interrupt Latency. The time between the assertion of an
enabled interrupt and the start of its ISR is calculated using
this equation:
For example, if the 5-cycle JMP instruction is executing
when an interrupt becomes active, the total number of CPU
clock cycles before the ISR begins are:
(1 to 5 cycles for JMP to finish) + Equation 2
(13 cycles for interrupt routine) +
(7 cycles for LJMP) = 21 to 25 cycles.
In the example above, at 24 MHz, 25 clock cycles take
1.042 μs.
Interrupt Priority. Interrupt priorities only come into consideration if more than one interrupt is pending during the same
instruction cycle. In this case, the priority encoder (see
Figure 5-1) generates an interrupt vector for the highest
pendingpriority interrupt.
5.1.1
Posted versus Pending Interrupts
An interrupt is posted when its interrupt conditions occur.
This results in the flip-flop in Figure 5-1 clocking in a ‘1’. The
interrupt remains posted until the interrupt is taken or until it
is cleared by writing to the appropriate INT_CLRx register.
A posted interrupt is not pending unless it is enabled by setting its interrupt mask bit (in the appropriate INT_MSKx register). All pending interrupts are processed by the Priority
Encoder to determine the highest priority interrupt which is
taken by the M8C if the Global Interrupt Enable bit is set in
the CPU_F register.
Disabling an interrupt by clearing its interrupt mask bit (in
the INT_MSKx register) does not clear a posted interrupt,
nor does it prevent an interrupt from being posted. It simply
prevents a posted interrupt from becoming pending.
It is especially important to understand the functionality of
clearing posted interrupts, if the configuration of the PSoC
device is changed by the application.
For example, if a block has a posted interrupt when it is
enabled, and then disabled, the posted interrupt remains. It
is good practice to use the INT_CLR register to clear posted
interrupts before enabling or re-enabling a block.
Equation 1
Latency =
Time for current instruction to finish +
Time for M8C to change program counter to interrupt address +
Time for LJMP instruction in interrupt table to execute.
46
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Interrupt Controller
5.2
Application Overview
The interrupt controller and its associated registers allow the
user’s code to respond to an interrupt from almost every
functional block in the PSoC devices. Interrupts for all the
digital blocks and each of the analog columns are available,
as well as interrupts for supply voltage, sleep, variable
clocks, and a general GPIO (pin) interrupt.
The registers associated with the interrupt controller allow
interrupts to be disabled either globally or individually. The
registers also provide a mechanism by which a user can
clear all pending and posted interrupts, or clear individual
posted or pending interrupts. A software mechanism is provided to set individual interrupts. Setting an interrupt by way
of software is very useful during code development, when
one may not have the complete hardware system necessary
to generate a real interrupt.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
This table lists the interrupts and priorities that are available
in the PSoC devices.
Table 5-1. PSoC Device Interrupt Table
Interrupt
Priority
Interrupt
Address
0 (Highest)
0000h
Reset
1
0004h
Supply Voltage Monitor
2
0008h
Analog
3
000Ch
CapSense
4
0010h
Timer
5
0014h
GPIO
6
0018h
SPI
7
001Ch
I2C
8 (Lowest)
0020h
Sleep Timer
Interrupt Name
47
[+] Feedback
Interrupt Controller
5.3
Register Definitions
These registers are associated with the Interrupt Controller and are listed in address order. The register descriptions have an
associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. The grayed out bits in the tables are reserved bits and are
not detailed in the register descriptions that follow. Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For a complete table of Interrupt Controller registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the Core Registers” on page 24.
5.3.1
Address
0,DAh
INT_CLR0 Registers
Name
INT_CLR0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
I2C
Sleep
SPI
GPIO
Timer
CapSense
Analog
V Monitor
RW : 00
The Interrupt Clear Register 0 (INT_CLR0) is used to enable
the individual interrupt sources’ ability to clear posted interrupts.
The INT_CLR0 register is similar to the INT_MSK0 register
in that it holds a bit for each interrupt source. Functionally
the INT_CLR0 register is similar to the INT_VC register,
although its operation is completely independent. When the
INT_CLR0 register is read, any bits that are set indicates an
interrupt has been posted for that hardware resource.
Therefore, reading this register gives the user the ability to
determine all posted interrupts.
Bit 7: I2C. This bit allows posted I2C interrupts to be read,
cleared, or set.
Bit 6: Sleep. This bit allows posted sleep interrupts to be
read, cleared, or set.
Bit 5: SPI. This bit allows posted SPI interrupts to be read,
cleared, or set.
Bit 4: GPIO. This bit allows posted GPIO interrupts to be
read, cleared, or set.
The Enable Software Interrupt (ENSWINT) bit in the
INT_SW_EN register determines the way an individual bit
value, written to an INT_CLR0 register, is interpreted. When
ENSWINT is cleared (the default state), writing 1's to the
INT_CLR0 register has no effect. However, writing 0's to the
INT_CLR0 register, when ENSWINT is cleared, will cause
the corresponding interrupt to clear. If the ENSWINT bit is
set, any 0's written to the INT_CLR0 register is ignored.
However, 1's written to the INT_CLR0 register, while
ENSWINT is set, will cause an interrupt to post for the corresponding interrupt.
Bit 3: Timer. This bit allows posted Timer interrupts to be
read, cleared, or set.
Software interrupts can aid in debugging interrupt service
routines by eliminating the need to create system level interactions that are sometimes necessary to create a hardwareonly interrupt.
For additional information, refer to the INT_CLR0 register on
page 170.
48
Bit 2: CapSense. This bit allows posted CapSense interrupts to be read, cleared, or set.
Bit 1: Analog. This bit allows posted analog interrupts to
be read, cleared, or set.
Bit 0: V Monitor. This bit allows posted voltage monitor
interrupts to be read, cleared, or set.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Interrupt Controller
5.3.2
Address
0,E0h
INT_MSK0 Register
Name
INT_MSK0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
I2C
Sleep
SPI
GPIO
Timer
CapSense
Analog
V Monitor
RW : 00
The Interrupt Mask Register (INT_MSK0) is used to enable
the individual interrupt sources’ ability to create pending
interrupts.
If cleared, each bit in an INT_MSK0 register prevents a
posted interrupt from becoming a pending interrupt (input to
the priority encoder). However, an interrupt can still post
even if its mask bit is zero. All INT_MSK0 bits are independent of all other INT_MSK0 bits.
If an INT_MSK0 bit is set, the interrupt source associated
with that mask bit may generate an interrupt that will
become a pending interrupt. For example, if INT_MSK0[4] is
set and at least one GPIO pin is configured to generate an
interrupt, the interrupt controller will allow a GPIO interrupt
request to post and become a pending interrupt for the M8C
to respond to. If a higher priority interrupt is generated
before the M8C responds to the GPIO interrupt, the higher
priority interrupt is responded to before the GPIO interrupt.
Each interrupt source may require configuration at a block
level. Refer to the corresponding chapter for each interrupt
for any additional configuration information.
Bit 6: Sleep. This bit allows sleep interrupts to be enabled
or masked.
Bit 5: SPI. This bit allows SPI interrupts to be enabled or
masked.
Bit 4: GPIO. This bit allows GPIO interrupts to be enabled
or masked.
Bit 3: Timer. This bit allows Timer interrupts to be enabled
or masked.
Bit 2: CapSense. This bit allows CapSense interrupts to be
enabled or masked.
Bit 1: Analog. This bit allows analog interrupts to be
enabled or masked.
Bit 0: V Monitor. This bit allows voltage monitor interrupts
to be enabled or masked.
For additional information, refer to the INT_MSK0 register
on page 172.
Bit 7: I2C. This bit allows I2C interrupts to be enabled or
masked.
5.3.3
Address
0,E1h
INT_SW_EN Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
INT_SW_EN
The Interrupt Software Enable Register (INT_SW_EN) is
used to enable software interrupts.
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
ENSWINT
RW : 00
Bit 0: ENSWINT. This bit is a special non-mask bit that
controls the behavior of the INT_CLR0 register. See the
INT_CLR0 register in this section for more information.
For additional information, refer to the INT_SW_EN register
on page 173.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
49
[+] Feedback
Interrupt Controller
5.3.4
Address
0,E2h
INT_VC Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
INT_VC
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Pending Interrupt[7:0]
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RC : 00
LEGEND
C Clearable register or bits.
The Interrupt Vector Clear Register (INT_VC) returns the
next pending interrupt and clears all pending interrupts
when written.
Bits 7 to 0: Pending Interrupt[7:0]. When the register is
read, the least significant byte (LSB) of the highest priority
pending interrupt is returned. For example, if the GPIO and
I2C interrupts were pending and the INT_VC register was
read, the value 14h is read. However, if no interrupts were
pending, the value 00h is returned. This is the reset vector in
the interrupt table; however, reading 00h from the INT_VC
register should not be considered an indication that a system reset is pending. Rather, reading 00h from the INT_VC
register simply indicates that there are no pending interrupts. The highest priority interrupt, indicated by the value
5.3.5
■
50
returned by a read of the INT_VC register, is removed from
the list of pending interrupts when the M8C services an
interrupt.
Reading the INT_VC register has limited usefulness. If interrupts are enabled, a read to the INT_VC register would not
be able to determine that an interrupt was pending before
the interrupt was actually taken. However, while in an interrupt service routine, a user may wish to read the INT_VC
register to see what the next interrupt are. When the
INT_VC register is written, with any value, all pending and
posted interrupts are cleared by asserting the clear line for
each interrupt.
For additional information, refer to the INT_VC register on
page 174.
Related Registers
“CPU_F Register” on page 30.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
6. General Purpose IO (GPIO)
This chapter discusses the General Purpose IO (GPIO) and its associated registers, which is the circuit responsible for interfacing to the IO pins of a PSoC device. The GPIO blocks provide the interface between the M8C core and the outside world.
They offer a large number of configurations to support several types of input/output (IO) operations for both digital and analog
systems. For a complete table of the GPIO registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the Core Registers” on page 24. For a
quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
6.1
Architectural Description
The GPIO in the CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device is uniform,
except the Port 1 GPIO has stronger high drive and an
option for regulated output level. These distinctions are discussed in more detail in the section “Port 1 Distinctions” on
page 52.
IO Ports are arranged with (up to) 8 bits per port. Each full
port contains eight identical GPIO blocks. Each GPIO block
can be used for the following types of IO:
6.1.1
Each IO pin also has several drive modes, as well as interrupt capabilities. All GPIO pins provide both digital IO and
analog input capability.
■
■
General Description
The GPIO contains input buffers, output drivers, and configuration logic for connecting the PSoC device to the outside
world.
Digital IO (digital input and output controlled by software)
Analog IO
Figure 6-1. GPIO Block Diagram
0.
Drive Modes
1.
2.
3.
Diagram
DM1 DM0 Drive Mode
Number Data = 0 Data = 1
0
0
Resistive Pull Up
0
StrongResistive
0
1
Strong Drive
1
StrongStrong
1
0
High Impedance Analog 2
Hi-ZHi-Z
1
1
Open DrainLow
3
StrongHi-Z
Read PRTxDR
Vdd
Data
Bus
LDO
REG_EN
Port 1
Only
DM(1:0)=10b
Alt. Input
(e.g., I2C)
Write PRTxDR
Alt. Data
INBUF
(to GPIO
interrupt logic)
2:1
Alt. Select
Note Alt. Select/
Data is not available
on all pins.
Vdd
DM1
Vdd
Drive
Logic
5.6k
DM0
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Pin
51
[+] Feedback
General Purpose IO (GPIO)
All IO contain the capability to connect to an internal analog
bus. This is described in detail in the IO Analog
Multiplexer chapter on page 81.
Certain pins contain an option to bypass the normal data
path and output from an internal source. An example is I2C
outputs. These are described in “Data Bypass” on page 54.
6.1.2
Digital IO
One of the basic operations of the GPIO ports is to allow the
M8C to send information out of the PSoC device and get
information into the M8C from outside the PSoC device.
This is accomplished by way of the port data register
(PRTxDR). Writes from the M8C to the PRTxDR register
store the data state, one bit per GPIO. In the standard nonbypass mode, the pin drivers drive the pin in response to
this data bit, with a drive strength determined by the Drive
mode setting. The actual voltage on the pin depends upon
the Drive mode and the external load.
The M8C reads the value of a port by reading the PRTxDR
register address. When the M8C reads the PRTxDR register
address, the current value of the pin voltage is translated
into a logic value and returned to the M8C. Note that the pin
voltage can represent a different logic value than the last
value written to the PRTxDR register. This is an important
distinction to remember in situations such as the use of a
read modify write to a PRTxDR register. Examples of read
modify write instructions include AND, OR, and XOR.
Here is an example of how a read modify write, to a
PRTxDR register, could have an unexpected and even indeterminate result in certain systems. Consider a scenario
where all bits of Port 1 on the PSoC device are in the strong
0 resistive 1 Drive mode; so that in some cases, the system
the PSoC is in may pull down one of the bits by an external
driver.
mov
and
reg[PRT1DR], 0xFF
reg[PRT1DR], 0x7F
In the first line of code above, writing a 0xFF to the port
causes the PSoC to drive all pins high through a resistor.
This does not affect any bits that happen to be strongly
driven low by the system the PSoC is in. However, in the
second line of code, it cannot guarantee that only bit 7 is the
one set to a strong 0 (zero). Because the AND instruction
will first read the port, any bits that are currently driven low
externally will be read as a ‘0’. These zeros will then be written back to the port. When this happens, the pin will go in to
a strong 0 state; therefore, if the external low drive condition
ends in the system, the PSoC will keep the pin value at a
logic 0.
6.1.3
Analog and Digital Inputs
Analog signals can pass into the PSoC device core from
PSoC device pins through a resistive path. For analog signals, the GPIO block is typically configured into a High
Impedance Analog Drive mode (High-Z). This mode turns
off the Schmitt trigger on the input path, which may reduce
power consumption and decrease internal switching noise
when using a particular IO as an analog input.
All modes, except High Impedance Analog, allow digital
inputs. The most useful digital input modes are Resistive
Pull Up (DM1, DM0 = 00b with Data = 1) or a fully high
impedance input using open drain (DM1, DM0 = 11b with
Data = 1).
6.1.4
Port 1 Distinctions
Port 1 has two differences from the other GPIO ports. It has
stronger high drive and it has an option for regulating all outputs to a 3V level when in strong drive mode. Refer to the
device datasheet for the different current sourcing specifications of Port 1.
By setting the REG_EN bit in the IO_CFG register, Port 1
can be configured to drive strong high to a regulated 3V
level, when device Vdd is above 3V. If REG_EN is set low,
Port 1 pins drive to Vdd in strong drive mode.
In Resistive High Drive mode ([DM1, DM0] = 00), the pins
pull up to the chip Vdd level regardless of the regulator setting for this port. Only Strong Drive mode allows for the outputs to be driven to the regulated level. When the REG_EN
bit is set high, pins configured for strong drive will drive to
3V, while those in resistive pull-up mode will drive to Vdd.
6.1.5
GPIO Block Interrupts
Each GPIO pin can be individually configured for interrupt
capability. Pins are configured by pin interrupt enables and
also by a chip-wide selection for interrupt state with this global selection. Pins can be set to interrupt when the pin is low
or when it changes from the last time it was read. The block
provides an open-drain interrupt output (INTO) that is connected to other GPIO blocks in a wire-OR fashion.
All pin interrupts that are wire-OR’ed together are tied to the
same system GPIO interrupt. Therefore, if interrupts are
enabled on multiple pins, the user’s interrupt service routine
must provide a mechanism to determine which pin was the
source of the interrupt.
Using a GPIO interrupt requires the following steps:
1. Set the Interrupt mode (IOINT bit in the IO_CFG register).
2. Enable the bit interrupt in the GPIO block.
3. Set the mask bit for the (global) GPIO interrupt.
4. Assert the overall Global Interrupt Enable.
The first step sets a common interrupt mode for all pins.
52
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
General Purpose IO (GPIO)
The second step, bit interrupt enable, is set at the GPIO pin
level (that is, at each port pin), by way of the PRTxIE registers.
The last two steps are common to all interrupts and are
described in the Interrupt Controller chapter on page 45.
At the GPIO block level, asserting the INTO line depends
only on the bit interrupt enable and the state of the pin relative to the chosen Interrupt mode. At the PSoC device level,
due to their wire-OR nature, the GPIO interrupts are neither
true edge-sensitive interrupts nor true level-sensitive interrupts. They are considered edge-sensitive for asserting, but
level-sensitive for release of the wire-OR interrupt line.
If no GPIO interrupts are asserting, a GPIO interrupt will
occur whenever a GPIO pin interrupt enable is set and the
GPIO pin transitions (if not already transitioned) appropriately high or low to match the interrupt mode configuration.
Once this happens, the INTO line will pull low to assert the
GPIO interrupt. This assumes the other system-level
enables are on, such as setting the global GPIO interrupt
enable and the Global Interrupt Enable. Setting the pin interrupt enable may immediately assert INTO, if the Interrupt
mode conditions are already being met at the pin.
Once INTO pulls low, it will continue to hold INTO low until
one of these conditions change: (a) the pin interrupt enable
is cleared; (b) the voltage at pin transitions to the opposite
state; (c) in interrupt-on-change mode, the GPIO data register is read thus setting the local interrupt level to the opposite state; or (d) the Interrupt mode is changed so that the
current pin state does not create an interrupt. Once one of
these conditions is met, the INTO releases. At this point,
another GPIO pin (or this pin again) could assert its INTO
pin, pulling the common line low to assert a new interrupt.
Note the following behavior from this level-release feature. If
one pin is asserting INTO and then a second pin asserts its
INTO, when the first pin releases its INTO, the second pin is
already driving INTO and thus no change is seen (that is, no
new interrupt would be asserted on the GPIO interrupt).
Care must be taken, using polling or the states of the GPIO
pin and Global Interrupt Enables, to catch all interrupts
among a set of wire-OR GPIO blocks.
Figure 6-2 shows the interrupt logic portion of the block.
Figure 6-2. GPIO Interrupt Logic Diagram
IE (PRTxIE.n)
INBUF (from GPIO Block Diagram)
INTO
IOINT
Interrupt Mode
D
Q
Port Read
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
IE
IOINT
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Interrupt
Disabled
Disabled
Low
Change from last read
53
[+] Feedback
General Purpose IO (GPIO)
6.1.5.1
Interrupt Modes
Figure 6-3. GPIO Interrupt Mode IOINT = 1
GPIO interrupts use the IOINT bit from the IO_CFG register.
The setting of IOINT determines the interrupt mode for all
GPIO.
Last Value Read From Pin was ‘0’
Pin State Waveform
(a)
Interrupt mode IOINT=0 means that the block will assert the
GPIO interrupt line (INTO) when the pin voltage is low, providing the block’s bit interrupt enable line is set (high).
Interrupt mode IOINT=1 means that the block will assert the
interrupt line (INTO) when the pin voltage is the opposite of
the last state read from the pin, providing the block’s bit
interrupt enable line is set high. This mode switches
between low mode and high mode, depending on the last
value that was read from the port during reads of the data
register (PRTxDR). If the last value read from the GPIO was
‘0’, the GPIO pin will subsequently be in Interrupt High
mode. If the last value read from the GPIO was ‘1’, the GPIO
will then be in Interrupt Low mode.
GPIO pin
interrupt
enable set
Pin State Waveform
(b)
Interrupt
occurs
GPIO pin
interrupt
enable set
Interrupt
occurs
Last Value Read From Pin was ‘1’
Pin State Waveform
(c)
GPIO pin
interrupt
enable set
Pin State Waveform
(d)
Interrupt
occurs
GPIO pin
interrupt
enable set
Interrupt
occurs
Table 6-1. GPIO Interrupt Modes
IE
IOINT
0
0
Bit interrupt disabled, INTO de-asserted
Description
0
1
Bit interrupt disabled, INTO de-asserted
1
0
Assert INTO when PIN = low
1
1
Assert INTO when PIN = change from last read
Figure 6-3 assumes that the GIE is set, GPIO interrupt mask
is set, and that the IOINT bit has been set to high. The
Change Interrupt mode relies on the value of an internal
read register to determine if the pin state has changed.
Therefore, the port that contains the GPIO in question must
be read during every interrupt service routine. If the port is
not read, the Interrupt mode will act as if it is in high mode
when the latch value is ‘0’ and low mode when the latch
value is ‘1’.
6.1.6
Data Bypass
GPIO pins can be configured to either output data through
CPU writes to the PRTxDR registers, or to bypass the port's
data register and output data from internal functions instead.
The bypass path is shown in Figure 6-1 by the Alt Data
input, which is selected by the Alt Select input. These data
bypass options are selected in one of two ways.
For internal functions such as I2C and SPI, the hardware
automatically selects the bypass mode for the required pins
when the function is enabled. In addition, some bypass outputs are selected by the user through the OUT_P1 register.
For these, the pin is configured for data bypass when the
register bit is set high, which allows an internal signal to be
driven to the pin.
For all bypass modes, the desired drive mode of the pin
must be configured separately for each pin, with the
PRTxDM1 and PRTxDM0 registers.
54
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
General Purpose IO (GPIO)
6.2
Register Definitions
The following registers are associated with the General Purpose IO (GPIO) and are listed in address order. The register
descriptions have an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. The bits in the tables that are grayed
out are reserved bits and are not detailed in the register descriptions that follow. Reserved bits should always be written with
a value of ‘0’. For a complete table of GPIO registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the Core Registers” on page 24.
For a selected GPIO block, the individual registers are addressed in the “Summary Table of the Core Registers” on page 24.
In the register names, the ‘x’ is the port number, configured at the PSoC device level (x = 0 to 7 typically). All register values
are readable, except for the PRTxDR register; reads of this register return the pin state instead of the register bit state.
6.2.1
Address
0,xxh
PRTxDR Registers
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
PRTxDR
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Data[7:0]
Access
RW : 00
LEGEND
xx An “x” after the comma in the address field indicates that there are multiple instances of the register. For an expanded address listing of these registers,
refer to the “Core Register Summary” on page 24.
The Port Data Register (PRTxDR) allows for write or read
access of the current logical equivalent of the voltage on the
pin.
Reading the PRTxDR register returns the actual pin state,
as seen by the input buffer. This may not be the same as the
expected output state, if the load pulls the pin more strongly
than the pin’s configured output drive. See “Digital IO” on
page 52 for a detailed discussion of digital IO.
Bits 7 to 0: Data[7:0]. Writing the PRTxDR register bits set
the output drive state for the pin to high (for Data = 1) or low
(Data = 0), unless a bypass mode is selected (see “Data
Bypass” on page 54).
6.2.2
Address
0,xxh
For additional information, refer to the PRTxDR register on
page 138.
PRTxIE Registers
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
PRTxIE
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Interrupt Enables[7:0]
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RW : 00
LEGEND
xx An “x” after the comma in the address field indicates that there are multiple instances of the register. For an expanded address listing of these registers,
refer to the “Core Register Summary” on page 24.
The Port Interrupt Enable Register (PRTxIE) is used to
enable/disable interrupts from individual GPIO pins.
Bits 7 to 0: Interrupt Enables[7:0]. A ‘1’ enables the INTO
output at the block and a ‘0’ disables INTO so it is only HighZ. In the enabled state, the type of GPIO edge that actually
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
causes an interrupt is set by the IOINT bit in the IO_CFG
register.
For additional information, refer to the PRTxIE register on
page 139.
55
[+] Feedback
General Purpose IO (GPIO)
6.2.3
Address
PRTxDMx Registers
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
1,xxh
PRTxDM0
Drive Mode 0[7:0]
RW : 00
1,xxh
PRTxDM1
Drive Mode 1[7:0]
RW : FF
LEGEND
xx An “x” after the comma in the address field indicates that there are multiple instances of the register. For an expanded address listing of these registers,
refer to the “Core Register Summary” on page 24.
The Port Drive Mode Bit Registers (PRTxDM0 and
PRTxDM1) are used to specify the Drive mode for GPIO
pins.
rupt. (It is not strictly required that a High-Z mode be
selected for analog operation.)
When digital inputs are needed on the same pin as analog
inputs, the 11b Drive mode should be used with the corresponding data bit (in the PRTxDR register) set high.
Bits 7 to 0: Drive Mode x[7:0]. In the PRTxDMx registers
there are four possible drive modes for each port pin. Two
mode bits are required to select one of these modes, and
these two bits are spread into two different registers
(PRTxDM0 and PRTxDM1). The bit position of the effected
port pin (for example, Pin[2] in Port 0) is the same as the bit
position of each of the two drive mode register bits that control the Drive mode for that pin (for example, bit[2] in
PRT0DM0 and bit[2] in PRT0DM1). The two bits from the
two registers are treated as a group. These are referred to
as DM1 and DM0, or together as DM[1:0]. Drive modes are
shown in the table shown below.
Drive
Modes
DM1
Address
1,DCh
0
0
Resistive pull up
0
1
Strong drive
Resistive high, strong low
Strong high, strong low
1
0
High impedance,
analog (reset state)
High-Z high and low, digital input disabled (for zero power) (reset state)
1
1
Open drain low
High-Z high (digital input enabled),
strong low.
For additional information, refer to the PRTxDM0 register on
page 180, and the PRTxDM1 register on page 181.
IO_CFG Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
IO_CFG
The Input/Output Configuration Register (IO_CFG) is used
to configure the Port 1 output regulator and set the Interrupt
mode for all GPIO.
Bit 1: REG_EN. The Register Enable bit (REG_EN) controls the regulator on Port 1 outputs.
56
Description
The GPIO provides a default Drive mode of high impedance, analog (High-Z). This is achieved by forcing the reset
state of all PRTxDM1 registers to FFh.
For analog IO, the Drive mode should be set to the High-Z
analog mode, 10b. The 10b mode disables the block’s digital input buffer so no crowbar current flows, even when the
analog input is not close to either power rail. If the 10b Drive
mode is used, the pin will always be read as a zero by the
CPU and the pin will not be able to generate a useful inter-
6.2.4
Pin State
DM0
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
REG_EN
IOINT
RW : 00
Bit 0: IOINT. This bit sets the GPIO Interrupt mode for all
pins in the CY8C20x34/24 PSoC devices. GPIO interrupts
are controlled at each pin by the PRTxIE registers, and also
by the global GPIO bit in the INT_MSK0 register.
For additional information, refer to the IO_CFG register on
page 184.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
7. Internal Main Oscillator (IMO)
This chapter presents the Internal Main Oscillator (IMO) and its associated register. The IMO produces clock signals of 6 MHz
and 12 MHz. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on
page 137.
7.1
Architectural Description
The Internal Main Oscillator (IMO) outputs two clocks: a
SYSCLK (that can be the internal 6/12 MHz clock or an
external clock) and a 12/24 MHz clock called SYSCLKx2
that runs at twice the SYSCLK frequency. In the absence of
a high-precision input source from a crystal oscillator, the
accuracy of the internal 6/12 MHz clocks will be ±5% over
temperature and voltage variation for the 4.75V to 5.25V or
the 3.0V to 3.6V voltage ranges. The accuracy will be ±8.3%
over temperature and voltage variation in the 2.4V to 3.0V
range. This accuracy is only achieved in the selected voltage range. No external components are required to achieve
this level of accuracy.
The IMO can be disabled when using an external clocking
source. Registers for controlling these operations are found
in the Digital Clocks chapter on page 89.
Lower frequency SYSCLK settings are available by setting
the Slow IMO (SLIMO) bit in the CPU_SCR1 register. With
this bit set and the corresponding factory trim value applied
to the IMO_TR register, SYSCLK can be lowered to 6 MHz.
This offers lower device power consumption for systems
that can operate with the reduced system clock. Slow IMO
mode is discussed further in the “Application Overview” on
page 57.
7.2
Application Overview
To save power, the IMO frequency can be reduced from 12
MHz to 6 MHz using the SLIMO bit in the CPU_SCR1 register, in conjunction with the Trim values in the IMO_TR register. Both methods are described below.
7.2.1
Trimming the IMO
An 8-bit register (IMO_TR) is used to trim the IMO. Bit 0 is
the LSB and bit 7 is the MSB. The trim step size is approximately 80 kHz.
A factory trim setting is loaded into the IMO_TR register at
boot time for 4.75V to 5.25V operation. For operation in the
voltage ranges below 4.75V, user code must modify the contents of this register with values stored in Flash bank 0 as
shown in Table 4-11 on page 41. This is done with a Table
Read command to the Supervisory ROM.
7.2.2
Engaging Slow IMO
Forcing the CPU_SCR1 register bit 4 high engages the
Slow IMO feature. The IMO will immediately drop to a lower
frequency. Factory trim settings are stored in Flash bank 0
as shown in Table 4-11 on page 41 for the following voltage/
frequency combinations.
Table 7-1. Slow IMO
Voltage
Normal IMO
Frequency
Slow IMO
Frequency
4.75V to 5.25 V
12 MHz
6 MHz
3.0V to 3.3V
12 MHz
6 MHz
2.4V to 3.0V
12 MHz
6 MHz
A TableRead command to the Supervisory ROM is performed to set the IMO to the different frequencies. See the
“TableRead Function” on page 41.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
57
[+] Feedback
Internal Main Oscillator (IMO)
7.3
Register Definitions
The following register is associated with the Internal Main Oscillator (IMO). The register description has an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register.
7.3.1
Address
1,E8h
IMO_TR Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
IMO_TR
The Internal Main Oscillator Trim Register (IMO_TR) is used
to manually center the oscillator’s output to a target frequency.
The PSoC device specific value for 5.0V operation is loaded
into the IMO_TR register at boot time. The Internal Main
Oscillator will operate within specified tolerance over a voltage range of 4.75V to 5.25V, with no modification of this register. If the PSoC device is operated at a lower voltage, user
code must modify the contents of this register. For operation
in the voltage range of 3.3V ±0.3V or 2.7V ±0.3V, this is
accomplished with a TableRead command to the Supervisory ROM, which will supply a trim value for operation in this
range. For operation between these voltage ranges, user
code can interpolate the best value using both available factory trim values.
7.3.2
■
■
58
Bit 4
Bit 3
Trim[7:0]
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
W : 00
It is strongly recommended that the user not alter the
register value, unless Slow IMO mode is used.
Bits 7 to 0: Trim[7:0]. These bits are used to trim the Internal Main Oscillator. A larger value in this register increases
the speed of the oscillator.
For additional information, refer to the IMO_TR register on
page 190.
Related Registers
“OSC_CR2 Register” on page 94.
“CPU_SCR1 Register” on page 108.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
8. Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO)
This chapter briefly explains the Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO) and its associated register. The Internal Low Speed
Oscillator produces a 32 kHz clock. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register
Reference chapter on page 137.
8.1
Architectural Description
The Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO) is an oscillator with a nominal frequency of 32 kHz. It is used to generate sleep wakeup interrupts and watchdog resets. This oscillator can also be used as a clocking source for the digital PSoC blocks.
The oscillator operates in three modes: normal power, low power, and off. The Normal Power mode consumes more current
to produce a more accurate frequency. The Low Power mode is always used when the part is in a power down (sleep) state.
8.2
Register Definitions
The following register is associated with the Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO). The register description has an associated
register table showing the bit structure. The bits in the table that are grayed out are reserved bits and are not detailed in the
register description that follows. Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’.
8.2.1
ILO_TR Register
Address
Name
1,E9h
ILO_TR
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
The Internal Low Speed Oscillator Trim Register (ILO_TR)
sets the adjustment for the internal low speed oscillator.
The device-specific value, placed in the trim bits of this register at boot time, is based on factory testing. It is strongly
recommended that the user not alter the values in the
register.
Bits 5 and 4: Bias Trim[1:0]. These bits are used to set
the bias current in the PTAT Current Source. Bit 5 gets
inverted, so that a medium bias is selected when both bits
are ‘0’. The bias current is set according to the information
in this table:
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bias Trim[1:0]
Bit 1
Bit 0
Freq Trim[3:0]
Bias Current
Access
W : 00
Bias Trim [1:0]
Medium Bias
00b
Maximum Bias
01b
Minimum Bias
10b
Reserved
11b
Bits 3 to 0: Freq Trim[3:0]. These bits are used to trim the
frequency. Bit 0 is the LSb and bit 3 is the MSb. Bit 3 gets
inverted inside the register.
For additional information, refer to the ILO_TR register on
page 191.
59
[+] Feedback
Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO)
60
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
9. Sleep and Watchdog
This chapter discusses the Sleep and Watchdog operations and their associated registers. For a complete table of the Sleep
and Watchdog registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the Core Registers” on page 24. For a quick reference of all PSoC
registers in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
9.1
Architectural Description
Device components that are involved in Sleep and Watchdog operation are the selected 32 kHz clock, the sleep timer,
the Sleep bit in the CPU_SCR0 register, the sleep circuit (to
sequence going into and coming out of sleep), the bandgap
refresh circuit (to periodically refresh the reference voltage
during sleep), and the watchdog timer.
The goal of Sleep operation is to reduce average power
consumption as much as possible. The system has a sleep
state that can be initiated under firmware control. In this
state, the CPU is stopped at an instruction boundary and the
6/12 MHz oscillator (IMO), the Flash memory module, and
bandgap voltage reference are powered down. The only
blocks that remain in operation are the 32 kHz oscillator,
PSoC blocks clocked from the 32 kHz clock selection, and
the supply voltage monitor circuit.
The system can only wake up from sleep as a result of an
interrupt or reset event. The sleep timer can provide periodic
interrupts to allow the system to wake up, poll peripherals,
or do real-time functions, and then go to sleep again. The
GPIO (pin) interrupt, supply monitor interrupt, and analog
interrupt are examples of asynchronous interrupts that can
also be used to wake the system up.
The Watchdog Timer (WDT) circuit is designed to assert a
hardware reset to the device after a pre-programmed interval, unless it is periodically serviced in firmware. In the event
that an unexpected execution path is taken through the
code, this functionality serves to reboot the system. It can
also restart the system from the CPU halt state.
Once the WDT is enabled, it can only be disabled by an
External Reset (XRES) or a Power On Reset (POR). A WDT
reset will leave the WDT enabled. Therefore, if the WDT is
used in an application, all code (including initialization code)
must be written as though the WDT is enabled.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
9.1.1
Sleep Timer
The Sleep Timer is a 15-bit up counter clocked by the 32
kHz clock source. This timer is always enabled. The exception to this is within an ICE (in-circuit emulator) in debugger
mode and when the Stop bit in the CPU_SCR0 is set; the
sleep timer is disabled, so that the user will not get continual
watchdog resets when a breakpoint is hit in the debugger
environment.
If the associated sleep timer interrupt is enabled, a periodic
interrupt to the CPU is generated based on the sleep interval selected from the OSC_CR0 register. The sleep timer
functionality does not need to be directly associated with the
sleep state. It can be used as a general purpose timer interrupt regardless of sleep state.
The reset state of the sleep timer is a count value of all
zeros. There are two ways to reset the sleep timer. Any
hardware reset, (that is, POR, XRES, or Watchdog Reset
(WDR) will reset the sleep timer. There is also a method that
allows the user to reset the sleep timer in firmware. A write
of 38h to the RES_WDT register clears the sleep timer.
Note Any write to the RES_WDT register also clears the
watchdog timer.
Clearing the sleep timer may be done at anytime to synchronize the sleep timer operation to CPU processing. A good
example of this is after POR. The CPU hold-off, due to voltage ramp and others, may be significant. In addition, a significant amount of program initialization may be required.
However, the sleep timer starts counting immediately after
POR and will be at an arbitrary count when user code
begins execution. In this case, it may be desirable to clear
the sleep timer before enabling the sleep interrupt initially to
ensure that the first sleep period is a full interval.
61
[+] Feedback
Sleep and Watchdog
9.2
Application Overview
The following are notes regarding sleep as it relates to firmware and application issues.
Note 1 If an interrupt is pending, enabled, and scheduled to
be taken at the instruction boundary after the write to the
sleep bit, the system will not go to sleep. The instruction will
still execute, but it will not be able to set the Sleep bit in the
CPU_SCR0 register. Instead, the interrupt will be taken and
the effect of the sleep instruction is ignored.
Note 2 The Global Interrupt Enable (CPU_F register) does
not need to be enabled to wake the system out of sleep
state. Individual interrupt enables, as set in the interrupt
mask registers, are sufficient. If the Global Interrupt Enable
is not set, the CPU will not service the ISR associated with
that interrupt. However, the system will wake up and continue executing instructions from the point at which it went to
sleep. In this case, the user must manually clear the pending interrupt or subsequently enable the Global Interrupt
Enable bit and let the CPU take the ISR. If a pending interrupt is not cleared, it will be continuously asserted. Although
the Sleep bit may be written and the sleep sequence executed as soon as the device enters Sleep mode, the Sleep
bit is cleared by the pending interrupt and Sleep mode is
exited immediately.
Note 3 On wake up, the instruction immediately after the
sleep instruction is executed before the interrupt service
routine (if enabled). The instruction after the sleep instruction is pre-fetched before the system actually goes to sleep.
Therefore, when an interrupt occurs to wake the system up,
the pre-fetched instruction is executed and then the interrupt
service routine is executed. (If the Global Interrupt Enable is
62
not set, instruction execution continues where it left off
before sleep.)
Note 4 Analog power must be turned off by firmware before
going to sleep, to achieve the smallest sleep current. The
system sleep state does not control the analog array. There
are individual power controls for each analog block and global power controls in the reference block. These power controls must be manipulated by firmware.
Note 5 If the Global Interrupt Enable bit is disabled, it can be
safely enabled just before the instruction that writes the
sleep bit. It is usually undesirable to get an interrupt on the
instruction boundary, just before writing the sleep bit. This
means that on the return from interrupt, the sleep command
will be executed, possibly bypassing any firmware preparations that must be made in order to go to sleep. To prevent
this, disable interrupts before preparations are made. After
sleep preparations, enable global interrupts and write the
sleep bit with the two consecutive instructions as follows.
and f,~01h
or f,01h
mov reg[ffh],08h
//
//
//
//
//
disable global interrupts
(prepare for sleep, could
be many instructions)
enable global interrupts
Set the sleep bit
Due to the timing of the Global Interrupt Enable instruction, it
is not possible for an interrupt to occur immediately after that
instruction. The earliest the interrupt could occur is after the
next instruction (write to the Sleep bit) has been executed.
Therefore, if an interrupt is pending, the sleep instruction is
executed; but as described in Note 1, the sleep instruction
will be ignored. The first instruction executed after the ISR is
the instruction after sleep.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Sleep and Watchdog
9.3
Register Definitions
The following registers are associated with Sleep and Watchdog and are listed in address order. Each register description has
an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. The bits that are grayed out in the tables below are
reserved bits and are not detailed in the register descriptions. Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For a complete
table of the Sleep and Watchdog registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the Core Registers” on page 24.
9.3.1
Address
0,E3h
RES_WDT Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
RES_WDT
Bit 4
The Reset Watchdog Timer Register (RES_WDT) is used to
clear the watchdog timer (a write of any value) and clear
both the watchdog timer and the sleep timer (a write of 38h).
Address
1,EBh
Name
SLP_CFG
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
PSSDC[1:0]
The value placed in this register is based on factory testing.
It is strongly recommended that the user not alter the
register value.
■
■
■
■
■
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
W : 00
For additional information, refer to the RES_WDT register
on page 175.
SLP_CFG Register
The Sleep Configuration Register (SLP_CFG) is used to set
the sleep duty cycle.
9.3.3
Bit 2
the sleep timer is very close to its terminal count, the
watchdog timeout will be closer to two times. To ensure a full
three times timeout, both the WDT and the sleep timer may
be cleared. In applications that need a real-time clock, and
thus cannot reset the sleep timer when clearing the WDT,
the duty cycle at which the WDT must be cleared should be
no greater than two times the sleep interval.
Bits 7 to 0: WDSL_Clear[7:0]. The
Watchdog
Timer
(WDT) write-only register is designed to timeout at three rollover events of the sleep timer. Therefore, if only the WDT is
cleared, the next Watchdog Reset (WDR) will occur anywhere from two to three times the current sleep interval setting. If the sleep timer is near the beginning of its count, the
watchdog timeout will be closer to three times. However, if
9.3.2
Bit 3
WDSL_Clear[7:0]
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RW : 00
Bits 7 and 6: PSSDC[1:0]. The Power System Sleep Duty
Cycle bits are used to set the sleep duty cycle. These bits
should not be altered.
For additional information, refer to the SLP_CFG register on
page 193.
Related Registers
“INT_MSK0 Register” on page 49.
“OSC_CR0 Register” on page 93.
“ILO_TR Register” on page 59.
“CPU_SCR0 Register” on page 109.
“CPU_SCR1 Register” on page 108.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
63
[+] Feedback
Sleep and Watchdog
9.4
9.4.1
Timing Diagrams
Sleep Sequence
The Sleep bit, in the CPU_SCR0 register, is an input into the
sleep logic circuit. This circuit is designed to sequence the
device into and out of the hardware sleep state. The hardware sequence to put the device to sleep is shown in
Figure 9-1 and is defined as follows.
1. Firmware sets the Sleep bit in the CPU_SCR0 register.
The Bus Request (BRQ) signal to the CPU is immediately asserted: This is a request by the system to halt
CPU operation at an instruction boundary.
2. The CPU issues a Bus Request Acknowledge (BRA) on
the following positive edge of the CPU clock.
3. The sleep logic waits for the following negative edge of
the CPU clock and then asserts a system-wide Power
Down (PD) signal. In Figure 9-1, the CPU is halted and
the system-wide power down signal is asserted.
The system-wide PD signal controls three major circuit
blocks: the Flash memory module, the Internal Main Oscillator (6/12 MHz oscillator that is also called the IMO), and the
bandgap voltage reference. These circuits transition into a
zero power state. The only operational circuits on the PSoC
device are the ILO, the bandgap refresh circuit, and the supply voltage monitor circuit.
Figure 9-1. Sleep Sequence
Firmware write to
the SLEEP bit
causes an
immediate BRQ.
CPU captures
BRQ on next
CPUCLK edge.
CPU
responds
with a BRA.
On the falling edge of
CPUCLK, PD is asserted.
The 6/12 MHz system clock
is halted; the Flash and
bandgap are powered down.
CPUCLK
IOW
SLEEP
BRQ
BRA
PD
64
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Sleep and Watchdog
9.4.2
Wakeup Sequence
Once asleep, the only event that can wake the system up is
an interrupt. The Global Interrupt Enable of the CPU flag
register does not need to be set. Any unmasked interrupt
will wake the system up. It is optional for the CPU to actually
take the interrupt after the wakeup sequence.
The wakeup sequence is synchronized to the 32 kHz clock
for purposes of sequencing a startup delay, to allow the
Flash memory module enough time to power up before the
CPU asserts the first read access. Another reason for the
delay is to allow the IMO, bandgap, and LVD/POR circuits
time to settle before actually being used in the system. As
shown in Figure 9-2, the wakeup sequence is as follows.
1. The wakeup interrupt occurs and is synchronized by the
negative edge of the 32 kHz clock.
2. At the following positive edge of the 32 kHz clock, the
system-wide PD signal is negated. The Flash memory
module, IMO, and bandgap any POR/LVD circuits are all
powered up to a normal operating state.
3. At the next positive edge of the 32 kHz clock, the values
of the bandgap are settled and sampled.
4. At the following negative edge of the 32 kHz clock (after
about 15 μs, nominal), the values of the POR/LVD signals have settled and are sampled. The BRQ signal is
negated by the sleep logic circuit. On the following CPU
clock, BRA is negated by the CPU and instruction execution resumes.
The wakeup times (interrupt to CPU operational) ranges
from two to three 32 kHz cycles or 61 - 92 μs (nominal).
Figure 9-2. Wakeup Sequence
Sleep timer or GPIO
interrupt occurs.
Interrupt is double sampled by
32K clock and PD is negated to
system.
CPU is restarted after
75 μs (nominal).
CLK32K
INT
LVD/PPOR is valid
SLEEP
PD
BANDGAP
LVD/PPOR
ENABLE
POR/LVD/
BANDGAP
SAMPLE
BANDGAP
SAMPLE
LVD/POR
CPUCLK/
6/12 Mhz
(Not to Scale)
BRQ
BRA
CPU
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
65
[+] Feedback
Sleep and Watchdog
9.4.3
Bandgap Refresh
9.4.4
During normal operation, the bandgap circuit provides a
voltage reference (VRef) to the system, for use in the analog
blocks, Flash, and low voltage detect (LVD) circuitry. Normally, the bandgap output is connected directly to the VRef
signal. However, during sleep, the bandgap reference generator block and LVD circuits are completely powered down.
The bandgap and LVD blocks are periodically re-enabled
during sleep in order to monitor for low voltage conditions.
This is accomplished by turning on the bandgap periodically,
allowing it time to start up for a full 32 kHz clock period, and
connecting it to VRef to refresh the reference voltage for the
following 32 kHz clock period as shown in Figure 9-3.
During the second 32 kHz clock period of the refresh cycle,
the LVD circuit is allowed to settle during the high time of
the 32 kHz clock. During the low period of the second 32
kHz clock, the LVD interrupt is allowed to occur.
Figure 9-3. Bandgap Refresh Operation
Bandgap is turned on,
but not yet connected
to VRef.
Bandgap output is
connected to VRef.
Voltage is refreshed.
Bandgap is powered
down until next
refresh cycle.
CLK32K
Band Gap
VRef
VRef is slowly
leaking to ground.
Low voltage monitors are
active during CLK32K low.
Watchdog Timer
On device boot up, the Watchdog Timer (WDT) is initially
disabled. The PORS bit in the system control register controls the enabling of the WDT. On boot, the PORS bit is initially set to '1', indicating that either a POR or XRES event
has occurred. The WDT is enabled by clearing the PORS
bit. Once this bit is cleared and the watchdog timer is
enabled, it cannot be subsequently disabled. (The PORS bit
cannot be set to '1' in firmware; it can only be cleared.)
The only way to disable the Watchdog function, after it is
enabled, is through a subsequent POR or XRES. Although
the WDT is disabled during the first time through initialization code after a POR or XRES, all code should be written
as if it is enabled (that is, the WDT should be cleared periodically). This is because, in the initialization code after a WDR
event, the watchdog timer is enabled so all code must be
aware of this.
The watchdog timer is three counts of the sleep timer interrupt output. The watchdog interval is three times the
selected sleep timer interval. The available selections for the
watchdog interval are shown in Table 9-1. When the sleep
timer interrupt is asserted, the watchdog timer increments.
When the counter reaches three, a terminal count is
asserted. This terminal count is registered by the 32 kHz
clock. Therefore, the WDR (Watchdog Reset) signal will go
high after the following edge of the 32 kHz clock and be held
asserted for one cycle (30 μs nominal). The flip-flop that
registers the WDT terminal count is not reset by the WDR
signal when it is asserted, but is reset by all other resets.
Figure 9-4. Watchdog Reset Timing
CLK32K
The rate at which the refresh occurs is related to the 32 kHz
clock and controlled by the Power System Sleep Duty Cycle
(PSSDC). Table 9-1 enumerates the available selections.
The default setting (256 sleep timer counts) is applicable for
many applications, giving a typical average device current
under 5 μA.
Table 9-1. Power System Sleep Duty Cycle Selections
PSSDC
66
Sleep Timer Counts
Period (Nominal)
00b (default)
256
8 ms
01b
1024
31.2 ms
10b
64
2 ms
11b
16
500 μs
SLEEP INT
WD COUNT
2
3
0
WD RESET
(WDR)
Once enabled, the WDT must be periodically cleared in firmware. This is accomplished with a write to the RES_WDT
register. This write is data independent, so any write will
clear the watchdog timer. (Note that a write of 38h will also
clear the sleep timer.) If for any reason the firmware fails to
clear the WDT within the selected interval, the circuit will
assert WDR to the device. WDR is equivalent in effect to
any other reset. All internal registers are set to their reset
state, see the table titled “Details of Functionality for Various
Resets” on page 112. An important aspect to remember
about WDT resets is that RAM initialization can be disabled
(IRAMDIS in the CPU_SCR1 register). In this case, the
SRAM contents are unaffected; so that when a WDR
occurs, program variables are persistent through this reset.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Sleep and Watchdog
In practical application, it is important to know that the
watchdog timer interval can be anywhere between two and
three times the sleep timer interval. The only way to guarantee that the WDT interval is a full three times that of the
sleep interval is to clear the sleep timer (write 38h) when
clearing the WDT register. However, this is not possible in
applications that use the sleep timer as a real-time clock. In
the case where firmware clears the WDT register without
clearing the sleep timer, this can occur at any point in a
given sleep timer interval. If it occurs just before the terminal
count of a sleep timer interval, the resulting WDT interval will
be just over two times that of the sleep timer interval.
9.5
Power Modes
Sleep mode power consumption consists of the items in the
following tables.
In Table 9-2, the typical block currents shown do not represent maximums. These currents do not include any analog
block currents that may be on during Sleep mode.
Table 9-2. Continuous Currents
IPOR
1 μA
ICLK32K (ILO/ECO)
1 μA
While the CLK32K can be turned off in Sleep mode, this
mode is not useful since it makes it impossible to restart
unless an imprecise power on reset (IPOR) occurs. (The
Sleep bit cannot be cleared without CLK32K.) During the
sleep mode buzz, the bandgap is on for two cycles and the
LVD circuitry is on for one cycle. Time-averaged currents
from periodic sleep mode ‘buzz’, with periodic count of N,
are listed in Table 9-3.
Table 9-3. Time Averaged Currents
IBG (Bandgap)
(2/N) * 60 μA
ILVD (LVD comparators)
(2/N) * 50 μA
Table 9-4 lists example currents for N=256 and N=1024.
Device leakage currents add to the totals in the table.
Table 9-4. Example Currents
N=256
N=1024
IPOR
1
1
CLK32K
1
1
IBG
0.46
0.12
ILVD
0.4
0.1
Total
2.9 μA
2.2 μA
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
67
[+] Feedback
Sleep and Watchdog
68
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section C: CapSense System
The configurable CapSense System section discusses the CapSense and analog components of the PSoC device and the
registers associated with those components. This section encompasses the following chapters:
■
CapSense Module on page 71.
■
■
IO Analog Multiplexer on page 81.
Comparators on page 83.
Top Level CapSense Architecture
The figure below illustrates the top level architecture of the PSoC’s CapSense system. Each component of the figure is discussed in detail in this section.
PSoC CapSense System
CAPSENSE
SYSTEM
System Bus
From
IMO
CapSense
Module
Comparators
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Analog
Reference
Analog
Mux
Global
Analog
Interconnect
69
[+] Feedback
Section C: CapSense System
CapSense Register Summary
This table lists all the PSoC registers for the CapSense system in address order within their system resource configuration.
The bits that are grayed out are reserved bits. If these bits are written, always write them with a value of ‘0’.
Summary Table of the CapSense Registers
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
CAPSENSE MODULE REGISTERS (page 71)
0,A0h
CS_CR0
0,A1h
CS_CR1
0,A2h
CS_CR2
0,A3h
CS_CR3
0,A4h
CS_CNTL
Data[7:0]
0,A5h
CS_CNTH
Data[7:0]
0,A6h
CS_STAT
0,A7h
CS_TIMER
0,A8h
CS_SLEW
0,FDh
IDAC_D
CSOUT[1:0]
CHAIN
MODE[1:0]
CLKSEL[1:0]
IRANGE[1:0]
IBOOST
INS
REFMUX
COLS
RLOSEL
IDACDIR
IDAC_EN
REFMODE
REF_EN
COHS
PPS
INV
EN
INSEL[2:0]
PXD_EN
RO_EN
LPFilt[1:0]
RW : 00
RW : 00
LPF_EN[1:0]
RW : 00
RW : 00
R : 00
R : 00
INM
COLM
COHM
PPM
Timer Count Value[5:0]
# : 00
RW : 00
FastSlew[6:0]
FS_EN
IDACDATA[7:0]
RW : 00
RW : 00
IO ANALOG MULTIPLEXER REGISTERS (page 81)
0,61h
AMUX_CFG
1,D8h
MUX_CR0
ENABLE[7:0]
RW : 00
1,D9h
MUX_CR1
ENABLE[7:0]
RW : 00
1,DAh
MUX_CR2
ENABLE[7:0]
RW : 00
1,DBh
MUX_CR3
ENABLE[7:0]
RW : 00
ICAPEN[1:0]
INTCAP[1:0]
RW : 00
COMPARATOR REGISTERS (page 83)
0,78h
CMP_RDC
0,79h
CMP_MUX
0,7Ah
CMP_CR0
0,7Bh
CMP_CR1
0,7Ch
CMP_LUT
CMP1D
INP1[1:0]
CINT1
CMP0D
INN1[1:0]
CPIN1
CMP1R
CMP1EN
CRST1
CDS1
CMP1L
INP0[1:0]
CINT0
CPIN0
LUT1[3:0]
CMP0L
INN0[1:0]
# : 00
RW : 00
CMP0R
CMP0EN
RW : 00
CRST0
CDS0
RW : 00
LUT0[3:0]
RW : 00
LEGEND
# Access is bit specific. Refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137 for additional information.
R Read register or bit(s).
W Write register or bit(s).
70
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
10. CapSense Module
This chapter presents the CapSense™ Module and its associated registers. For a complete table of the CapSense Module
registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the CapSense Registers” on page 70. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in
address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
10.1
Architectural Description
10.1.1
Types of CapSense Approaches
10.1.1.1
Relaxation Oscillator
The CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device contains hardware support for a numbers of different capacitive sensing
approaches. A block diagram of the overall capacitive sensing architecture is shown in Figure 10-1. Cs1 through Csn
are the capacitors being measured. The various sensing
approaches use different subsets of this hardware.
The relaxation oscillator (RO) method operates by forming
an oscillator using the sense capacitance. The IDAC, sense
capacitance, and comparator (switching between two references) form the RO.
Figure 10-1. CapSense Module Block Diagram
This interval is set by a number of cycles of the RO using a
6-bit counter. During this interval, the IMO clocks a 16-bit
counter and the final count gives a measure of capacitance.
(See Figure 10-2).
Cs1
Analog
Global Bus
IDAC
Dedicated RO
Comparators
In the RO method the RO is compared to the frequency of
an internal oscillator over a predetermined interval.
Figure 10-2. Relaxation Oscillator Block Diagram
Cs2
Pin Enables
V+
IDAC
Csn
Dedicated RO
Comparators
Vr
Cs1
Analog
Global Bus
V-
Cs2
V+
Reference
Buffer
Cinternal
RO Clock
Comparator
V-
Cexternal
Mux
Csn
6-Bit Counter
Mux
Refs
Cap Sense Logic
IMO
CapSense
Clock Select CSCLK
16-Bit Counter
Cap Sense Counters
CSCLK
IMO
CapSense
Clock Select
Relaxation
Oscillator
(RO)
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
On each (rising/falling) edge of the relaxation oscillator, an
option allows the edge to operate with two different slew
rates. A faster charging rate can be set for a fixed time, followed by a slower rate until the waveform reaches the target
threshold voltage. This approach can lead to increased
capacitance measurement sensitivity. The CS_SLEW register controls this mode.
71
[+] Feedback
CapSense Module
10.1.1.2
IDAC
The internal current DAC provides a bias current for use
with the relaxation oscillator (RO), or for capacitance measurement in the proximity detect mode. It can also be set to
supply a sinking or sourcing current to any IO pin through
the analog global bus connection.
The IDAC current is set by the 8-bit IDAC_D register. In
addition, the two IRANGE bits in the CS_CR2 register provide additional prescaling range.
Note At very low currents a low frequency noise exists on
the IDAC output. To avoid generating this low frequency
noise, do not use IDAC_D settings equal to or less than
three for capacitive sensing applications.
10.1.2
CapSense Counter
enabled simultaneously with a write to the enable bit. On terminal count of the 6-bit RO counter, the contents of the 16bit counter are captured. Changes in this count then indicate
capacitance changes.
The CapSense Counter block is optimized to implement the
relaxation oscillator algorithm. The hardware consists of two
8-bit counters capable of being chained into a 16-bit counter.
For a clear understanding of this architecture see the block
diagram in Figure 10-3.
Figure 10-3. CapSense Counter Block Diagram
Low Byte Counter
COL
CO
EN
8-Bit
Up
Counter
High Byte Counter
CHAIN
EN
CO
8-Bit
Up
Counter
COH
0
The CapSense Counter block (see Figure 10-3) is optimized
to implement the relaxation oscillator algorithm. The hardware consists of two 8-bit up-counters with capture that can
be optionally chained into a single 16-bit capture counter
and an additional 6-bit timer.
In the relaxation algorithm, a 6-bit timer is clocked by the
relaxation oscillator. A 16-bit chained counter is formed and
clocked by CSCLK, a divided version of the internal main
oscillator (IMO). In this configuration, the counters are
IMO
IMO/2
IMO/4
IMO/8
0
1
2
3
RLO
CSCLK
1
RLOSEL
CLKSEL[1:0]
IN
CS_INT
COLR
COHR
0
1
2
3
To Pin
CSOUT[1:0]
Figure 10-4 illustrates the variety of interrupt options for the
block.
Figure 10-4. Block Interrupt Options Diagram
CMP0
ILO
CMP1
RLO_TIMER_TC
TIMER
RLO_TIMER_IRQ
MUXBUS
‘0’
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Edge Detect
IOW or
BLOCK_EN
INV
INSEL[2:0]
INS
INM
COLS
COLM
IOW or
R
BLOCK_EN
S
COHR
COHS
COHM
IOW or
R
BLOCK_EN
S
PPS
S
IN
IOW or
BLOCK_EN
IMO
COL
CLK
COH
CLK/RLO
PF DONE
R
COLR
R
S
CS_INT
PPM
(Control Logic)
IMO
72
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CapSense Module
This diagram illustrates the 6-bit timer.
Figure 10-6. RLO Timer Block Diagram
Figure 10-5. 6-Bit Timer Diagram
RLO
CSCLK
0
1
6 -B it
T im e r
CO
R L O _ T IM E R _ T C
R L O _ T IM E R _ IR Q
Relaxation
Oscillator
CapSense
Clock
Programmable
Timer
IRQ
Terminal
Count
PXD _EN
Register
DATA[5:0]
10.1.3
Timer
The programmable timer is a 6-bit down counter with a terminal count output. This timer has one data register associated with it. The timer is started when the CapSense block is
enabled. The enable signal is double synchronized to the
timer’s clock domain. When started, the timer always starts
counting down from the value loaded into its data registers
(CS_TIMER). This timer only has a one shot mode, in which
the timer completes one full count cycle and stops. Disabling
and re-enabling the CapSense block restarts the timer.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
The timer’s clock is either the RLO clock or the CapSense
count clock, depending on the value of the PXD_EN bit in
the CS_CR2 register. See the “CS_CR2 Register” on
page 75 for details.
10.1.3.1
Operation
When started, the timer loads the value contained in its data
register and counts down to its terminal count of zero. The
timer outputs an active high terminal count pulse for one
clock cycle upon reaching the terminal count. The low time
of the terminal count pulse is equal to the loaded decimal
count value multiplied by the clock period. (TCpw = COUNT
VALUEdecimal * CLKperiod). The period of the terminal count
output is the pulse width of the terminal count plus one clock
period. (TCperiod = TCpw + CLKperiod). Refer to the timing
diagram in Figure 10-11.
73
[+] Feedback
CapSense Module
10.2
Register Definitions
The following registers are associated with the CapSense Module and are listed in address order. The register descriptions
have an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. The bits in the tables that are grayed out are
reserved bits and are not detailed in the register descriptions that follow. Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For a
complete table of CapSense Module registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the CapSense Registers” on page 70.
10.2.1
Address
0,A0h
CS_CR0 Register
Name
CS_CR0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
The CapSense Control Register 0 (CS_CR0) controls the
operation of the CapSense counters. Bits [7:1] should never
be written to while the block is enabled.
Bits 7 and 6: CSOUT[1:0]. These bits select between a
number of CapSense signals that can be driven to an output
pin. Refer to Figure 10-3 on page 72 for the COL and COH,
and to Figure 10-7 on page 79 for IN and CS_INT.
CSOUT[1:0]
Bit 4
Bit 3
IN
01
CS_INT
10
COL
11
COH
Bits 2 and 1: MODE[1:0]. These bits specify the operating
mode of the counter logic. The modes are shown in this
table.
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
EN
RW : 00
MODE[1:0]
MODE[1:0]
00
Description
Stop On Event
In this mode, the block starts counting when the EN bit is
set, and stops counting on the selected interrupt event. This
mode allows the user to read the counter results in firmware. Counting can be started again by disabling and reenabling the block using the EN bit.
01
Pulse Width
In this mode, after the EN bit is set, the block waits for a
positive edge on the data input selection to start the
counter, and then stops the counter on the following negative edge of the data input. Polarity can be adjusted with the
INV bit (CS_CR1). Counting can be started again by disabling and re-enabling the block using the EN bit.
Description
00
Bit 2
CSOUT[1:0]
10
Period
In this mode, after the EN bit is set, the block waits for a
positive edge on the data input selection to start the
counter, and then stops the counter on the following positive edge of the data input. Polarity can be adjusted with the
INV bit (CS_CR1). Counting can be started again by disabling and re-enabling the block using the EN bit.
11
Continuous
In this mode, the counter can be used to generate a periodic interrupt. The period is set by the input clock selection
in conjunction with using one 8-bit counter (period=100h) or
the chained 16-bit counter (period = 10000h).
Bit 0: EN. When this bit is written to ‘1’, the counters are
enabled for counting. When this bit is written to ‘0’, counting
is stopped and all counter values are reset to ‘0’. If the
counting mode is stopped in conjunction with an event (see
MODE[1:0]), the current count is held and can be subsequently read from the counter registers. The EN bit must be
toggled to ‘0’ and then back to ‘1’ to start a new count.
For additional information, refer to the CS_CR0 register on
page 150.
74
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CapSense Module
10.2.2
Address
0,A1h
CS_CR1 Register
Name
CS_CR1
Bit 7
Bit 6
CHAIN
Bit 5
CLKSEL[1:0]
Bit 4
Bit 3
RLOSEL
INV
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INSEL[2:0]
Access
RW : 00
The CapSense Control Register 1 (CS_CR1) contains additional CapSense system control options. This register
should never be written to while the block is enabled.
Bit 3: INV. Input Invert. When this bit is a ‘1’, the data input
select is inverted. When this bit is a ‘0’, the input polarity is
unchanged.
Bit 7: CHAIN. When this bit is a ‘0’, the two 8-bit counters
operate independently. When this bit is a ‘1’, the counters
are chained to operate as a 16-bit counter.
Bits 2 to 0: INSEL[2:0]. Input Selection. These bits control
the selection of input signals for event control according to
the information in the following table.
Bits 6 and 5: CLKSEL[1:0]. These
bits
select
the
CapSense module frequency of operation according to the
information in the following table.
CLKSEL[1:0]
INSEL[1:0]
Frequency of Operation
Selected Input
000
Comparator 0
001
ILO
010
Comparator 1
011
RLO Timer Terminal Count
Internal Timer
00
IMO
100
01
IMO/2
101
RLO Timer IRQ
10
IMO/4
110
Analog Global Mux Bus
11
IMO/8
111
‘0’
Bit 4: RLOSEL. When this bit is a ‘0’, the entire CapSense
system runs at the frequency specified in the CLKSEL[1:0]
bits. When this bit is a ‘1’, the High Counter is clocked independently by the CapSense RLO clock.
10.2.3
Address
0,A2h
For additional information, refer to the CS_CR1 register on
page 151.
CS_CR2 Register
Name
CS_CR2
Bit 7
Bit 6
IRANGE[1:0]
Bit 5
Bit 4
IDACDIR
IDAC_EN
The CapSense Control Register 2 (CS_CR2) contains additional CapSense system control options.
Bits 7 and 6: IRANGE. These bits scale the IDAC current
output.
Frequency of Operation
00
1X range
01
2X range
10
4X range
11
8X range
Bit 5: IDACDIR. This bit determines whether the IDAC
sinks or sources current to the analog global bus when
enabled.
Bit 3
Bit 2
PXD_EN
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RO_EN
RW : 00
Bit 2: PXD_EN. This bit drives a clock to each IO pin that is
enabled for connection to the analog global bus. This clock
alternately connects the pin to the bus, then connects the
pin to ground. The clock rate is selected by the CLKSEL bits
in the CS_CR1 register. In addition, the IDAC sources current to the bus. The programmable timer is clocked by this
same clock.
Bit 0: RO_EN. This bit enables the relaxation oscillator.
The internal RO is connected to the analog global bus, and
the capacitance of any connected pins will affect the RO frequency. The oscillator current is set by the value of the
IDAC_D register.
For additional information, refer to the CS_CR2 register on
page 152.
Frequency of Operation
0
IDAC Sources
1
IDAC Sink
Bit 4: IDAC_EN. This bit enables manual connection of the
IDAC to the analog global bus.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
75
[+] Feedback
CapSense Module
10.2.4
Address
0,A3h
CS_CR3 Register
Name
CS_CR3
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
IBOOST
REFMUX
REFMODE
REF_EN
Bit 3
Bit 2
LPFilt[1:0]
Bit 1
Bit 0
LPF_EN[1:0]
Access
RW : 00
The CapSense Control Register 3 (CS_CR3) contains control bits primarily for the low pass filter and reference buffer.
Bit 4: REF_EN. This bit enables the reference buffer to
drive to the analog global bus.
Bit 7: IBOOST. This bit adds an offset current to all IDAC
settings, so a zero value in the IDAC_D register does not
give zero current out. This affects all IDAC functions, including the relaxation oscillator.
Bits 3 and 2: LPFilt[1:0]. These bits control the time constant of the low pass filter that connects to the analog bus.
LPFilt[1:0]
Bit 6: REFMUX. This bit selects between VREF and REFHI
for the reference buffer input.
Bit 5: REFMODE. This bit is used for manual connection of
the reference buffer to the analog global bus. If either the
CI_EN or RO_EN bits are set high in the CS_CR2 register,
this bit has no effect.
Frequency of Operation
00
1 ms
01
2 ms
10
5 ms
11
10 ms
Bits 1 and 0: LPF_EN[1:0]. These bits are used to connect
a low pass filter into the input of either comparator channel.
For additional information, refer to the CS_CR3 register on
page 153.
10.2.5
Address
0,A4h
CS_CNTL Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
CS_CNTL
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Data[7:0]
Access
RO : 00
Bits 7 to 0: Data[7:0]. This value contains the current
count for the counter low block. The block must be stopped
to read a valid value.
The CapSense Counter Low Byte Register (CS_CNTL) contains the current count for the low byte counter.
For additional information, refer to the CS_CNTL register on
page 154.
10.2.6
Address
0,A5h
CS_CNTH Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
CS_CNTH
The CapSense Counter High Byte Register (CS_CNTH)
contains the current count value for the high byte counter.
Bit 4
Bit 3
Data[7:0]
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RO : 00
Bits 7 to 0: Data[7:0]. This value contains the current
count for the counter high block. The block must be stopped
to read a valid value.
For additional information, refer to the CS_CNTH register on
page 155.
76
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CapSense Module
10.2.7
Address
0,A6h
CS_STAT Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
CS_STAT
INS
COLS
COHS
PPS
INM
COLM
COHM
PPM
# : 00
LEGEND
# Access is bit specific.
The CapSense Status Register
CapSense counter options.
(CS_STAT)
controls
bit is cleared by writing a ‘0’ to this bit position. Writing a ‘1’
has no effect.
Status Bits 7 to 4 – The posted CapSense interrupts are
the corresponding status bits in this register. Interrupt clearing is performed by clearing the associated status bit. Status
can only be updated while the block is enabled and running.
All status bits are cleared when the block is disabled.
Mask Bits 3 to 0 – The interrupt mask bits should never be
modified while the block is enabled. If modification to bits 3
to 0 is necessary while the block is enabled, then special
attention must be paid to ensure that the status bits, bits 7 to
4, are not accidentally cleared. This can be done by writing a
‘1’ to all of the status bits when writing to the mask bits.
Bit 7: INS. Input Status. Reading a ‘1’ indicates a rising
edge on the selected input was detected. Reading a ‘0’ indicates that this event did not occur. This bit is cleared by writing a ‘0’ to this bit position. Writing a ‘1’ has no effect.
Bit 3: INM. Input Interrupt Mask. When this bit is a ‘1’, a rising edge event on the input will assert the block interrupt.
When this bit is a ‘0’, this event is masked.
Bit 6: COLS. Counter Carry Out Low Status. Reading a ‘1’
indicates an overflow occurred in the Counter Low block.
Reading a ‘0’ indicates that this event did not occur. This bit
is cleared by writing a ‘0’ to this bit position. Writing a ‘1’ has
no effect.
Bit 2: COLM. Counter Carry Out Low Mask. When this bit
is a ‘1’, a carry out from the counter low block will assert the
block interrupt. When this bit is a ‘0’, this event is masked.
Bit 1: COHM. Counter Carry Out High Mask. When this bit
is a ‘1’, a carry out from the counter high block will assert the
block interrupt. When this bit is a ‘0’, this event is masked.
Bit 5: COHS. Counter Carry Out High Status. Reading a ‘1’
indicates an overflow occurred in the Counter High block.
Reading a ‘0’ indicates that this event did not occur. This bit
is cleared by writing a ‘0’ to this bit position. Writing a ‘1’ has
no effect.
Bit 0: PPM. Pulse Width/Period Mask When this bit is a ‘1’,
the completion of a pulse width or period measurement will
assert the block interrupt. When this bit is a ‘0’, this event is
masked.
Bit 4: PPS. Pulse Width/Period Status. Reading a ‘1’ indicates the completion of a pulse width or period measurement (as defined by the MODE[1:0] bits in CS_CR0). This
10.2.8
Address
0,A7h
For additional information, refer to the CS_STAT register on
page 156.
CS_TIMER Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
CS_TIMER
The CapSense Timer Register (CS_TIMER) sets the timer
count value.
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Timer Count Value[5:0]
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RW : 00
Bits 5 to 0: Timer Count Value[5:0]. The 6-bit value in this
register sets the initial count value for the timer.
For additional information, refer to the CS_TIMER register
on page 157.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
77
[+] Feedback
CapSense Module
10.2.9
CS_SLEW Register
Address
Name
0,A8h
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
CS_SLEW
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
FastSlew[6:0]
Bit 0
Access
FS_EN
RW : 00
The CapSense Slew Control Register (CS_SLEW) enables
and controls a fast slewing mode for the relaxation oscillator.
falling edges. This timer value has no effect unless the
FS_EN bit is set high.
Bits 7 to 1: FastSlew[6:0]. This 7-bit count sets the time
interval, in IMO cycles, for a faster slew rate on the relaxation oscillator edges. The interval applies to both rising and
Bit 0: FS_EN. This bit enables the fast slewing interval on
each edge of the relaxation oscillator.
10.2.10
Address
0,FDh
IDAC_D Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
IDAC_D
The Current DAC Data Register (IDAC_D) specifies the 8bit multiplying factor that determines the output DAC current.
Bits 7 to 0: IDACDATA[7:0]. The 8-bit value in this register
sets the current driven onto the analog global mux bus when
the current DAC mode is enabled.
78
For additional information, refer to the CS_SLEW register on
page 158.
Bit 4
Bit 3
IDACDATA[7:0]
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RW : 00
Note At very low currents a low frequency noise exists on
the IDAC output. To avoid generating this low frequency
noise, do not use IDAC_D settings equal to or less than
three for capacitive sensing applications.
For additional information, refer to the IDAC_D register on
page 177.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CapSense Module
10.3
Timing Diagrams
Figure 10-7. Event Timing (Mode = 00)
SYSCLK
Block Enable
Count Enable
Event
Count
00
01
02
03
04
87
88
89
Figure 10-8. Pulse Width Frequency Timing (Mode = 01/10)
SYSCLK
Block Enable
Input Signal
Edge Detect
Count Enable
Count
00
01
02
03
04
94
95
96
Figure 10-9. Continuous Timing (Mode = 11)
SYSCLK
Block Enable
Count Enable
Count
00
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
01
02
03
04
44
45
00
79
[+] Feedback
CapSense Module
Figure 10-10. High Byte Counter Timing (RLO clock selected)
SYSCLK
Low Byte Count Enable
Low Byte Clock
00
Low Byte Count
01
02
03
04
High Byte Clock
High Byte Count Enable
00
High Byte Count
01
02
Figure 10-11. 6-Bit RLO Timer Operation
CS_TIMER[5:0]
03h (6-bit)
RLO Clock
EN
Synchronized
EN
Count
00h
03h
02h
01h
00h
RLO_TIMER_TC
RLO_TIMER_IRQ
80
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
11. IO Analog Multiplexer
This chapter explains the chip-wide IO Analog Multiplexer for the CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device and its associated registers.
For a complete table of the IO Analog Multiplexer registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the CapSense Registers” on
page 70. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
11.1
Architectural Description
The CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device contains an enhanced
analog multiplexer (mux) capability. This function allows
many IO pins to connect to a common internal analog global
bus.
Any number of pins can be connected simultaneously, and
dedicated support circuitry allows selected pins to be alternately charged high or connected to the bus. The analog
global bus can be connected as a comparator input.
Figure 11-1 shows a block diagram of the IO analog mux
system.
Figure 11-1. IO Analog Mux System
For each pin, the mux capability exists in parallel with the
normal GPIO cell, shown in Figure 11-2. Normally, the associated GPIO pin is put into a high-impedance state for these
applications, although there are cases where the GPIO cell
is configured by the user to briefly drive pin initialization
states as described below.
Pins are individually connected to the internal bus by setting
the corresponding bits in the MUX_CRx registers. Any number of pins can be enabled at the same time. At reset, all of
these mux connections are open (disconnected).
Figure 11-2. IO Pin Configuration for the CY8C20x34/24
Pin
PSoC Device
GPIO
Switch Enable
(MUX_CRx.n)
Analog Mux Bus
IO
Pin
IO
Pin
CapSense
Blocks
11.2
The analog mux circuitry enables capacitive sensing and
internal capacitance.
Analog
Mux
IO
Pin
IO
Pin
Analog Mux Bus
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Application Overview
Capacitive Sensing. The analog mux supports capacitive
sensing applications through the use of the IO analog multiplexer and its control circuitry. Refer to the “Architectural
Description” on page 71 in the CapSense Module chapter
for more details.
Internal Capacitance. An internal filter capacitance can be
connected to the analog global bus, using the ICAPEN bits
in the AMUX_CFG register.
81
[+] Feedback
IO Analog Multiplexer
11.3
Register Definitions
The following registers are only associated with the Analog Bus Mux in the CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device and are listed in
address order. For a complete table of the IO Analog Multiplexer registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the CapSense Registers” on page 70. Each register description has an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. Register bits that are grayed out throughout this document are reserved bits and are not detailed in the register descriptions that
follow.Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’.
11.3.1
Address
0,61h
AMUX_CFG Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCAP[1:0]
Access
RW : 00
Bits 1 and 0: INTCAP[1:0]. These bits select between the
P0[1] and P0[3] pins for the integration capacitor for charge
integration capacitive sensing.
For additional information, refer to the AMUX_CFG register
on page 143.
Bits 3 and 2: ICAPEN[1:0]. Setting these bits connect an
internal capacitor (up to approximately 100 pF) to the analog
global bus.
Address
Bit 2
ICAPEN[1:0]
The Analog Mux Configuration Register (AMUX_CFG) is
used to configure the integration capacitor pin connections
to the analog global bus.
11.3.2
Bit 3
AMUX_CFG
MUX_CRx Registers
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
1,D8h
MUX_CR0
ENABLE[7:0]
RW : 00
1,D9h
MUX_CR1
ENABLE[7:0]
RW : 00
1,DAh
MUX_CR2
ENABLE[7:0]
RW : 00
1,DBh
MUX_CR3
ENABLE[7:0]
RW : 00
The Analog Mux Port Bit Enable Registers (MUX_CR0,
MUX_CR1, MUX_CR2, and MUX_CR3) are used to control
the connection between the analog mux bus and the corresponding pin.
82
Bits 7 to 0: ENABLE[7:0]. The bits in these registers
enable connection of individual pins to the analog mux bus.
Each IO port has a corresponding MUX_CRx register.
For additional information, refer to the MUX_CRx register on
page 183.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
12. Comparators
This chapter explains the Comparators for the CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device and its associated registers. For a complete table
of the comparator registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the CapSense Registers” on page 70. For a quick reference of all
PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
12.1
Architectural Description
The CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device contains two comparators designed to support capacitive sensing or other general purpose
uses. Figure 12-1 shows a block diagram of the comparator system.
Figure 12-1. Comparators Block Diagram
INP1[1:0]
(CMP_MUX)
AMuxBus
Reserved
P0[1]
LPF_EN[0]
(CS_CR3)
Comparator Analog System
CMP1D
(CMP_RDC)
COMP1
P0[3]
LUT1[3:0]
(CMP_LUT)
A
CMP1 LUT
LUT
VREF
RefLo
RefHi
Reserved
CMP1
To: Cap Sense Logic
B
S
Enable, Range
(CMP_CR)
CMP1O
LATCH
CMP0 LUT
2
INN1[1:0]
(CMP_MUX)
LPFilt[1:0]
(CS_CR3)
I/O Read
CDS1
(CMP_CR1)
Reg Write
CPIN1
(CMP_CR1)
CRST1
(CMP_CR1)
CMP1L
(CMP_RDC)
LPF
INP0[1:0]
(CMP_MUX)
AMuxBus
Reserved
P0[1]
I/O Read
LPF_EN[1]
(CS_CR3)
COMP0
P0[3]
LUT0[3:0]
(CMP_LUT)
A
VREF
RefLo
RefHi
Reserved
INN0[1:0]
(CMP_MUX)
To: Pin Outputs
R
CDS0
(CMP_CR1)
CMP1
CINT1
CMP0
CINT0
To: Analog
Interrupt
CMP0D
(CMP_RDC)
I/O Read
CMP0 LUT
LUT
CMP0
To: Cap Sense Logic
B
S
2
Enable, Range
(CMP_CR)
CMP1 LUT
Reg Write
CMP0O
LATCH
To: Pin Outputs
R
CPIN0
(CMP_CR1)
CRST0
(CMP_CR1)
CMP0L
(CMP_RDC)
I/O Read
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
83
[+] Feedback
Comparators
The comparator digital interface performs logic processing
on one or more comparator signals, provides a latching
capability, and routes the result to other chip subsystems.
The comparator signal is routed through a look-up table
(LUT) function. The other input to the LUT is the neighboring
comparator output. The LUT implements 1 of 16 functions
on the two inputs, as selected by the CMP_LUT register.
The LUT output also feeds the set input on an reset/set (RS)
latch. The latch is cleared by writing a ‘0’ to the appropriate
bit in the CMP_RDC register, or by a rising edge from the
other comparator LUT.
12.2
The primary output for each comparator is the LUT output or
its latched version. These are routed to the CapSense logic
and to the interrupt controller. The comparator LUT output
state and latched state may be directly read by the CPU
through the CMP_RDC register. A selection of comparator
state may also be driven to an output pin.
When disabled, the comparators consume no power. Two
active modes provide a full rail-to-rail input range, or a
somewhat lower power option with limited input range.
Register Definitions
The following registers are only associated with the Comparators in the CY8C20x34/24 PSoC device and are listed in
address order. For a complete table of the comparator registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the CapSense Registers” on
page 70. Each register description has an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. Register bits
that are grayed out throughout this document are reserved bits and are not detailed in the register descriptions that follow.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’.
12.2.1
Address
0,78h
CMP_RDC Register
Name
CMP_RDC
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
CMP1D
CMP0D
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
CMP1L
CMP0L
# : 00
LEGEND
# Access is bit specific.
The Comparator Read/Clear Register (CMP_RDC) is used
to read the state of the comparator data signal and the
latched state of the comparator.
Bit 5: CMP1D. Comparator 1 Data State. This bit is a readonly bit and returns the dynamically changing state of the
comparator.
Bit 4: CMP0D. Comparator 0 Data State. This bit is a readonly bit and returns the dynamically changing state of the
comparator.
Bit 1: CMP1L. Comparator 1 Latched State. This bit is set
and held high whenever the comparator 1 LUT goes high
since the last time this register was read. Refer to the
CRST1 bit in the CMP_CR1 register for information on how
the latch is cleared.
Bit 0: CMP0L. Comparator 0 Latched State. This bit is set
and held high whenever the comparator 0 LUT goes high
since the last time this register was read. Refer to the
CRST0 bit in the CMP_CR1 register for information on how
the latch is cleared.
For additional information, refer to the CMP_RDC register
on page 144.
84
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Comparators
12.2.2
Address
0,79h
CMP_MUX Register
Name
Bit 7
CMP_MUX
Bit 6
Bit 5
INP1[1:0]
Bit 4
Bit 0
INN0[1:0]
INPx[1:0]
Bits 5 and 4: INN1[1:0]. These bits select the negative
input data source for comparator 1. The selections are
shown in the table.
Access
RW : 00
INNx[1:0]
00
Analog Global Bus (Mix-ups
00
1.3V Reference
01
Reserved
01
RefLo Reference
10
P0[1] pad
10
RefHi Reference
11
P0[3] pad
11
Reserved
For additional information, refer to the CMP_MUX register
on page 145.
Bits 3 and 2: INP0[1:0]. These bits select the positive input
data source for comparator 0. The selections are shown in
the table.
Address
Bit 1
Bits 1 and 0: INN0[1:0]. These bits select the negative
input data source for comparator 0. The selections are
shown in the table below.
Bits 7 and 6: INP1[1:0]. These bits select the positive input
data source for comparator 1. The selections are shown in
the table.
0,7Ah
Bit 2
INP0[1:0]
The Comparator Multiplexer Register (CMP_MUX) contains
control bits for input selection of comparators 0 and 1.
12.2.3
Bit 3
INN1[1:0]
CMP_CR0 Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
CMP_CR0
Bit 5
Bit 4
CMP1R
CMP1EN
The Comparator Control Register 0 (CMP_CR0) is used to
enable and configure the input range of the comparators.
Bit 5: CMP1R. This bit selects the input range for comparator 1. Setting the bit high selects a somewhat lower power
mode that does not operate rail-to-rail.
Bit 4: CMP1EN. This bit enables comparator 1.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
CMP0R
CMP0EN
RW : 00
Bit 1: CMP0R. This bit selects the input range for comparator 1. Setting the bit high selects a somewhat lower power
mode that does not operate rail-to-rail.
Bit 0: CMP0EN. This bit enables comparator 0.
For additional information, refer to the CMP_CR0 register on
page 146.
85
[+] Feedback
Comparators
12.2.4
Address
0,7Bh
CMP_CR1 Register
Name
CMP_CR1
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
CINT1
CPIN1
CRST1
CDS1
CINT0
CPIN0
CRST0
CDS0
RW : 00
The Comparator Control Register 1 (CMP_CR1) is used to
configure the comparator output options.
Bit 3: CINT0. This bit connects the comparator 0 output to
the analog output.
Bit 7: CINT1. This bit connects the comparator 1 output to
the analog output.
Bit 2: CPIN0. This bit selects whether the comparator 0
LUT output or the latched output can be routed to a GPIO
pin.
Bit 6: CPIN1. This bit selects whether the comparator 1
LUT output or the latched output can be routed to a GPIO
pin.
Bit 1: CRST0. This bit selects whether the comparator 0
latch is reset on register write or by a rising edge from the
comparator 1 LUT output.
Bit 5: CRST1. This bit selects whether the comparator 1
latch is reset on register write or by a rising edge from the
comparator 0 LUT output.
Bit 0: CDS0. This bit selects between the comparator 0
LUT and the latched output, for the main comparator output,
that drives to the capacitive sense and interrupt logic.
Bit 4: CDS1. This bit selects between the comparator 1
LUT and the latched output, for the main comparator output,
that drives to the capacitive sense and interrupt logic.
12.2.5
Address
0,7Ch
For additional information, refer to the CMP_CR1 register on
page 147.
CMP_LUT Register
Name
CMP_LUT
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
LUT1[3:0]
The Comparator LUT Control Register (CMP_LUT) is used
to select the logic function.
Bits 7 to 4: LUT1[3:0]. These bits control the selection of
the LUT 1 logic functions that may be selected for the comparator channel 1.
Bit 2
Bit 1
LUT0[3:0]
Bit 0
Access
RW : 00
Bits 3 to 0: LUT0[3:0]. These bits control the selection of
LUT 0 logic functions that may be selected for the comparator channel 0.
CLUTx[3:0]
0h: 0000: FALSE
1h: 0001: A .AND. B
2h: 0010: A .AND. B
3h: 0011: A
4h: 0100: A .AND. B
5h: 0101: B
6h: 0110: A .XOR. B
7h: 0111: A .OR. B
8h: 1000: A .NOR. B
9h: 1001: A .XNOR. B
Ah: 1010: B
Bh: 1011: A .OR. B
Ch: 1100: A
Dh: 1101: A .OR. B
Eh: 1110: A. NAND. B
Fh: 1111: TRUE
For additional information, refer to the CMP_LUT register on
page 149.
86
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section D: System Resources
The System Resources section discusses the system resources that are available for the PSoC device and the registers
associated with those resources. This section encompasses the following chapters:
■
Digital Clocks on page 89.
■
POR and LVD on page 113.
■
I2C Slave on page 95.
■
Serial Peripheral Interface on page 115.
■
Internal Voltage References on page 105.
■
Programmable Timer on page 129.
■
System Resets on page 107.
Top Level System Resources Architecture
The figure below illustrates the top level architecture of the PSoC’s system resources. Each component of the figure is discussed in detail in this section.
PSoC System Resources
SYSTEM BUS
Digital
Clocks
I2C
Slave
Internal
Voltage
References
System
Resets
POR
and
LVD
SPI
Master/
Slave
Programmable
Timer
SYSTEM RESOURCES
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
87
[+] Feedback
Section D: System Resources
System Resources Register Summary
The table below lists all the PSoC registers for the system resources, in address order, within their system resource configuration. The bits that are grayed out are reserved bits. If these bits are written, they should always be written with a value of ‘0’.
Summary Table of the System Resource Registers
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
P10D
P10EN
Access
DIGITAL CLOCK REGISTERS (page 89)
1,DDh
OUT_P1
1,E0h
OSC_CR0
1,E2h
OSC_CR2
P16D
P16EN
P14D
Disable Buzz
No Buzz
P14EN
P12D
P12EN
Sleep[1:0]
EXTCLKEN
RW : 00
CPU Speed[2:0]
RW : 01
IMODIS
RW : 00
I2C SLAVE REGISTERS (page 95)
0,D6h
PSelect
I2C_CFG
0,D7h
I2C_SCR
0,D8h
I2C_DR
Stop IE
Stop
Status
Bus Error
Clock Rate[1:0]
ACK
Address
Transmit
LRB
Enable
RW : 00
Byte
Complete
R : 00
Data[7:0]
RW : 00
INTERNAL VOLTAGE REFERENCES REGISTER (page 106)
1,EAh
TC[2:0]
BDG_TR
V[4:0]
RW : 50
SYSTEM RESET REGISTERS (page 107)
0,FEh
CPU_SCR1
IRESS
0,FFh
CPU_SCR0
GIES
SLIMO
WDRS
PORS
Sleep
IRAMDIS
# : 00
STOP
# : XX
POR REGISTERS (page 113)
1,E3h
VLT_CR
1,E4h
VLT_CMP
PORLEV[1:0]
LVDTBEN
VM[2:0]
NoWrite
LVD
RW : 00
PPOR
R : 00
SPI REGISTERS (page 115)
0,29h
SPI_TXR
Data[7:0]
0,2Ah
SPI_RXR
Data[7:0]
0,2Bh
SPI_CR
1,29h
SPI_CFG
LSb First
Overrun
Clock Sel[2:0]
SPI
Complete
W : 00
R : 00
TX Reg
Empty
RX Reg Full
Bypass
SS_
Clock Phase
Clock
Polarity
Enable
# : 00
SS_EN_
Int Sel
Slave
RW : 00
One Shot
START
PROGRAMMABLE TIMER REGISTERS (page 129)
0,B0h
PT_CFG
0,B1h
PT_DATA1
0,B2h
PT_DATA0
Data[4:0]
Data[7:0]
RW : 00
RW : 00
RW : 00
LEGEND
X The value after power on reset is unknown.
R Read register or bit(s).
W Write register or bit(s).
# Access is bit specific. Refer to the Register Details chapter for additional information.
88
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
13. Digital Clocks
This chapter discusses the Digital Clocks and their associated registers. It serves as an overview of the clocking options
available in the PSoC devices. For detailed information on specific oscillators, see the individual oscillator chapters in the section called “PSoC Core” on page 23. For a complete table of the digital clock registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the
System Resource Registers” on page 88. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register
Reference chapter on page 137.
13.1
Architectural Description
The PSoC M8C core has a large number of clock sources
that increase the flexibility of the PSoC mixed-signal array,
as listed in Table 13-1 and illustrated in Figure 13-1.
Table 13-1. System Clocking Signals and Definitions
Signal
Definition
SYSCLK
Either the direct output of the Internal Main Oscillator or the
direct input of the EXTCLK pin while in external clocking
mode.
CPUCLK
SYSCLK is divided down to one of eight possible frequencies, to create CPUCLK which determines the speed of the
M8C. See OSC_CR0 in the Register Definitions section of
this chapter.
CLK32K
The Internal Low Speed Oscillators output. See OSC_CR0 in
the Register Definitions section of this chapter.
CLK12M
The internally generated 12 MHz clock by the IMO. By
default, this clock drives SYSCLK; however, an external clock
may be used by enabling EXTCLK mode. Also, the IMO may
be put into a slow mode using the SLIMO bit which will
change the speed of the IMO and the CLK24M to 6 MHz or
12 MHz.
SLEEP
One of four sleep intervals may be selected from 1.95 ms to 1
second. See OSC_CR0 in the Register Definitions section of
this chapter.
13.1.1
Internal Main Oscillator
The Internal Main Oscillator (IMO) is the foundation upon
which almost all other clock sources in the PSoC mixed-signal array are based. The default mode of the IMO creates a
12 MHz reference clock that is used by many other circuits
in the PSoC device. The PSoC device has an option to
replace the IMO with an externally supplied clock that will
become the base for all of the clocks the IMO normally
serves. The internal base clock net is called SYSCLK and
may be driven by either the IMO or an external clock (EXTCLK).
Whether the external clock or the internal main oscillator is
selected, all PSoC device functions are clocked from a
derivative of SYSCLK or are resynchronized to SYSCLK. All
external asynchronous signals, as well as the internal low
speed oscillator, are resynchronized to SYSCLK for use in
the digital PSoC blocks.
Some PSoC devices contain the option to lower the internal
oscillator’s system clock from 12 MHz to 6 MHz. See the
“Architectural Description” on page 57, in the Internal Main
Oscillator chapter, for more information.
The IMO is discussed in detail in the chapter “Internal Main
Oscillator (IMO)” on page 57.
13.1.2
Internal Low Speed Oscillator
The Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO) is always on. The
ILO is available as a general clock, but is also the clock
source for the sleep and watchdog timers.
The ILO is discussed in detail in the chapter “Internal Low
Speed Oscillator (ILO)” on page 59.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
89
[+] Feedback
Digital Clocks
Figure 13-1. Overview of PSoC Clock Sources
IMO Trim Register
P1[4]
(EXTCLK Input)
IMO_TR[7:0]
Internal
Main
Oscillator
(IMO)
OSC_CR2[2]
SYSCLK
EXTCLK
Clock Divider
OSC_CR0[2:0]
CPU_SCR1[4]
Slow IMO Option
1
2
4
8
16
32
128
256
Internal
Low Speed
Oscillator
(ILO)
CPUCLK
CLK32K
Sleep Clock Divider
OSC_CR0[4:3]
269
2 12
215
2
ILO_TR[7:0]
ILO Trim Register
13.1.3
External Clock
The ability to replace the 12 MHz internal main oscillator
(IMO), as the device master system clock (SYSCLK) with an
externally supplied clock, is a feature in the PSoC mixedsignal array (see Figure 13-1).
Pin P1[4] is the input pin for the external clock. If P1[4] is
selected as the external clock source, the drive mode of the
pin must be set to High-Z (not High-Z analog).
An external clock with a frequency between 1 MHz and 12
MHz can be supplied. The reset state of the EXTCLKEN bit
is ‘0’; therefore, the device always boots up under the control of the IMO. There is no way to start the system from a
reset state with the external clock.
When the EXTCLKEN bit is set, the external clock becomes
the source for the internal clock tree, SYSCLK, which drives
most PSoC device clocking functions. All external and internal signals, including the 1 kHz clock, are synchronized to
this clock source.
90
13.1.3.1
SLEEP
Switch Operation
Switching between the IMO and the external clock may be
done in firmware at any time and is transparent to the user.
Since all PSoC device resources run on clocks derived from
or synchronized to SYSCLK, when the switch is made, analog and digital functions may be momentarily interrupted.
When a switch is made from the IMO to the external clock,
the IMO may be turned off to save power. This is done by
setting the IMODIS bit and may be done immediately after
the instruction that sets the EXTCLKEN bit. However, the
IMO must not be disabled if the external clock is slower than
6 MHz. When switching back from an external clock to the
IMO, the IMODIS bit must be cleared and a firmware delay
implemented. This gives the IMO sufficient start-up time
before the EXTCLKEN bit is cleared.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Digital Clocks
Switch timing depends on whether the CPU clock divider is
set for divide by 1, or divide by 2 or greater. In the case
where the CPU clock divider is set for divide by 2 or greater,
as shown in Figure 13-2, the setting of the EXTCLKEN bit
occurs shortly after the rising edge of SYSCLK. The
SYSCLK output is then disabled after the next falling edge
of SYSCLK, but before the next rising edge. This ensures a
glitch-free transition and provides a full cycle of setup time
from SYSCLK to output disable. Once the current clock
selection is disabled, the enable of the newly selected clock
is double synchronized to that clock. After synchronization,
on the subsequent negative edge, SYSCLK is enabled to
output the newly selected clock.
In the 12 MHz case, as shown in Figure 13-3, the assertion
of IOW_ and thus the setting of the EXTCLKEN bit occurs
on the falling edge of SYSCLK. Since SYSCLK is already
low, the output is immediately disabled. Therefore, the setup
time from SYSCLK to disable is one half SYSCLK.
Figure 13-2. Switch from IMO to the External Clock with a CPU Clock Divider of Two or Greater
IMO
Extenal Clock
SYSCLK
CPUCLK
IOW_
EXTCLK bit
IMO is
disabled.
External clock is
enabled.
Figure 13-3. Switch from IMO to External Clock with the CPU Running with a CPU Clock Divider of One
IMO
External Clock
SYSCLK
CPUCLK
IOW
EXTCLK
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
IMO is
disabled.
External clock is
enabled.
91
[+] Feedback
Digital Clocks
13.2
Register Definitions
The following registers are associated with the Digital Clocks and are listed in address order. Each register description has an
associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. The bits in the tables that are grayed out throughout this
manual are reserved bits and are not detailed in the register descriptions that follow. Always write reserved bits with a value of
‘0’. For a complete table of digital clock registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the System Resource Registers” on page 88.
13.2.1
Address
1,DDh
OUT_P1 Register
Name
OUT_P1
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
P16D
P16EN
P14D
P14EN
P12D
P12EN
P10D
P10EN
RW : 00
The Output Override to Port 1 Register (OUT_P1) enables
specific internal signals to be output to Port 1 pins. If any
other function, such as I2C, is enabled for output on these
pins, that function has higher priority than the OUT_P1 signals.
Bit 7: P16D. This bit selects either the TIMEROUT or
CLK32 signals for output on P1[6]. P16EN must be high for
the signal to be output on that pin.
Bit 6: P16EN. This bit enables pin P1[6] for output of the
signal selected by the P16D bit.
Bit 5: P14D. This bit selects either the RO or CMP1 signals
for output on P1[4]. P14EN must be high for the signal to be
output on that pin.
Bit 4: P14EN. This bit enables pin P1[4] for output of the
signal selected by the P14D bit.
Bit 3: P12D. This bit selects either the SYSCLK or CS signals for output on P1[2]. P12EN must be high for the signal
to be output on that pin.
Bit 2: P12EN. This bit enables pin P1[2] for output of the
signal selected by the P12D bit.
Bit 1: P10D. This bit selects either the SLPINT or CMP0
signals for output on P1[0]. P10EN must be high for the signal to be output on that pin.
Bit 0: P10EN. This bit enables pin P1[0] for output of the
signal selected by the P10D bit.
For additional information, refer to the OUT_P1 register on
page 185.
92
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Digital Clocks
13.2.2
OSC_CR0 Register
Address
1,E0h
Name
Bit 7
OSC_CR0
Bit 6
Bit 5
Disable Buzz
No Buzz
The Oscillator Control Register 0 (OSC_CR0) is used to
configure various features of internal clock sources and
clock nets.
Bit 6: Disable Buzz. Setting this bit causes the bandgap
and POR/LVD systems to remain powered off continuously
during sleep. In this case, there is no periodic “buzz” (brief
wakeup) of these functions during sleep. This bit has no
effect when the No Buzz bit is set high.
Bit 5: No Buzz. Normally, when the Sleep bit is set in the
CPU_SCR register, all PSoC device systems are powered
down, including the bandgap reference. However, to facilitate the detection of POR and LVD events at a rate higher
than the sleep interval, the bandgap circuit is powered up
periodically (for about 60 μs) at the Sleep System Duty
Cycle, which is independent of the sleep interval and typically higher. When the No Buzz bit is set, the Sleep System
Duty Cycle value is overridden and the bandgap circuit is
forced to be on during sleep. This results in faster response
to an LVD or POR event (continuous detection as opposed
to periodic), at the expense of higher average sleep current.
Bits 4 and 3: Sleep[1:0]. The available sleep interval
selections are shown in the table below. Sleep intervals are
approximate based on the accuracy of the internal low
speed oscillator.
Sleep Interval
OSC_CR[4:3]
Sleep Timer
Clocks
Sleep Period
(nominal)
Watchdog
Period
(nominal)
00b (default)
64
1.95 ms
6 ms
01b
512
15.6 ms
47 ms
10b
4096
125 ms
375 ms
11b
32,768
1 sec
3 sec
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Sleep[1:0]
Bit 1
CPU Speed[2:0]
Bit 0
Access
RW : 01
The CPU frequency is changed with a write to the
OSC_CR0 register. There are eight frequencies generated
from a power-of-two divide circuit which are selected by a 3bit code. At any given time, the CPU 8-to-1 clock mux is
selecting one of the available frequencies, which is resynchronized to the 12 MHz master clock at the output.
A slow IMO option is also supported, as discussed in the
IMO chapter in the “Architectural Description” on page 57.
This offers an option to lower both system and CPU clock
speed in order to save power.
Bits
6 MHz Internal
Main Oscillator
12 MHz Internal
Main Oscillator
External Clock
000b
750 kHz
1.5 MHz
EXTCLK/ 8
001b
1.5 MHz
3.0 MHz
EXTCLK/ 4
010b
3 MHz
6.0 MHz
EXTCLK/ 2
011b
6 MHz
12.0 MHz
EXTCLK/ 1
100b
375 kHz
750 kHz
EXTCLK/ 16
101b
187.5 kHz
375 kHz
EXTCLK/ 32
110b
46.8 kHz
93.7 kHz
EXTCLK/ 128
111b
23.4 kHz
46.8 kHz
EXTCLK/ 256
An automatic protection mechanism is available for systems
that need to run at peak CPU clock speed but cannot guarantee a high enough supply voltage for that clock speed.
See the LVDTBEN bit in the “VLT_CR Register” on page 113
for more information.
For additional information, refer to the OSC_CR0 register on
page 186.
Bits 2 to 0: CPU Speed[2:0]. The PSoC M8C may operate
over a range of CPU clock speeds as illustrated in the table
below, allowing the M8C’s performance and power requirements to be tailored to the application.
The reset value for the CPU speed bits is 001b. Therefore,
the default CPU speed is one fourth of the clock source. The
internal main oscillator is the default clock source for the
CPU speed circuit; therefore, the default CPU speed is 3.0
MHz. See “External Clock” on page 90 for more information
on the supported frequencies for externally supplied clocks.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
93
[+] Feedback
Digital Clocks
13.2.3
Address
1,E2h
OSC_CR2 Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
OSC_CR2
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
EXTCLKEN
IMODIS
Bit 0
Access
RW : 00
The Oscillator Control Register 2 (OSC_CR2) is used to
configure various features of internal clock sources and
clock nets.
input, the pin drive mode should be set to High-Z (not HighZ analog), such as drive mode 11b with PRT1DR bit 4 set
high.
Bit 2: EXTCLKEN. When the EXTCLKEN bit is set, the
external clock becomes the source for the internal clock
tree, SYSCLK, which drives most PSoC device clocking
functions. All external and internal signals, including the low
speed oscillator, are synchronized to this clock source. The
external clock input is located on P1[4]. When using this
Bit 1: IMODIS. When set, the Internal Main Oscillator (IMO)
is disabled.
13.2.4
■
■
94
For additional information, refer to the OSC_CR2 register on
page 187.
Related Registers
“INT_CLR0 Registers” on page 48.
“INT_MSK0 Register” on page 49.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
14. I2C Slave
This chapter explains the I2C™ Slave block and its associated registers. The I2C communications block is a serial processor
designed to implement a complete I2C slave. For a complete table of the I2C registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the
System Resource Registers” on page 88. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register
Reference chapter on page 137.
14.1
Architectural Description
The I2C communications block is a serial to parallel processor, designed to interface the PSoC device to a two-wire I2C
serial communications bus. To eliminate the need for excessive M8C microcontroller intervention and overhead, the
block provides I2C specific support for status detection and
generation of framing bits.
PSoC I2C features include:
Figure 14-1. I2C Slave Block Diagram
Hardware functionality provides basic I2C control, data, and
status primitives. A combination of hardware support and
firmware command sequencing provides a high degree of
flexibility for implementing the required I2C functionality.
I2C Slave Block
SDA_IN
SCL_IN
DATA_IN
CLK_IN
DATA_OUT
CLK_OUT
SYSCLK
SDA_OUT
SCL_OUT
INT
Registers
CONFIGURATION[7:0]
CONTROL[7:0]
DATA[7:0]
The I2C block controls the data (SDA) and the clock (SCL)
to the external I2C interface, through direct connections to
two dedicated GPIO pins. When I2C is enabled, these GPIO
pins are not available for general purpose use. The PSoC
device firmware interacts with the block through IO (input/
output) register reads and writes, and firmware synchronization will be implemented through polling and/or interrupts.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
■
■
■
■
■
Slave, Transmitter/Receiver operation
Byte processing for low CPU overhead
Interrupt or polling CPU interface
7- or 10-bit addressing (through firmware support)
SMBus operation (through firmware support)
Hardware limitations in regards to I2C are:
1. There is no hardware support for automatic address
comparison. Every slave address will cause the block to
interrupt the PSoC device and possibly stall the bus.
2. Since receive and transmitted data are not buffered,
there is no support for automatic receive acknowledge.
The M8C microcontroller must intervene at the boundary
of each byte and either send a byte or ACK received
bytes.
The I2C block is designed to support a set of primitive operations and detect a set of status conditions specific to the
I2C protocol. These primitive operations and conditions are
manipulated and combined at the firmware level to support
the required data transfer modes. The CPU will set up control options and issue commands to the unit through IO
writes and obtain status through IO reads and interrupts.
The block operates as a slave. In Slave mode, the unit is
always listening for a Start condition, or sending or receiving
data.
95
[+] Feedback
I2C Slave
14.1.1
Basic I2C Data Transfer
Figure 14-2 shows the basic form of data transfers on the
I2C bus with a 7-bit address format. (For a more detailed
description, see the Philips Semiconductors’ I2C™ Specification, version 2.1.)
A Start condition (generated by the master) is followed by a
data byte, consisting of a 7-bit slave address (there is also a
10-bit address mode) and a Read/Write (RW) bit. The RW
bit sets the direction of data transfer. The addressed slave is
required to acknowledge (ACK) the bus by pulling the data
line low during the ninth bit time. If the ACK is received, the
transfer may proceed and the master can transmit or
receive an indeterminate number of bytes, depending on the
RW direction. If the slave does not respond with an ACK for
any reason, a Stop condition is generated by the master to
terminate the transfer or a Restart condition may be generated for a retry attempt.
Figure 14-2. Basic I2C Data Transfer with 7-Bit Address Format
START
7-Bit Address
1
14.2
14.2.1
R/W
7
8
ACK
9
8-Bit Data
1
ACK/
NACK
7
8
STOP
9
Application Overview
Slave Operation
When the IC slave operation is enabled, it is continually listening to or on the bus for a Start condition. When detected,
the transmitted Address/RW byte is received and read from
the I2C block by firmware. At the point where eight bits of
the address/RW byte have been received, a byte complete
interrupt is generated. On the following low of the clock, the
bus is stalled by holding the SCL line low, until the PSoC
device has had a chance to read the address byte and compare it to its own address. It will issue an ACK or NACK
command based on that comparison.
If there is an address match, the RW bit determines how the
PSoC device will sequence the data transfer in Slave mode,
as shown in the two branches of Figure 14-3. I2C handshaking methodology (slave holds the SCL line low to “stall” the
bus) will be used as necessary, to give the PSoC device
time to respond to the events and conditions on the bus.
Figure 14-3 is a graphical representation of a typical data
transfer from the slave perspective.
96
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
I2C Slave
Figure 14-3. Slave Operation
Master may
transmit
another byte
or STOP.
M8C writes
(ACK) to
I2C_SCR
register.
Slave Transmitter/Reciever
)
(R
X
rit
e
7-Bit Address
STOP
ACK/
NACK
1
W
START
7
8
9
NACK =
Slave says no
more
R/W
SHIFTER
7
8
M8C reads the
received byte from
the I2C_DR register.
d
ea
R
1
ACK = OK to
receive more
8-Bit Data
ACK
A byte interrupt is
generated. The SCL line
is held low.
M8C issues ACK/
NACK command
with a write to the
I2C_SCR register.
An interrupt is generated
on byte complete. The
SCL line is held low.
X
(T
)
SHIFTER
M8C reads the
received byte from the
I2C_DR register and
checks for “Own
Address” and R/W.
SHIFTER
M8C writes the
byte to transmit
to the I2C_DR
register.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
An interrupt is generated
on a complete byte +
ACK/NACK. The SCL line
is held low.
M8C writes
(ACK | TRANSMIT) to
I2C_SCR register.
8-Bit Data
ACK
ACK/
NACK
9
1
7
8
M8C writes a new byte to the
I2C_DR register and then writes
a TRANSMIT command to
I2C_SCR to release the bus.
NACK = Master
says end-of-data
STOP
9
ACK = Master
wants to read
another byte.
97
[+] Feedback
I2C Slave
14.3
Register Definitions
The following registers are associated with I2C Slave and are listed in address order. Each register description has an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. The bits in the tables that are grayed out are reserved bits and
are not detailed in the register descriptions that follow. Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For a complete table of
I2C registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the System Resource Registers” on page 88.
I2C_CFG Register
Bit 5
Bit 4
The I2C Configuration Register (I2C_CFG) is used to set
the basic operating modes, baud rate, and selection of interrupts.
The bits in this register control baud rate selection and
optional interrupts. The values are typically set once for a
given configuration. The bits in this register are all RW.
Mode
1 = P1[1], P1[0]
RW
Stop IE
Slave
Stop interrupt enable.
0 = Disabled.
1 = Enabled. An interrupt is generated on the
detection of a Stop Condition.
3:2
RW
Clock Rate
Access
RW : 00
Even if ISSP is not used, pins P1[1] and P1[0] will respond
differently to a POR or XRES event than other IO pins. After
an XRES event, both pins are pulled down to ground by
going into the resistive zero drive mode, before reaching the
High-Z Drive mode. After a POR event, P1[0] will drive out a
one, then go to the resistive zero state for some time, and
finally reach the High-Z drive mode state. After POR, P1[1]
will go into a resistive zero state for a while, before going to
the High-Z Drive mode.
Slave
0 = P1[7], P1[5]
4
Bit 0
Enable
Slave
00 = 100K Standard Mode
01 = 400K Fast Mode
10 = 50K Standard Mode
11 = Reserved
Bit 6: PSelect. Pin Select. With the default value of zero,
the I2C pins are P1[7] for clock and P1[5] for data. When
this bit is set, the pins for I2C switch to P1[1] for clock and
P1[0] for data. This bit may not be changed while the Enable
bit is set. However, the PSelect bit may be set at the same
time as the enable bits. The two sets of pins that may be
used on I2C are not equivalent. The default set, P1[7] and
P1[5], are the preferred set. The alternate set, P1[1] and
P1[0], are provided so that I2C may be used with 8-pin
PSoC devices.
If In-circuit System Serial Programming (ISSP®) is used and
the alternate I2C pin set is also used, it is necessary to take
into account the interaction between the PSoC Test Controller and the I2C bus. The interface requirements for ISSP
should be reviewed to ensure that they are not violated.
Bit 4: Stop IE. Stop Interrupt Enable. When this bit is set, a
slave can interrupt on Stop detection. The status bit associated with this interrupt is the Stop Status bit in the I2C_SCR
register. When the Stop Status bit transitions from ‘0’ to ‘1’,
the interrupt is generated. It is important to note that the
Stop Status bit is not automatically cleared. Therefore, if it is
already set, no new interrupts are generated until it is
cleared by firmware.
Bits 3 and 2: Clock Rate[1:0]. These bits offer a selection
of three sampling and bit rates. All block clocking is based
on the SYSCLK input, which is nominally 12 MHz or 6 MHz
(unless the PSoC device is in external clocking mode). The
sampling rate and the baud rate are determined as follows:
■
■
Sample Rate = SYSCLK/Pre-scale Factor
Baud Rate = 1/(Sample Rate x Samples per Bit)
The nominal values, when using the internal 12 MHz or 6
MHz oscillator, are shown in this table:.
00b
0
Standard
1
01b
0
10b
0
Fast
0
16
1.5 MHz/
667 ns
93.75 kHz
5.3 μs
16
6 MHz/
167 ns
375 kHz
1.33 μs
32
1.5 MHz/
667 ns
46.8 kHz
10.7 μs
/2
/1
Standard
1
11b
/8
/4
1
Start/Stop
Hold Time
(8 clocks)
Description
I2C Pin Select
Bit 1
Master
Baud Rate
(nominal)
Access
RW
Bit 2
Clock Rate[1:0]
Internal
Sampling
Freq./Period
(12 MHz)
Bit
6
Bit 3
Stop IE
Samples
per Bit
Bit 6
PSelect
SYSCLK
Pre-scale
Factor
Bit 7
I2C Mode
Name
I2C_CFG
SLIMO
Address
0,D6h
Clock Rate
[1:0]
14.3.1
/8
/4
Reserved
1
98
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
I2C Slave
When clocking the input with a frequency other than 6/12
MHz (for example, clocking the PSOC device with an external clock), the baud rates and sampling rates will scale
accordingly. Whether the block works in a Standard Mode or
Fast Mode system depends upon the sample rate. The sample rate must be sufficient to resolve bus events, such as
Start and Stop conditions. (See the Philips Semiconductors’
I2C™ Specification, version 2.1, for minimum Start and Stop
hold times.)
Enable
No
The block is disconnected from the GPIO pins, P1[5] and P1[7].
(The pins may be used as general purpose IO.) When the slave
is enabled, the GPIO pins are under control of the I2C hardware
and are unavailable.
All internal registers (except I2C_CFG) are held in reset.
Yes
Address
0,D7h
Slave Mode
Any external Start condition will cause the block to start receiving
an address byte. Regardless of the current state, any Start resets
the interface and initiates a Receive operation. Any Stop will
cause the block to revert to an idle state
Bit 0: Enable. When the slave is enabled, the block generates an interrupt on any Start condition and an address byte
that it receives indicating the beginning of an I2C transfer.
The block is clocked from an external master. Therefore, the
block works at any frequency up to the maximum defined by
the currently selected clock rate. The internal clock is only
used to ensure that there is adequate setup time from data
output to the next clock on the release of a slave stall. When
the Enable bit is ‘0’, the block is held in reset and all status is
cleared. Block enable will be synchronized to the SYSCLK
clock input (see “Timing Diagrams” on page 101).
14.3.2
Block Operation
Disabled
For additional information, refer to the I2C_CFG register on
page 167.
I2C_SCR Register
Name
I2C_SCR
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bus Error
Bit 5
Stop
Status
Bit 4
ACK
Bit 3
Address
Bit 2
Transmit
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
LRB
Byte
Complete
# : 00
LEGEND
# Access is bit specific.
The I2C Status and Control Register (I2C_SCR) is used by
the slave to control the flow of data bytes and to keep track
of the bus state during a transfer.
This register contains status bits, for determining the state of
the current I2C transfer, and control bits, for determining the
actions for the next byte transfer. At the end of each byte
transfer, the I2C hardware interrupts the M8C microcontroller and stalls the I2C bus on the subsequent low of the
clock, until the PSoC device intervenes with the next command. This register may be read as many times as necessary; but on a subsequent write to this register, the bus stall
is released and the current transfer will continue.
There are six status bits: Byte Complete, LRB, Address,
Stop Status, Lost Arb, and Bus Error. These bits have Read/
Clear (RC) access, which means that they are set by hardware but may be cleared by a write of ‘0’ to the bit position.
Under certain conditions, status is cleared automatically by
the hardware. These cases are noted in the table shown
below.
Bit 7: Bus Error. The Bus Error status detects misplaced
Start or Stop conditions on the bus. These may be due to
noise, rogue devices, or other devices that are not yet synchronized with the I2C bus traffic. According to the I2C
specification, all compatible devices must reset their interface on a received Start or Stop. This is a natural thing to do
in Slave mode because a Start will initiate an address reception and a Stop will idle the slave.
A bus error is defined as follows. A Start is only valid if the
block is idle or a Slave receiver is ready to receive the first
bit of a new byte after an ACK. Any other timing for a Start
condition causes the Bus Error bit to be set. A Stop is only
valid if the block is idle or a Slave receiver is ready to
receive the first bit of a new byte after an ACK. Any other
timing for a Stop condition causes the Bus Error bit to be set.
There are two control bits: Transmit and ACK. These bits
have RW access and may be cleared by hardware.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
99
[+] Feedback
I2C Slave
Bit
Access
Description
7
RC
Bus Error
1 = A misplaced Start or Stop condition was detected.
This status bit must be cleared by firmware with a write of
‘0’ to the bit position. It is never cleared by the hardware.
5
RC
Stop Status
1 = A Stop condition was detected.
This status bit must be cleared by firmware with a write of
‘0’ to the bit position. It is never cleared by the hardware.
4
RW
ACK: Acknowledge Out
0 = NACK the last received byte.
1 = ACK the last received byte.
This bit is automatically cleared by hardware on the following Byte Complete event.
3
RC
Address
1 = The transmitted or received byte is an address.
This status bit must be cleared by firmware with a write of
‘0’ to the bit position.
2
RW
Transmit
0 = Receive Mode.
1 = Transmit Mode.
This bit is set by firmware to define the direction of the
byte transfer.
Any Start detect will automatically clear this bit.
1
RC
LRB: Last Received Bit
The value of the ninth bit in a Transmit sequence, which is
the acknowledge bit from the receiver.
0 = Last transmitted byte was ACK’ed by the receiver.
1 = Last transmitted byte was NACK’ed by the receiver.
Any Start detect will automatically clear this bit.
0
RC
Byte Complete
Transmit Mode:
1 = 8 bits of data have been transmitted and an ACK or
NACK has been received.
Receive Mode:
1 = 8 bits of data have been received.
Any Start detect will automatically clear this bit.
Bit 5: Stop Status. Stop status is set on detection of an I2C
Stop condition. This bit is sticky, which means that it will
remain set until a ‘0’ is written back to it by the firmware.
This bit may only be cleared if the Byte Complete status bit
is set. If the Stop Interrupt Enable bit is set, an interrupt is
also generated on Stop detection. It is never automatically
cleared.
Using this bit, a slave can distinguish between a previous
Stop or Restart on a given address byte interrupt.
Bit 4: ACK. This control bit defines the acknowledge data
bit that is transmitted out in response to a received byte.
When receiving, a Byte Complete interrupt is generated
after the eighth data bit is received. On the subsequent write
to this register to continue (or terminate) the transfer, the
state of this bit will determine the next bit of data that is
transmitted. It is active high. A ‘1’ will send an ACK and a
‘0’ will send a NACK. A Slave receiver sends a NACK to
inform the master that it cannot receive any more bytes.
100
Bit 3: Address. This bit is set when an address has been
received. This consists of a Start or Restart, and an address
byte.
In Slave mode, when this status is set, firmware will read the
received address from the data register and compare it with
its own address. If the address does not match, the firmware
will write a NACK indication to this register. No further interrupts will occur until the next address is received. If the
address does match, firmware must ACK the received byte,
then Byte Complete interrupts are generated on subsequent
bytes of the transfer.
Bit 2: Transmit. This bit sets the direction of the shifter for
a subsequent byte transfer. The shifter is always shifting in
data from the I2C bus, but a write of ‘1’ enables the output of
the shifter to drive the SDA output line. Since a write to this
register initiates the next transfer, data must be written to the
data register prior to writing this bit. In Receive mode, the
previously received data must have been read from the data
register before this write. Firmware derives this direction
from the RW bit in the received slave address.
This direction control is only valid for data transfers. The
direction of address bytes is determined by the hardware.
Bit 1: LRB. Last Received Bit. This is the last received bit
in response to a previously transmitted byte. In Transmit
mode, the hardware will send a byte from the data register
and clock in an acknowledge bit from the receiver. On the
subsequent byte complete interrupt, firmware will check the
value of this bit. A ‘0’ is the ACK value and a ‘1’ is a NACK
value. The meaning of the LRB depends on the current
operating mode.
‘0’: ACK. The master wants to read another byte. The
slave should load the next byte into the I2C_DR register
and set the transmit bit in the I2C_SCR register to continue the transfer.
‘1’: NACK. The master is done reading bytes. The slave
will revert to IDLE state on the subsequent I2C_SCR
write (regardless of the value written).
Bit 0: Byte Complete. The I2C hardware operates on a
byte basis. In Transmit mode, this bit is set and an interrupt
is generated at the end of nine bits (the transmitted byte +
the received ACK). In Receive mode, the bit is set after the
eight bits of data are received. When this bit is set, an interrupt is generated at these data sampling points, which are
associated with the SCL input clock rising (see details in
“Timing Diagrams” on page 101). If the PSoC device
responds with a write back to this register before the subsequent falling edge of SCL (which is approximately one-half
bit time), the transfer will continue without interruption. However, if the PSoC device is unable to respond within that
time, the hardware will hold the SCL line low, stalling the I2C
bus. A subsequent write to the I2C_SCR register will
release the stall.
For additional information, refer to the I2C_SCR register on
page 168.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
I2C Slave
14.3.3
Address
0,D8h
I2C_DR Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
I2C_DR
Bit 4
Bit 3
Data[7:0]
The I2C Data Register (I2C_DR) provides read/write access
to the Shift register.
Bits 7 to 0: Data[7:0]. This register is not buffered; therefore, writes and valid data reads may only occur at specific
points in the transfer. These cases are outlined as follows.
■
Slave Receiver – Data in the I2C_DR register is only
valid for reading when the Byte Complete status bit is
set. Data bytes must be read from the I2C_DR register
14.4
14.4.1
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RW : 00
before writing to the I2C_SCR register, which continues
the transfer.
■
Slave Transmitter – Data bytes must be written to the
I2C_DR register before the transmit bit is set in the
I2C_SCR register, which continues the transfer.
For additional information, refer to the I2C_DR register on
page 169.
Timing Diagrams
Clock Generation
Figure 14-4 illustrates the I2C input clocking scheme. The SYSCLK pin is an input into a three-stage ripple divider that provides the baud rate selections. When the block is disabled, all internal state is held in a reset state. When the Enable bit in the
I2C_CFG register is set, the reset is synchronously released and the clock generation is enabled. All three taps from the ripple divider are selectable (/2, /4, /8) from the clock rate bits in the I2C_CFG register. If any of the three divider taps is
selected, that clock is resynchronized to SYSCLK. The resulting clock is routed to all of the synchronous elements in the
design.
Figure 14-4. I2C Input Clocking
I/O WRITE
SYSCLK
ENABLE
BLOCK RESET
2
4
8
RESYNC CLOCK
Default
8
Two SYSCLKS to first block clock.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
101
[+] Feedback
I2C Slave
14.4.2
Basic IO Timing
Figure 14-5 illustrates basic input output timing that is valid for both 16 times sampling and 32 times sampling. For 16 times
sampling, N=4; for 32 times sampling, N=12. N is derived from the half-bit rate sampling of eight and 16 clocks, respectively,
minus the input latency of three (count of 4 and 12 correspond to 5 and 13 clocks).
Figure 14-5. Basic Input/Output Timing
CLOCK
SCL
SCL_IN
CLK CTR
N
0
1
SHIFT
SDA_IN
SDA_OUT
14.4.3
2
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
1
2
...
...
...
...
Figure 14-6 illustrates the interrupt timing for Byte Complete, which occurs on the positive edge of the ninth clock
(byte + ACK/NACK) in Transmit mode and on the positive
edge of the eighth clock in Receive mode. There is a maximum of three cycles of latency due to the input synchronizer/filter circuit. As shown, the interrupt occurs on the
clock following a valid SCL positive edge input transition
(after the synchronizers). The Address bit is set with the
same timing but only after a slave address has been
received. The LRB (Last Received Bit) status is also set with
the same timing but only on the ninth bit after a transmitted
byte.
Max
3 Cycles
Latency
0
...
Status Timing
Figure 14-6. Byte Complete, Address, LRB Timing
N
N
0
Figure 14-7 shows the timing for Stop Status. This bit is set
(and the interrupt occurs) two clocks after the synchronized
and filtered SDA line transitions to a ‘1’, when the SCL line is
high.
Figure 14-7. Stop Status and Interrupt Timing
CLOCK
SCL
SDA
SDA_IN
Synchronized)
TOP DETECT
STOP IRQ
and STATUS
CLOCK
Figure 14-8 illustrates the timing for bus error interrupts. Bus
Error status (and Interrupt) occurs one cycle after the internal Start or Stop Detect (two cycles after the filtered and synchronized SDA input transition).
SCL
SCL_IN
Synchronized)
IRQ
Transmit: Ninth positive edge SCL
Receive: Eighth positive edge SCL
102
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
I2C Slave
Figure 14-8. Bus Error Interrupt Timing
Misplaced Start
CLOCK
SCL
SDA
SDA_IN
(Synchronized)
START DETECT
BUS ERROR
and INTERRUPT
Misplaced Stop
CLOCK
SCL
SDA
SDA_IN
(Synchronized)
STOP DETECT
BUS ERROR
and INTERRUPT
14.4.4
Slave Stall Timing
When a Byte Complete interrupt occurs, the PSoC device firmware must respond with a write to the I2C_SCR register to continue the transfer (or terminate the transfer). The interrupt occurs two clocks after the rising edge of SCL_IN (see “Status Timing” on page 102). As illustrated in Figure 14-9, firmware has until one clock after the falling edge of SCL_IN to write to the
I2C_SCR register; otherwise, a stall occurs. Once stalled, the IO write releases the stall. The setup time between data output
and the next rising edge of SCL is always N-1 clocks.
Figure 14-9. Slave Stall Timing
I/O WRITE
CLOCK
SCL
SCL_IN
(Synchronized)
1 Clocks
N-1 Clocks
SDA_OUT
SCL_OUT
No STALL
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
STALL
103
[+] Feedback
I2C Slave
104
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
15. Internal Voltage References
This chapter discusses the Internal Voltage References and their associated register. The internal voltage references provide
an absolute value of 1.3V to a variety of subsystems in the PSoC device. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in
address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
15.1
Architectural Description
Figure 15-1. Voltage Reference Schematic
The internal voltage references consist of two blocks: a
bandgap voltage generator and a buffer with sample and
hold. The bandgap generator is typically a (VBE + K VT)
design, where K is a numerical constant determined by circuit parameters.The buffer circuit provides gain to the 1.2V
bandgap voltage, to produce a 1.3V reference. A simplified
schematic is illustrated in Figure 15-1. The connection
between amplifier and capacitor is made through a CMOS
switch, allowing the reference voltage to be used by the system while the reference circuit is powered down. The voltage reference is trimmed to 1.30V at room temperature.
VBG
S+H
+
-
VREF
Another block, which is associated with the internal voltage
reference circuitry, is the Flash trim buffer. Figure 15-2
shows the conceptual block diagram for the Flash trim
buffer.
Figure 15-2. Flash Trim Buffer
vout 18 = 1.8V
FLS_PR3[1:0]
Mode Select
FLS_PR2[7:0]
b2
b1
VFB = 1.3V
Digital
Logic
b0
Rtop
Rtrimmable
Band
Gap
1.3V
VREF
To Flash
3:8
Decoder
FLTRIM
To Flash
Rbot
VGND = 0.0V
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
105
[+] Feedback
Internal Voltage References
15.2
Register Definitions
This register is associated with the Internal Voltage References. The Internal Voltage References are trimmed for gain and
temperature coefficient using the BDG_TR register. The register description below has an associated register table showing
the bit structure.
15.2.1
BDG_TR Register
Add.
Name
1,EAh
BDG_TR
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
TC[2:0]
Bit 3
Bit 2
V[4:0]
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RW : 50
The Bandgap Trim Register (BDG_TR) is used to adjust the
bandgap and add an RC filter to Agnd.
Bits 4 to 0: V[4:0]. These bits are for setting the gain in the
reference buffer. 32 steps of 2.129 mV are available.
It is strongly recommended that the user not alter the
value of the bits in this register.
The value of these bits is used to trim the bandgap reference. Their value is set to the best value for the device during boot. The value of these bits should not be changed.
Bits 7 to 5: TC[2:0]. These bits are for setting the temperature coefficient inside the bandgap voltage generator.
For additional information, refer to the BDG_TR register on
page 192.
The value of these bits is used to trim the temperature coefficient. Their value is set to the best value for the device during boot. The value of these bits should not be changed.
106
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
16. System Resets
This chapter discusses the System Resets and their associated registers. PSoC devices support several types of resets. The
various resets are designed to provide error-free operation during power up for any voltage ramping profile, to allow for usersupplied external reset and to provide recovery from errant code operation. For a complete table of the System Reset registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the System Resource Registers” on page 88. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers
in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
16.1
Architectural Description
When reset is initiated, all registers are restored to their
default states. In the Register Reference chapter on
page 137, this is indicated by the POR row in the register
tables and elsewhere it is indicated in the Access column,
values on the right side of the colon, in the register tables.
Minor exceptions are explained below.
The following types of resets can occur in the PSoC device:
■
■
■
■
Power on Reset (POR). This occurs at low supply voltage and is comprised of multiple sources.
External Reset (XRES). This active high reset is driven
into the PSoC device on parts that contain an XRES pin.
Watchdog Reset (WDR). This optional reset occurs
when the watchdog timer expires before being cleared
by user firmware. Watchdog reset defaults to off.
Internal Reset (IRES). This occurs during the boot
sequence if the SROM code determines that Flash
reads are not valid.
The occurrence of a reset is recorded in the Status and Control registers (CPU_SCR0 for POR, XRES, and WDR) or in
the System Status and Control Register 1 (CPU_SCR1 for
IRESS). Firmware can interrogate these registers to determine the cause of a reset.
16.2
Pin Behavior During Reset
Power on Reset and External Reset cause toggling on two
GPIO pins, P1[0] and P1[1], as described below and illustrated in Figure 16-1 and Figure 16-2. This allows programmers to synchronize with the PSoC device. All other GPIO
pins are placed in a high impedance state during and immediately following reset.
16.2.1
GPIO Behavior on Power Up
At power up, the internal POR causes P1[0] to initially drive
a strong high (1) while P1[1] drives a resistive low (0). After
256 sleep oscillator cycles (approximately 8 ms), the P1[0]
signal transitions to a resistive low state. After an additional
256 sleep oscillator clocks, both pins transition to a high
impedance state and normal CPU operation begins. This is
illustrated in Figure 16-1.
Figure 16-1. P1[1:0] Behavior on Power Up
POR Trip
Point
Vdd
T1 = T2 = 256 Sleep Clock Cycles
(approximately 8 ms)
Internal
Reset
P1[0]
S1
R0
HiZ
P1[1]
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
R0
R0
T1
T2
HiZ
107
[+] Feedback
System Resets
16.2.2
GPIO Behavior on External Reset
Figure 16-2. P1[1:0] Behavior on External Reset (XRES)
During External Reset (XRES=1), both P1[0] and P1[1] drive
resistive low (0). After XRES de-asserts, these pins continue
to drive resistive low for another 8 sleep clock cycles
(approximately 200 μs). After this time, both pins transition
to a high impedance state and normal CPU operation
begins. This is illustrated in Figure 16-2.
T1 = 8 Sleep Clock Cycles
(approximately 200 μs)
XRES
P1[0]
R0
HiZ
R0
P1[1]
HiZ
T1
16.3
Register Definitions
The following registers are associated with the PSoC System Resets and are listed in address order. Each register description has an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. The bits in the tables that are grayed out are
reserved bits and are not detailed in the register descriptions that follow. Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For a
complete table of system reset registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the System Resource Registers” on page 88.
16.3.1
Address
x,FEh
CPU_SCR1 Register
Name
Bit 7
CPU_SCR1
IRESS
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
SLIMO
Bit 0
Access
IRAMDIS
# : 00
LEGEND
x An “x” before the comma in the address field indicates that this register can be read or written to no matter what bank is used.
# Access is bit specific. Refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137 for additional information.
The System Status and Control Register 1 (CPU_SCR1) is
used to convey the status and control of events related to
internal resets and watchdog reset.
Bit 7: IRESS. Internal Reset Status. This bit is a read only
bit that may be used to determine if the booting process
occurred more than once.
When this bit is set, it indicates that the SROM SWBootReset code was executed more than once. If this bit is not set,
the SWBootReset was executed only once. In either case,
the SWBootReset code will not allow execution from code
stored in Flash until the M8C core is in a safe operating
mode with respect to supply voltage and Flash operation.
There is no need for concern when this bit is set. It is provided for systems which may be sensitive to boot time, so
that they can determine if the normal one-pass boot time
was exceeded. For more information on the SWBootReest
code see the Supervisory ROM (SROM) chapter on
page 37.
108
Bit 4: SLIMO. Slow IMO. When set, this bit allows the
active power dissipation of the PSoC device to be reduced
by slowing down the IMO from 12 MHz to 6 MHz. The IMO
trim value must also be changed when SLIMO is set (see
“Engaging Slow IMO” on page 57). When not in external
clocking mode, the IMO is the source for SYSCLK; therefore, when the speed of the IMO changes so will SYSCLK.
Bit 0: IRAMDIS. Initialize RAM Disable. This bit is a control
bit that is readable and writeable. The default value for this
bit is ‘0’, which indicates that the maximum amount of SRAM
should be initialized on watchdog reset to a value of 00h.
When the bit is ‘1’, the minimum amount of SRAM is initialized after a watchdog reset. For more information on this bit,
see the “SROM Function Descriptions” on page 38.
For additional information, refer to the CPU_SCR1 register
on page 178.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
System Resets
16.3.2
Address
0,FFh
CPU_SCR0 Register
Name
Bit 7
CPU_SCR0
GIES
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
WDRS
PORS
Sleep
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
STOP
# : XX
LEGEND
# Access is bit specific. Refer to register detail for additional information.
XX The reset value is 10h after POR/XRES and 20h after a watchdog reset.
The System Status and Control Register 0 (CPU_SCR0) is
used to convey the status and control of events for various
functions of a PSoC device.
Bit 7: GIES. Global Interrupt Enable Status. This bit is a
read only status bit and its use is discouraged. The GIES bit
is a legacy bit which was used to provide the ability to read
the GIE bit of the CPU_F register. However, the CPU_F register is now readable. When this bit is set, it indicates that
the GIE bit in the CPU_F register is also set which, in turn,
indicates that the microprocessor will service interrupts.
Bit 5: WDRS. WatchDog Reset Status. This bit may not be
set. It is normally ‘0’ and automatically set whenever a
watchdog reset occurs. The bit is readable and clearable by
writing a zero to its bit position in the CPU_SCR0 register.
Bit 4: PORS. Power On Reset Status. This bit, which is the
watchdog enable bit, is set automatically by a POR or External Reset (XRES). If the bit is cleared by user code, the
watchdog timer is enabled. Once cleared, the only way to
reset the PORS bit is to go through a POR or XRES. Thus,
there is no way to disable the watchdog timer other than to
go through a POR or XRES.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Bit 3: Sleep. This bit is used to enter Low Power Sleep
mode when set. To wake up the system, this register bit is
cleared asynchronously by any enabled interrupt. There are
two special features of this bit that ensures proper Sleep
operation. First, the write to set the register bit is blocked, if
an interrupt is about to be taken on that instruction boundary
(immediately after the write). Second, there is a hardware
interlock to ensure that, once set, the Sleep bit may not be
cleared by an incoming interrupt until the sleep circuit has
finished performing the sleep sequence and the systemwide power down signal has been asserted. This prevents
the sleep circuit from being interrupted in the middle of the
process of system power down, possibly leaving the system
in an indeterminate state.
Bit 0: STOP. This bit is readable and writeable. When set,
the PSoC M8C will stop executing code until a reset event
occurs. This can be either a POR, WDR, or XRES. If an
application wants to stop code execution until a reset, the
preferred method would be to use the HALT instruction
rather than a register write to this bit.
For additional information, refer to the CPU_SCR0 register
on page 179.
109
[+] Feedback
System Resets
16.4
16.4.1
Timing Diagrams
Power On Reset
A Power on Reset (POR) is triggered whenever the supply
voltage is below the POR trip point. POR ends once the supply voltage rises above this voltage. Refer to the POR and
LVD chapter on page 113 for more information on the operation of the POR block.
POR consists of two pieces: an imprecise POR (IPOR) and
a Precision POR (PPOR). “POR” refers to the OR of these
two functions. IPOR has coarser accuracy and its trip point
is typically lower than PPOR’s trip point. PPOR is derived
from a circuit that is calibrated (during boot) for a very accurate location of the POR trip point.
During POR (POR=1), the IMO is powered off for low power
during start-up. Once POR de-asserts, the IMO is started
(see Figure 16-3).
POR configures register reset status bits as shown in
Table 16-1 on page 112. PPOR does not affect the BandGap Trim register (BDG_TR), but IPOR does reset this register.
16.4.2
External Reset
An External Reset (XRES) is caused by pulling the XRES
pin high. The XRES pin has an always-on, pull down resistor, so it does not require an external pull down for operation
and can be tied directly to ground or left open. Behavior after
XRES is similar to POR.
During XRES (XRES=1), the IMO is powered off for low
power during start-up. Once XRES de-asserts, the IMO is
started (see Figure 16-3).
How the XRES configures register reset status bits is shown
in Table 16-1 on page 112.
16.4.3
Watchdog Timer Reset
The user has the option to enable the Watchdog Timer
Reset (WDR), by clearing the PORS bit in the CPU_SCR0
register. Once the PORS bit is cleared, the watchdog timer
cannot be disabled. The only exception to this is if a POR/
XRES event takes place which will disable the WDR. Note
that a WDR does not clear the Watchdog timer. See “Watchdog Timer” on page 66 for details of the Watchdog operation.
When the watchdog timer expires, a watchdog event occurs
resulting in the reset sequence. Some characteristics
unique to the WDR are as follows.
■ PSoC device reset asserts for one cycle of the CLK32K
clock (at its reset state).
■ The IMO is not halted during or after WDR (that is, the
part does not go through a low power phase).
■ CPU operation restarts one CLK32K cycle after the internal reset de-asserts (see Figure 16-3).
How the WDR configures register reset status bits is shown
in Table 16-1 on page 112.
110
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
System Resets
Figure 16-3. Key Signals During WDR and IRES Key Signals During POR and XRES
WDR: Reset 1 cycle, then one additional cycle before CPU reset released.
CLK32
Reset
0
Sleep Timer
IMO PD
1
2
(Stays Low)
IMO (not to scale)
CPU Reset
IRES: Reset 1 cycle, then 2048 additional cycles low power hold-off,
and then 1 cycle with IMO on before CPU reset released.
CLK32
Reset
0
Sleep Timer
1
2
N=2048
IMO PD
IMO (not to scale)
CPU Reset
Close -up
View
CLK32
Note: Test Mode assertion
(from key acquire) also
clears the Hold-off Signal.
Hold-off Signal
Sampled by next rising edge.
CPU Clock
Divided by 4 from IMO after reset.
CPU Reset
Reset releases after
falling edge of CPU clock.
CPU Reset Microcode
1 st
0
2 nd
3 rd
POR (IPOR followed by PPOR): Reset while POR is high (IMO off), then 511(+)
cycles (IMO on), and then the CPU reset is released. XRES is the same, with N=8.
CLK32
IPOR
PPOR
Reset (Follows POR / XRES)
Sleep Timer
0
0
1
511
N=512
IMO PD
IMO (not to scale)
CPU Reset
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
111
[+] Feedback
System Resets
16.4.4
Reset Details
Timing and functionality details are summarized in Table 16-1. Figure 16-3 shows some of the relevant signals for IPOR,
PPOR, and XRES, while Figure 16-3 shows signaling for WDR and IRES.
Table 16-1. Details of Functionality for Various Resets
Item
Reset Length
IPOR (Part of POR)
While POR=1
PPOR (Part of POR)
While PPOR=1, plus
30-60 μs (1-2 clocks)
XRES
While XRES=1
WDR
30 μs (1 clock)
Low Power (IMO Off) During Reset?
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Low Power Wait Following Reset?
No
No
No
No
CLK32K Cycles from End of Reset to
CPU Reset De-assertsa
512
1
8
1
Register Reset
All
All, except PPOR does not
reset Bandgap Trim
register
All
All
Reset Status Bits in CPU_SCR0,
CPU_SCR1
Set PORS,
Clear WDRS,
Clear IRAMDIS
Set PORS,
Clear WDRS,
Clear IRAMDIS
Set PORS,
Clear WDRS,
Clear IRAMDIS
Clear PORS,
Set WDRS,
IRAMDIS unchanged
Bandgap Power
On
On
On
On
Boot Timeb
2.0 ms Min
2.0 ms Min
2.0 ms Min
2.0 ms Min
5.5 ms Max
5.5 ms Max
5.5 ms Max
5.5 ms Max
(See next line for CPU_SCR0,
CPU_SCR1)
a. CPU reset is released after synchronization with the CPU clock.
b. Measured from CPU reset release to execution of the code at Flash address 0x0000.
16.5
Power Modes
The ILO block drives the CLK32K clock used to time most
events during the reset sequence. This clock is powered
down by IPOR but not by any other reset. The sleep timer
provides interval timing.
While POR or XRES assert, the IMO is powered off to
reduce start-up power consumption.
During and following IRES (for 64 ms nominally), the IMO is
powered off for low average power during slow supply
ramps.
During and after POR or XRES, the bandgap circuit is powered up.
Following IRES, the bandgap circuit is only powered up
occasionally to refresh the sampled bandgap voltage value.
This sampling follows the same process used during sleep
mode.
The IMO is always on for at least one CLK32K cycle before
CPU reset is deasserted.
112
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
17. POR and LVD
This chapter briefly discusses the Power on Reset (POR) and Low Voltage Detect (LVD) circuits and their associated registers. For a complete table of the POR registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the System Resource Registers” on page 88.
For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
17.1
Architectural Description
The Power on Reset (POR) and Low Voltage Detect (LVD) circuits provide protection against low voltage conditions. The
POR function senses Vdd and holds the system in reset until the magnitude of Vdd will support operation to specification. The
LVD function senses Vdd and provides an interrupt to the system when Vdd falls below a selected threshold. Other outputs
and status bits are provided to indicate important voltage trip levels. Refer to Section 16.2 Pin Behavior During Reset for a
description of GPIO pin behavior during power up.
17.2
Register Definitions
The following registers are associated with the POR and LVD, and are listed in address order. The register descriptions below
have an associated register table showing the bit structure. The bits that are grayed out in the register tables are reserved bits
and are not detailed in the register descriptions that follow. Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For a complete table
of the POR registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the System Resource Registers” on page 88.
17.2.1
Address
1,E3h
VLT_CR Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
VLT_CR
Bit 5
Bit 4
PORLEV[1:0]
The Voltage Monitor Control Register (VLT_CR) is used to
set the trip points for POR and LVD.
The VLT_CR register is cleared by all resets. This can cause
reset cycling during very slow supply ramps to 5V when the
POR range is set for the 5V range. This is because the reset
clears the POR range setting back to 3V and a new boot/
start-up occurs (possibly many times). The user can manage this with Sleep mode and/or reading voltage status bits
if such cycling is an issue.
Bits 5 and 4: PORLEV[1:0]. These bits set the Vdd level at
which PPOR switches to one of three valid values. Note that
11b is a reserved value and should not be used.
The three valid settings for these bits are:
❐ 00b (2.4V operation)
❐ 01b (2.7V operation)
❐ 10b (3.0V operation)
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Bit 3
LVDTBEN
Bit 2
Bit 1
VM[2:0]
Bit 0
Access
RW : 00
See the “DC POR and LVD Specifications” table in the Electrical Specifications section of the PSoC device data sheet
for voltage tolerances for each setting.
Bit 3: LVDTBEN. This bit is AND’ed with LVD to produce a
throttle-back signal that reduces CPU clock speed when low
voltage conditions are detected. When the throttle-back signal is asserted, the CPU speed bits in the OSC_CR0 register are reset forcing the CPU speed to its reset state.
Bits 2 to 0: VM[2:0]. These bits set the Vdd level at which
the LVD Comparator switches.
See the “DC POR and LVD Specifications” table in the Electrical Specifications section of the PSoC device data sheet
for voltage tolerances for each setting.
For additional information, refer to the VLT_CR register on
page 188.
113
[+] Feedback
POR and LVD
17.2.2
Address
1,E4h
VLT_CMP Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
VLT_CMP
The Voltage Monitor Comparators Register (VLT_CMP) is
used to read the state of internal supply voltage monitors.
Bit 3: NoWrite. This bit is only used in PSoC devices with a
2.4V minimum POR. It reads the state of the Flash write
voltage monitor.
Bit 3
NoWrite
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
LVD
PPOR
RW : 00
Bit 0: PPOR. This bit reads back the state of the PPOR
output. This can only be meaningfully read with PORLEV[1:0] set to disable PPOR. In that case, the PPOR status bit shows the comparator state directly.
For additional information, refer to the VLT_CMP register on
page 189.
Bit 1: LVD. This bit reads the state of the low voltage
detect comparator. The trip point for the LVD is set by
VM[2:0] in the VLT_CR register.
114
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
18. Serial Peripheral Interface
This chapter presents the Serial Peripheral Interconnect (SPI) and its associated registers. For a complete table of the SPI
registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the System Resource Registers” on page 88. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
18.1
Architectural Description
The Serial Peripheral Interconnect (SPI) block is a dedicated master or slave SPI. The SPI slave function requires
three inputs: Clock, Data, and SS_ (unless the SS_ is forced
active with the SS_bit in the configuration register).
Figure 18-1. SPI Block Diagram
SPI Block
MOSI, MISO
SCLK
DATA_IN
CLK_IN
18.1.1
SPI Protocol Function
The SPI is a Motorola™ specification for implementing fullduplex synchronous serial communication between devices.
The 3-wire protocol uses both edges of the clock to enable
synchronous communication without the need for stringent
setup and hold requirements. Figure 18-2 shows the basic
signals in a simple connection.
Figure 18-2. Basic SPI Configuration
DATA_OUT
CLK_OUT
MOSI, MISO
SCLK
INT
SYSCLK
MISO MOSI
SCLK
SS_
SS_
Registers
CONFIGURATION[7:0]
CONTROL[7:0]
TRANSMIT[7:0]
RECEIVE[7:0]
SPI Master
Data is output by
both the Master
and Slave on
one edge of
the clock.
MOSI MISO
SCLK
SS_
SPI Slave
Data is registered at
the input of both
devices on the
opposite edge of
the clock.
SCLK
MOSI
MISO
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
115
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
A device can be a master or slave. A master outputs clock
and data to the slave device and inputs slave data. A slave
device inputs clock and data from the master device and
outputs data for input to the master. Together, the master
and slave are essentially a circular shift register, where the
master is generating the clocking and initiating data transfers.
A basic data transfer occurs when the master sends eight
bits of data, along with eight clocks. In any transfer, both
master and slave are transmitting and receiving simultaneously. If the master is only sending data, the received data
from the slave is ignored. If the master wishes to receive
data from the slave, the master must send dummy bytes to
generate the clocking for the slave to send data back.
18.1.1.1
SPI Protocol Signal Definitions
The SPI protocol signal definitions are located in Table 18-1.
The use of the SS_ signal varies according to the capability
of the slave device.
Table 18-1. SPI Protocol Signal Definitions
Name
Function
Description
MOSI
Master Out
Slave In
Master data output.
MISO
Master In
Slave Out
Slave data output.
SCLK
Serial Clock
Clock generated by the master.
SS_
Slave Select This signal is provided to enable multi-slave con(active low) nections to the MISO pin. The MOSI and SCLK pins
can be connected to multiple slaves, and the SS_
input selects which slave will receive the input data
and drive the MISO line.
18.1.2
SPI Master Function
The SPI Master (SPIM) offers SPI operating modes 0-3. By
default, the most significant bit (MSb) of the data byte is
shifted out first. An additional option can be set to reverse
the direction and shift the data byte out the least significant
bit (LSb) first. (Refer to the timing diagrams for this function
on page 122.)
The SPI protocol requires data to be registered at the device
input, on the opposite edge of the clock that operates the
output shifter.
The SPIM controls data transmission between master and
slave because it generates the bit clock for internal clocking
and for clocking the SPIS. The bit clock is derived from the
CLK input selection.
There are four control bits and four status bits in the control
register (SPI_CR) that provide for PSoC device interfacing
and synchronization.
The SPIM hardware has no support for driving the Slave
Select (SS_) signal. The behavior and use of this signal is
application and PSoC device dependent and, if required,
must be implemented in firmware.
116
18.1.2.1
Usability Exceptions
The following are usability exceptions for the SPI Protocol
function.
1. The SPI_RXR (Rx Buffer) register is not writeable.
2. The SPI_TXR (Tx Buffer) register is not readable.
18.1.2.2
Block Interrupt
The SPIM block has a selection of two interrupt sources:
interrupt on TX Reg Empty (default) or interrupt on SPI
Complete. Mode bit 1 in the function register controls the
selection. These modes are discussed in detail in “SPIM
Timing” on page 122.
If SPI Complete is selected as the block interrupt, the control
register must be read in the interrupt routine so that this status bit is cleared; otherwise, no subsequent interrupts are
generated.
18.1.3
SPI Slave Function
The SPI Slave (SPIS) offers SPI operating modes 0-3. By
default, the MSb of the data byte is shifted out first. An additional option can be set to reverse the direction and shift the
data byte out LSb first. (Refer to the timing diagrams for this
function on page 125.)
The SPI protocol requires data to be registered at the device
input, on the opposite edge of the clock that operates the
output shifter.
The SPIS function derives all clocking from the SCLK input
(typically an external SPI Master). This means that the master must initiate all transmissions. For example, to read a
byte from the SPIS, the master sends a byte.
There are four control bits and four status bits in the control
register (SPI_CR) that provide for PSoC device interfacing
and synchronization.
There is an additional data input in the SPIS, Slave Select
(SS_), which is an active low signal. SS_ must be asserted
to enable the SPIS to receive and transmit. SS_ has two
high level functions: 1) To allow for the selection of a given
slave in multi-slave environment, and 2) To provide additional clocking for TX data queuing in SPI modes 0 and 1.
SS_ may be controlled from an external pin or can be controlled by way of user firmware.
When SS_ is negated, the SPIS ignores any MOSI/SCLK
input from the master. In addition, the SPIS state machine is
reset and the MISO output is forced to idle at logic 1. This
allows for a wired-AND connection in a multi-slave environment. Note that if High-Z output is required when the slave
is not selected, this behavior must be implemented in firmware with IO writes to the port drive register.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
18.1.3.1
Usability Exceptions
The following are usability exceptions for the SPI Slave
function.
1. The SPI_RXR (Rx Buffer) register is not writeable.
2. The SPI_TXR (Tx Buffer) register is not readable.
18.1.3.2
Block Interrupt
The SPIS block has a selection of two interrupt sources:
Interrupt on TX Reg Empty (default) or interrupt on SPI
Complete (same selection as the SPIM). Mode bit 1 in the
function register controls the selection.
18.2
If SPI Complete is selected as the block interrupt, the control
register must still be read in the interrupt routine so that this
status bit is cleared; otherwise, no subsequent interrupts are
generated.
18.1.4
Input Synchronization
All pin inputs are double synchronized to SYSCLK by
default. Synchronization can be bypassed by setting the
BYPS bit in the SPI_CFG register.
Register Definitions
These registers are associated with the SPI and are listed in address order. The register descriptions have an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. For a complete table of SPI registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the
System Resource Registers” on page 88.
Data Registers
18.2.1
Address
0,29h
SPI_TXR Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
SPI_TXR
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Data[7:0]
The SPI Transmit Data Register (SPI_TXR) is the SPI’s
transmit data register.
Access
W : 00
Bits 7 to 0: Data[7:0]. These bits encompass the SPI
Transmit register. They are discussed by function type in
Table 18-1 and Table 18-2.
For additional information, refer to the SPI_TXR register on
page 140.
18.2.2
Address
0,2Ah
SPI_RXR Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
SPI_RXR
The SPI Receive Data Register (SPI_RXR) is the SPI’s
receive data register. A write to this register will clear the RX
Reg Full status bit in the Control register (SPI_CR).
Bit 4
Bit 3
Data[7:0]
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
R : 00
Bits 7 to 0: Data[7:0]. These bits encompass the SPI
Receive register. They are discussed by function type in
Table 18-1 and Table 18-2.
For additional information, refer to the SPI_RXR register on
page 141.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
117
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
18.2.2.1
SPI Master Data Register Definitions
There are two 8-bit Data registers and one 8-bit Control/Status register. This table explains the meaning of the Transmit and
Receive registers in the context of SPIM operation.
Name
SPI_TXR
Function
TX Buffer
Description
Write only register.
If no transmission is in progress and this register is written to, the data from this register is loaded into the Shift register, on
the following clock edge, and a transmission is initiated. If a transmission is currently in progress, this register serves as a
buffer for TX data.
This register should only be written to when TX Reg Empty status is set and the write clears the TX Reg Empty status bit in
the Control register. When the data is transferred from this register to the Shift register, then TX Reg Empty status is set.
SPI_RXR
RX Buffer
Read only register.
When a byte transmission/reception is complete, the data in the shifter is transferred into the RX Buffer register and RX
Reg Full status is set in the Control register.
A read from this register clears the RX Reg Full status bit in the Control register.
18.2.2.2
SPI Slave Data Register Definitions
There are two 8-bit Data registers and one 8-bit Control/Status register. The table shown below explains the meaning of the
Transmit and Receive registers in the context of SPIS operation.
Table 18-2. SPIS Data Register Descriptions
Name
SPI_TXR
Function
TX Buffer
Description
Write only register.
This register should only be written to when TX Reg Empty status is set and the write clears the TX Reg Empty status bit in
the Control register. When the data is transferred from this register to the Shift register, then TX Reg Empty status is set.
SPI_RXR
RX Buffer
Read only register.
When a byte transmission/reception is complete, the data in the shifter is transferred into the RX Buffer register and RX Reg
Full status is set in the Control register.
A read from this register clears the RX Reg Full status bit in the Control register.
118
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
Control Register
18.2.3
SPI_CR Register
Address
Name
0,2Bh
SPI_CR
Bit 7
LSb First
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Overrun
SPI
Complete
TX Reg
Empty
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RX Reg Full
Clock
Phase
Clock
Polarity
Enable
# : 00
LEGEND
# Access is bit specific. Refer to the register detail for additional information.
The SPI Control Register (SPI_CR) is the SPI’s control register.
Bit 4: TX Reg Empty. This status bit indicates whether or
not the transmit register is empty.
Bit 7: LSb First. This bit determines how the serial data is
shifted out, either LSb or MSb first.
Bit 3: RX Reg Full. This status bit indicates a receive register full condition.
Bit 6: Overrun. This status bit indicates whether or not
there was a Receive Buffer overrun. A read from the
Receive buffer, after each received byte, must be performed
before the reception of the next byte to avoid an overrun
condition.
Bit 2: Clock Phase. This bit determines which edge (rising
and falling) that the data changes on.
Bit 5: SPI Complete. This status bit indicates the completion of a transaction. A read from this register clears this bit.
Bit 0: Enable. This bit enables the SPI block.
18.2.3.1
Bit #
Bit 1: Clock Polarity. This bit determines the logic level the
clock codes to in its idle state.
For additional information, refer to the SPI_CR register on
page 142.
SPI Control Register Definitions
Name
Access
7
LSb First
Read/Write
6
Overrun
Read Only
5
SPI
Complete
Read Only
4
TX Reg Empty
Read Only
3
TX Reg Full
Read Only
2
Clock Phase
Read/Write
1
Clock
Polarity
Read/Write
0
Enable
Read/Write
Description
0 = Data shifted out MSb First.
1 = Data shifted out LSb First.
0 = No overrun.
1 = Indicates new byte received before previous one is read.
0 = Transaction in progress.
1 = Transaction is complete. Reading SPI_CR clears this bit.
0 = TX register is full.
1 = TX register is empty. Writing SPI_TXR register clears this bit.
0 = RX register is not full.
1 = RX register is full. Reading SPI_RXR register clears this bit.
0 = Data changes on trailing edge.
1 = Data changes on leading clock edge.
0 = Non-inverted, clock idles low (modes 0,2)
1 = Inverted, clock idles high (modes 1,3)
0 = Disable SPI function.
1 = Enable SPI function.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
119
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
Configuration Register
The configuration block contains 1 register. Do not change this register while the block is enabled. Note that the SPI Configuration register is located in bank 1 of the PSoC device’s memory map.
18.2.4
SPI_CFG Register
Address
Name
1,29h
Bit 7
SPI_CFG
Bit 6
Bit 5
Clock Sel[2:0]
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
Bypass
SS_
SS_EN_
Int Sel
Slave
RW : 00
Bits 7 to 5: Clock Sel. Clock Selection. These bits determine the operating frequency of the SPI Master.
Bit 2: SS_EN_. Slave Select Enable. This active low bit
determines if the slave select (SS_) signal is driven internally. If it is driven internally, its logic level is determined by
the SS_ bit. If it is driven externally, its logic level is determined by the external pin.
Bit 4: Bypass. This bit determines whether or not the
inputs are synchronized to SYSCLK.
Bit 1: Int Sel. Interrupt Select. This bit selects which condition produces an interrupt.
Bit 3: SS_. Slave Select. This bit determines the logic
value of the SS_ signal when the SS_EN_ signal is asserted
(SS_EN_ = 0).
Bit 0: Slave. This bit determines whether the block functions as a master or slave.
The SPI Configuration Register (SPI_CFG) is used to configure the SPI.
18.2.4.1
For additional information, refer to the SPI_CFG register on
page 182.
SPI Configuration Register Definitions
Bit #
Name
7:5
Clock Sel
Access
Read/Write
Mode
Master
4
Bypass
Read/Write
Master/Slave
3
SS_
Read/Write
Slave
2
SS_EN_
Read/Write
Slave
1
Int Sel
Read/Write
Master/Slave
0
Slave
Read/Write
Master/Slave
Description
SYSCLK
000b
/2
001b
/4
010b
/8
011b
/ 16
100b
/ 32
101b
/ 64
110b
/ 128
111b
/ 256
0 = All pin unputs are doubled, synchronized
1 = Input synchronization is bypassed.
0 = Slave selected
1 = Slave selection is determined from external SS_ pin.
0 = Slave selection determined from SS_ bit.
1 = Slave selection determined from external SS_ pin.
0 = Interrupt on TX Reg Empty
1 = Interrupt on SPI Complete
0 = Operates as a master.
1 = Operates as a slave.
120
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
18.3
18.3.1
Timing Diagrams
SPI Mode Timing
Figure 18-3 shows the SPI modes which are typically
defined as 0,1, 2, or 3. These mode numbers are an encoding of two control bits: Clock Phase and Clock Polarity.
Clock phase indicates the relationship of the clock to the
data. When the clock phase is '0', it means that the data is
registered as an input on the leading edge of the clock and
the next data is output on the trailing edge of the clock.
When the clock phase is '1', it means that the next data is
output on the leading edge of the clock and that data is registered as an input on the trailing edge of the clock.
Clock polarity controls clock inversion. When clock polarity
is set to '1’, the clock idle state is high.
Figure 18-3. SPI Mode Timing
MODE 0, 1 (Phase=0) Input on leading edge. Output on trailing edge.
SCLK, Polarity=0 (Mode 0)
SCLK, Polarity=1 (Mode 1)
MOSI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MISO
SS_
MODE 2, 3 (Phase=1) Output on leading edge. Input on trailing edge.
SCLK, Polarity=0 (Mode 2)
SCLK, Polarity=1 (Mode 3)
MOSI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MISO
SS_
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
121
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
18.3.2
SPIM Timing
Enable/Disable Operation. As soon as the block is configured for SPIM, the primary output is the MSb or LSb of the
Shift register, depending on the LSb First configuration in bit
7 of the Control register. The auxiliary output is '1' or '0',
depending on the idle clock state of the SPI mode. This is
the idle state.
Clock Generation. Figure 18-4 illustrates the SPIM input
clocking scheme. The SYSCLK pin is an input into an eightstage ripple divider that provides the baud rate selections.
When the block is disabled, all internal state is held in a
reset state. When the Enable bit in the SPI_CR register is
set, the reset is synchronously released and the clock generation is enabled. All eight taps from the ripple divider are
selectable (/2, /4, /8, /16, /32, /64, /128, /256) from the Clock
Sel bits in the SPI_CFG register. The selected divider tap is
resynchronized to SYSCLK. The resulting clock is routed to
all of the synchronous elements in the design.
When the block is disabled, the SCLK and MOSI outputs
revert to their idle state. All internal state is reset (including
CR0 status) to its configuration specific reset state.
Figure 18-4. SPI Input Clocking
I/O WRITE
SYSCLK
ENABLE
BLOCK RESET
2
4
8
RESYNC CLOCK
Default
2
Two SYSCLKS to first block clock.
122
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
Normal Operation. Typical timing for a SPIM transfer is
shown in Figure 18-5 and Figure 18-6. The user initially
writes a byte to transmit when TX Reg Empty status is true.
If no transmission is currently in progress, the data is loaded
into the shifter and the transmission is initiated. The TX Reg
Empty status is asserted again and the user is allowed to
write the next byte to be transmitted to the TX Buffer register. After the last bit is output, if TX Buffer data is available
with one-half clock setup time to the next clock, a new byte
transmission will be initiated. A SPIM block receives a byte
at the same time that it sends one. Use the SPI Complete or
RX Reg Full to determine when the input byte was received.
Figure 18-5. Typical SPIM Timing in Mode 0 and 1
Free running,
internal bit rate
clock is CLK input
divided by two.
Setup time
for TX
Buffer write.
Last bit of received
data is valid on this
edge and is latched
into RX Buffer.
Shifter is loaded
with first byte.
Shifter is loaded
with next byte.
CLK INPUT
INTERNAL CLOCK
TX REG EMPTY
RX REG FULL
MOSI
D7
D6
D5
D2
D1
D0
D7
SCLK (MODE 0)
SCLK (MODE 1)
User writes first
byte to the TX
Buffer register.
User writes next
First input bit First shift byte to the TX
is latched.
Buffer register.
Figure 18-6. Typical SPIM Timing in Mode 2 and 3
Free running,
internal bit rate
clock is CLK input
divided by two.
Setup time
for the TX
Buffer write.
Last bit of received
data is valid on this
edge and is latched
into RX Buffer.
Shifter is loaded
with the first byte.
Shifter is loaded
with the next
byte.
CLK INPUT
INTERNAL CLOCK
TX REG EMPTY
RX REG FULL
MOSI
D7
D6
D5
D2
D1
D0
D7
SCLK (MODE 2)
SCLK (MODE 3)
User writes first
byte to the TX
Buffer register.
First input bit
is latched.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
First shift
User writes next
byte to the TX
Buffer register.
123
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
Status Generation and Interrupts
SPI Complete is an optional interrupt and is generated when
eight bits of data and clock have been sent. In modes 0 and
1, this occurs one-half cycle after RX Reg Full is set;
because in these modes, data is latched on the leading
edge of the clock and there is an additional one-half cycle
remaining to complete that clock. In modes 2 and 3, this
occurs at the same edge that the receive data is latched.
This signal may be used to read the received byte or it may
be used by the SPIM to disable the block after data transmission is complete.
There are four status bits in an SPI Block: TX Reg Empty,
RX Reg Full, SPI Complete, and Overrun.
TX Reg Empty indicates that a new byte can be written to
the TX Buffer register. When the block is enabled, this status
bit is immediately asserted. This status bit is cleared when
the user writes a byte of data to the TX Buffer register. TX
Reg Empty is a control input to the state machine and, if a
transmission is not already in progress, the assertion of this
control signal initiates one. This is the default SPIM block
interrupt. However, an initial interrupt is not generated when
the block is enabled. The user must write a byte to the TX
Buffer register and that byte must be loaded into the shifter
before interrupts generated from the TX Reg Empty status
bit are enabled.
Overrun status is set, if RX Reg Full is still asserted from a
previous byte when a new byte is about to be loaded into the
RX Buffer register. Because the RX Buffer register is implemented as a latch, Overrun status is set one-half bit clock
before RX Reg Full status.
See Figure 18-7 and Figure 18-8 for status timing relationships.
RX Reg Full is asserted on the edge that captures the eighth
bit of receive data. This status bit is cleared when the user
reads the RX Buffer register (DR2).
Figure 18-7. SPI Status Timing for Modes 0 and 1
Free running,
internal bit rate
clock is CLK input
divided by two.
Setup time
for TX
Buffer write.
Shifter is loaded
with first byte.
Last bit of received
data is valid on this
edge and is latched
into RX Buffer.
Shifter is loaded
with next byte.
CLK INPUT
INTERNAL CLOCK
TX REG EMPTY
RX REG FULL
MOSI
D7
D6
D5
D2
D1
D0
D7
SCLK (MODE 0)
SCLK (MODE 1)
User writes first
byte to the TX
Buffer register.
124
First input bit
is latched.
First shift
User writes next
byte to the TX
Buffer register.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
Figure 18-8. SPI Status Timing for Modes 2 and 3
MODE 2, 3 (Phase=1) Output on leading edge. Input on trailing edge.
User writes the next byte.
SCLK, Polarity=0 (Mode 2)
SCLK, Polarity=1 (Mode 3)
MOSI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MISO
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
SS_
TX REG EMPTY
Last bit of byte
is received.
RX REG FULL
SPI COMPLETE
All clocks and data for
this byte completed.
OVERRUN
TX Buffer is
transferred into
the shifter
18.3.3
Overrun occurs onehalf cycle before the
last bit is received.
SPIS Timing
Enable/Disable Operation. As soon as the block is configured for SPI Slave and before enabling, the MISO output is
set to idle at logic 1. Both the enable bit must be set and the
SS_ asserted (either driven externally or forced by firmware
programming) for the block to output data. When enabled,
the primary output is the MSb or LSb of the shift register,
depending on the LSb First configuration in bit 7 of the Control register. The auxiliary output of the SPIS is always
forced into tri-state.
Since the SPIS has no internal clock, it must be enabled
with setup time to any external master supplying the clock.
Setup time is also required for a TX Buffer register write,
before the first edge of the clock or the first falling edge of
SS_ depending on the mode. This setup time must be
assured through the protocol and an understanding of the
timing between the master and slave in a system.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
TX Buffer is
transferred into
the shifter.
When the block is disabled, the MISO output reverts to its
idle '1' state. All internal state is reset (including CR0 status)
to its configuration specific reset state.
Normal Operation. Typical timing for a SPIS transfer is
shown in Figure 18-9 and Figure 18-10. If the SPIS is primarily used as a receiver, the RX Reg Full (polling only) or
SPI Complete (polling or interrupt) status may be used to
determine when a byte has been received. In this way, the
SPIS operates identically with the SPIM. However, there are
two main areas in which the SPIS operates differently: 1)
SPIS behavior related to the SS_ signal, and 2) TX data
queuing (loading the TX Buffer register).
125
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
Figure 18-9. Typical SPIS Timing in Modes 0 and 1
At the falling edge of SS_, MISO First input
transitions from an IDLE (high)
bit is
to output the first bit of data.
latched.
Last bit of received data is valid
on this edge and is latched into
the RX Buffer register.
First
Shift
SCLK (internal)
TX REG EMPTY
RX REG FULL
SS_
MISO
D7
D6
D5
D2
D1
D0
D7
D7
D6
SCLK (MODE 0)
SCLK (MODE 1)
User writes first byte to the
TX Buffer register in
advance of transfer.
User writes the next byte
to the TX Buffer register.
Figure 18-10. Typical SPIS Timing in Modes 2 and 3
Shifter is loaded with
first byte (by leading
edge of the SCLK).
First
input bit
latched.
Last bit of received data is valid
Shifter is
on this edge and is latched into loaded with
the RX Buffer register.
the next byte.
First
Shift
SCLK (Internal)
TX REG EMPTY
RX REG FULL
MISO
D7
D6
D5
D2
D1
D0
D7
SCLK (MODE 2)
SCLK (MODE 3)
User writes the first
byte to the TX Buffer
register.
126
User writes the next
byte to the TX Buffer
register.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
Slave Select (SS_, active low). Slave Select must be
asserted to enable the SPIS for receive and transmit. There
are two ways to do this:
1. Drive the auxiliary input from a pin (selected by the Aux
IO Select bits in the output register). This gives the SPI
master control of the slave selection in a multi-slave
environment.
2. SS_ may be controlled in firmware with register writes to
the output register. When Aux IO Enable = 1, Aux IO
Select bit 0 becomes the SS_ input. This allows the user
to save an input pin in single slave environments.
When SS_ is negated (whether from an external or internal
source), the SPIS state machine is reset and the MISO output is forced to idle at logic 1. In addition, the SPIS ignores
any incoming MOSI/SCLK input from the master.
Status Generation and Interrupts. There are four status
bits in the SPIS Block: TX Reg Empty, RX Reg Full, SPI
Complete, and Overrun. The timing of these status bits are
identical to the SPIM, with the exception of TX Reg Empty
which is covered in the section on TX data queuing.
Status Clear On Read. Refer to the same subsection in
“SPIM Timing” on page 122.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
TX Data Queuing. Most SPI applications call for data to be
sent back from the slave to the master. Writing firmware to
accomplish this requires an understanding of how the Shift
register is loaded from the TX Buffer register.
All modes use the following mechanism: 1) If there is no
transfer in progress, 2) if the shifter is empty, and 3) if data is
available in the TX Buffer register, the byte is loaded into the
shifter.
The only difference between the modes is that the definition
of “transfer in progress” is slightly different between modes 0
and 1, and modes 2 and 3.
Figure 18-11 illustrates TX data loading in modes 0 and 1. A
transfer in progress is defined to be from the falling edge of
SS_ to the point at which the RX Buffer register is loaded
with the received byte. This means that in order to send a
byte in the next transfer, it must be loaded into the TX Buffer
register before the falling edge of SS_. This ensures a minimum setup time for the first bit, since the leading edge of the
first SCLK must latch in the received data. If SS_ is not toggled between each byte or is forced low through the configuration register, the leading edge of SCLK is used to define
the start of transfer. However, in this case, the user must
provide the required setup time (one-half clock minimum
before the leading edge) with a knowledge of system latencies and response times.
127
[+] Feedback
Serial Peripheral Interface
Figure 18-11. Mode 0 and 1 Transfer in Progress
SS Forced Low
Transfer in Progress
SS
SCLK (Mode 0)
SCLK (Mode 1)
SS Toggled on a Message Basis
Transfer in Progress
Transfer in Progress
SS
SCLK (Mode 0)
SCLK (Mode 1)
SS Toggled on Each Byte
Transfer in Progress
Transfer in Progress
SS
SCLK (Mode 0)
SCLK (Mode 1)
Figure 18-12 illustrates TX data loading in modes 2 and 3. In
this case, a transfer in progress is defined to be from the
leading edge of the first SCLK, to the point at which the RX
Buffer register is loaded with the received byte. Loading the
shifter by the leading edge of the clock has the effect of providing the required one-half clock setup time, as the data is
latched into the receiver on the trailing edge of the SCLK in
these modes.
Figure 18-12. Mode 2 and 3 Transfer in Progress
Transfer in Progress
SCLK (Mode 2)
SCLK (Mode 3)
(No Dependance on SS)
128
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
19. Programmable Timer
This chapter presents the Programmable Timer and its associated registers. For a complete table of the programmable timer
registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the System Resource Registers” on page 88. For a quick reference of all PSoC registers in address order, refer to the Register Reference chapter on page 137.
19.1
Architectural Description
The programmable timer is a 13-bit down counter with a terminal count output. The timer has one configuration and two
data registers associated with it. It is started by setting the
START bit in its configuration register (PT_CFG). When
started, the timer always starts counting down from the
value loaded into its data registers (PT_DATA1, PT_DATA0).
The timer has a one shot mode, in which the timer completes one full count cycle and stops. In one-shot mode the
START bit in the configuration register is cleared after completion of one full count cycle. Setting the START bit will
restart the timer.
Figure 19-1. Programmable Timer Block Diagram
32 kHz
Clock
Programmable
Timer
Terminal
Count
Registers
CONFIGURATION[7:0]
DATA[7:0]
DATA[7:0]
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
129
[+] Feedback
Programmable Timer
19.1.1
Operation
When started, the programmable timer loads the value contained in its data registers and counts down to its terminal count of
zero. The timer outputs an active high terminal count pulse for one clock cycle upon reaching the terminal count. The low time
of the terminal count pulse is equal to the loaded decimal count value, multiplied by the clock period. (TCpw = COUNT VALUEdecimal * CLKperiod). The period of the terminal count output is the pulse width of the terminal count, plus one clock period.
(TCperiod = TCpw + CLKperiod). Refer to Figure 19-2 and Figure 19-3.
Figure 19-2. Continuous Operation Example
PTDATA1
PTDATA0
0003h (13-bit)
Clock
Start
One Shot
Count
00h
03h
02h
01h
00h
03h
02h
01h
00h
03h
02h
01h
00h
TC
IRQ
Figure 19-3. One Shot Operation Example
PTDATA1
PTDATA0
0003h (13-bit)
Clock
Start
One Shot
Count
00h
03h
02h
01h
00h
TC
IRQ
130
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Programmable Timer
19.2
Register Definitions
The following registers are associated with the Programmable Timer and are listed in address order. The register descriptions
have an associated register table showing the bit structure for that register. The bits in the tables that are grayed out are
reserved bits and are not detailed in the register descriptions that follow. Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For a
complete table of programmable timer registers, refer to the “Summary Table of the System Resource Registers” on page 88.
19.2.1
Address
0,B0h
PT_CFG Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
The Programmable Timer Configuration Register (PT_CFG)
configures the PSoC’s programmable timer.
Bit 1: One Shot. This bit determines if the timer runs in one
shot mode or continuous mode. In one-shot mode the timer
completes one full count cycle and terminates. Upon termination, the START bit in this register is cleared. In continuous mode, the timer reloads the count value each time upon
completion of its count cycle and repeats.
19.2.2
Address
0,B1h
Address
0,B2h
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
One Shot
START
RW : 00
Bit 0: START. This bit starts the timer counting from a full
count. The full count is determined by the value loaded into
the DATA registers. This bit is cleared when the timer is running in one shot mode upon completion of a full count cycle.
For additional information, refer to the PT_CFG register on
page 159.
PT_DATA1 Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
PT_DATA1
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Data[4:0]
The Programmable Timer Data Register 1 (PT_DATA1)
holds the upper 5 bits of the progammable timer’s count
value.
19.2.3
Bit 4
PT_CFG
Access
RW : 00
Bits 4 to 0: Data[4:0]. These bits hold the upper 5 bits of
the timer’s 13-bit count value.
For additional information, refer to the PT_DATA1 register
on page 160.
PT_DATA0 Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
PT_DATA0
The Programmable Timer Data Register 0 (PT_DATA0)
holds the lower 8 bits of the progammable timer’s count
value.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Bit 4
Bit 3
Data[7:0]
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Access
RW : 00
Bits 7 to 0: Data[7:0]. These bits hold the lower 8 bits of
the timer’s13-bit count value.
For additional information, refer to the PT_DATA0 register
on page 161.
131
[+] Feedback
Programmable Timer
132
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section E: Registers
The Registers section discusses the registers of the PSoC CY8C20x34/24 device. It lists all the registers in mapping tables,
in address order. For easy reference, each register is linked to the page of a detailed description located in the next chapter.
This section encompasses the following chapter:
■
Register Reference on page 137.
Register General Conventions
Register Mapping Tables
The register conventions specific to this section and the
Register Reference chapter are listed in the following table.
The PSoC device has a total register address space of 512
bytes. The register space is also referred to as IO space and
is broken into two parts: Bank 0 (user space) and Bank 1
(configuration space). The XIO bit in the Flag register
(CPU_F) determines which bank the user is currently in.
When the XIO bit is set, the user is said to be in the
“extended” address space or the “configuration” registers.
Register Conventions
Convention
Description
Empty, grayed-out
table cell
Illustrates a reserved bit or group of bits.
‘x’ before the comma
in an address
Indicates the register exists in register bank 1 and
register bank 2.
‘x’ in a register name
Indicates that there are multiple instances/address
ranges of the same register.
R
Read register or bit(s)
W
Write register or bit(s)
O
Only a read/write register or bit(s).
L
Logical register or bit(s)
C
Clearable register or bit(s)
#
Access is bit specific
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Refer to the individual PSoC device data sheets for devicespecific register mapping information.
133
[+] Feedback
Section E: Registers
Register Map Bank 0 Table: User Space
140
141
142
CMP_RDC
CMP_MUX
CMP_CR0
CMP_CR1
CMP_LUT
143
CS_CR0
CS_CR1
CS_CR2
CS_CR3
CS_CNTL
CS_CNTH
CS_STAT
CS_TIMER
CS_SLEW
PT_CFG
PT_DATA1
PT_DATA0
#
RW
RW
RW
RW
144
145
146
147
149
INT_CLR0
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
#
RW
RW
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
RW
RW
RW
159
160
161
INT_MSK0
INT_SW_EN
INT_VC
RES_WDT
CPU_F
IDAC_D
CPU_SCR1
CPU_SCR0
Page
134
W
R
#
RW
IDX_PP
MVR_PP
MVW_PP
I2C_CFG
I2C_SCR
I2C_DR
C0
C1
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
C8
C9
CA
CB
CC
CD
CE
CF
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
DA
DB
DC
DD
DE
DF
E0
E1
E2
E3
E4
E5
E6
E7
E8
E9
EA
EB
EC
ED
EE
EF
F0
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F9
FA
FB
FC
FD
FE
FF
Access
Gray fields are reserved.
AMUX_CFG
CUR_PP
STK_PP
Addr
(0,Hex)
138
139
Name
RW
RW
Page
138
139
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
8A
8B
8C
8D
8E
8F
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
9A
9B
9C
9D
9E
9F
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
AA
AB
AC
AD
AE
AF
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
BA
BB
BC
BD
BE
BF
Access
RW
RW
Addr
(0,Hex)
138
139
Name
RW
RW
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
4A
4B
4C
4D
4E
4F
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
5A
5B
5C
5D
5E
5F
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
Page
138
139
Access
RW
RW
Addr
(0,Hex)
SPI_TXR
SPI_RXR
SPI_CR
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
0A
0B
0C
0D
0E
0F
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
1A
1B
1C
1D
1E
1F
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
2A
2B
2C
2D
2E
2F
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
3A
3B
3C
3D
3E
3F
Name
PRT3DR
PRT3IE
Page
PRT2DR
PRT2IE
Access
PRT1DR
PRT1IE
Addr
(0,Hex)
Name
PRT0DR
PRT0IE
RW
RW
162
163
RW
RW
RW
RW
#
RW
164
165
166
167
168
169
RW
170
RW
RW
RC
W
172
173
174
175
RL
176
RW
#
#
177
178
179
# Access is bit specific.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section E: Registers
Register Map Bank 1 Table: Configuration Space
OSC_CR2
VLT_CR
VLT_CMP
IMO_TR
ILO_TR
BDG_TR
SLP_CFG
CPU_F
CPU_SCR1
CPU_SCR0
Page
182
OSC_CR0
C0
C1
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
C8
C9
CA
CB
CC
CD
CE
CF
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
DA
DB
DC
DD
DE
DF
E0
E1
E2
E3
E4
E5
E6
E7
E8
E9
EA
EB
EC
ED
EE
EF
F0
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F9
FA
FB
FC
FD
FE
FF
Access
Gray fields are reserved.
RW
MUX_CR0
MUX_CR1
MUX_CR2
MUX_CR3
IO_CFG
OUT_P1
Addr
(1,Hex)
180
181
Name
RW
RW
Page
180
181
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
8A
8B
8C
8D
8E
8F
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
9A
9B
9C
9D
9E
9F
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
AA
AB
AC
AD
AE
AF
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
BA
BB
BC
BD
BE
BF
Access
RW
RW
Addr
(1,Hex)
180
181
Name
RW
RW
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
4A
4B
4C
4D
4E
4F
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
5A
5B
5C
5D
5E
5F
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
Page
180
181
Access
RW
RW
Addr
(1,Hex)
SPI_CFG
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
0A
0B
0C
0D
0E
0F
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
1A
1B
1C
1D
1E
1F
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
2A
2B
2C
2D
2E
2F
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
3A
3B
3C
3D
3E
3F
Name
PRT3DM0
PRT3DM1
Page
PRT2DM0
PRT2DM1
Access
PRT1DM0
PRT1DM1
Addr
(1,Hex)
Name
PRT0DM0
PRT0DM1
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
183
183
183
183
184
185
RW
186
RW
RW
R
187
188
189
W
W
RW
RW
190
191
192
193
RL
176
#
#
178
179
# Access is bit specific.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
135
[+] Feedback
Section E: Registers
136
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
20. Register Reference
This chapter is a reference for all the PSoC device registers in address order, for Bank 0 and Bank 1. The most detailed
descriptions of the PSoC registers are in the Register Definitions section of each chapter. The registers that are in both banks
are incorporated with the Bank 0 registers, designated with an ‘x’, rather than a ‘0’ preceding the comma in the address. Bank
0 registers are listed first and begin on page 138. Bank 1 registers are listed second and begin on page 180. A condensed
view of all the registers is shown in the register mapping tables starting on page 133.
20.1
Maneuvering Around the Registers
For ease-of-use, this chapter is formatted so that there is one register per page, although some registers use two pages. On
each page, from top to bottom, there are four sections:
1. Register name and address (from lowest to highest).
2. Register table showing the bit organization, with reserved bits grayed out.
3. Written description of register specifics or links to additional register information.
4. Detailed register bit descriptions.
Use the register tables, in addition to the detailed register bit descriptions, to determine which bits are reserved. Reserved bits
are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section. Reserved bits should always be written with a value
of ‘0’. For all registers, an ‘x’ before the comma in the address field indicates that the register can be accessed or written to no
matter what bank is used. For example, the M8C flag register’s (CPU_F) address is ‘x,F7h’ meaning it is located in bank 0
and bank 1 at F7h.
20.2
Register Conventions
This table lists the register conventions that are specific to this chapter.
Register Conventions
Convention
Example
Description
‘x’ in a register name
PRTxIE
Multiple instances/address ranges of the same register
R
R : 00
Read register or bit(s)
W
W : 00
Write register or bit(s)
O
RO : 00
Only a read/write register or bit(s).
L
RL : 00
Logical register or bit(s)
C
RC : 00
Clearable register or bit(s)
00
RW : 00
Reset value is 0x00 or 00h
XX
RW : XX
Register is not reset
0,
0,04h
Register is in bank 0
1,
1,23h
Register is in bank 1
x,
x,F7h
Empty, grayed-out table cell
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
Register exists in register bank 0 and register bank 1
Reserved bit or group of bits, unless otherwise stated
137
[+] Feedback
PRTxDR
0,00h
20.3
Bank 0 Registers
The following registers are all in bank 0 and are listed in address order. An ‘x’ before the comma in the register’s address indicates that the register can be accessed in Bank 0 and Bank 1, independent of the XIO bit in the CPU_F register. Registers
that are in both Bank 0 and Bank 1 are listed in address order in Bank 0. For example, the CPU_F register has an address of
X,F7h and is listed only in Bank 0 but is accessed in both Bank 0 and Bank 1.
20.3.1
PRTxDR
Port Data Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
PRT0DR : 0,00h
0,00h
PRT1DR : 0,04h
7
6
PRT2DR : 0,08h
5
4
PRT3DR : 0,0Ch
3
Access : POR
RW : 00
Bit Name
Data[7:0]
2
1
0
This register allows for write or read access, of the current logical equivalent, of the voltage on the pin.
For PRT3DR, the upper nibble of this register will return the last data bus value when read and should be masked off prior to
using this information.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 55 in the GPIO chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Data[7:0]
Write value to port or read value from port. Reads return the state of the pin, not the value in the
PRTxDR register.
138
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
PRTxIE
0,01h
20.3.2
PRTxIE
Port Interrupt Enable Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
PRT0IE : 0,01h
0,01h
PRT1IE : 0,05h
7
6
PRT2IE : 0,09h
5
4
PRT3IE : 0,0Dh
3
2
1
0
RW : 00
Access : POR
Interrupt Enables[7:0]
Bit Name
This register enables or disables interrupts from individual GPIO pins.
For PRT3DR, the upper nibble of this register returns the last data bus value when read and should be masked off prior to
using this information.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 55 in the GPIO chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Interrupt Enables[7:0]
Bits enable the corresponding port pin interrupt.
0
Port pin interrupt disabled for the corresponding pin.
1
Port pin interrupt enabled for the corresponding pin. Interrupt mode is determined by the
IOINT bit in the IO_CFG register.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
139
[+] Feedback
SPI_TXR
0,29h
20.3.3
SPI_TXR
SPI Transmit Data Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,29h
SPI_TXR : 0,29h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
W : 00
Access : POR
Data[7:0]
Bit Name
This register is the SPI’s transmit data register.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 117 in the SPI chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Data[7:0]
Data for selected function.
140
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
SPI_RXR
0,2Ah
20.3.4
SPI_RXR
SPI Receive Data Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,2Ah
SPI_RXR : 0,2Ah
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R : 00
Access : POR
Data[7:0]
Bit Name
This register is the SPI’s receive data register.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 117 in the SPI chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Data[7:0]
Data for selected function.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
141
[+] Feedback
SPI_CR
0,2Bh
20.3.5
SPI_CR
SPI Control Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,2Bh
SPI_CR : 0,2Bh
Access : POR
Bit Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
R:0
R:0
R:1
R:0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
LSb First
Overrun
SPI Complete
TX Reg Empty
RX Reg Full
Clock Phase
Clock Polarity
Enable
This register is the SPI control register.
The LSb First, Clock Phase, and Clock Polarity bits are configuration bits and should never be changed once the block is
enabled. These bits can be set at the same time that the block is enabled.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 117 in the SPI chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
LSb First
Do not change this bit during an SPI transfer.
0
Data is shifted out MSb first.
1
Data is shifted out LSb first.
6
Overrun
0
1
No overrun has occurred.
Overrun has occurred. Indicates that a new byte is received and loaded into the RX Buffer
before the previous one is read. It is cleared on a read of this (CR0) register.
5
SPI Complete
0
1
Indicates that a byte may still be in the process of shifting out, or no transmission is active.
Indicates that a byte is shifted out and all associated clocks are generated. It is cleared on a
read of this (CR0) register. Optional interrupt.
4
TX Reg Empty
Reset state and the state when the block is disabled is ‘1’.
0
Indicates that a byte is currently buffered in the TX register.
1
Indicates that a byte is written to the TX register and cleared on write of the TX Buffer (DR1)
register. This is the default interrupt. This status is initially asserted on block enable; however, the TX Reg Empty interrupt will occur only after the first data byte is written and transferred into the shifter.
3
RX Reg Full
0
1
RX register is empty.
A byte is received and loaded into the RX register. It is cleared on a read of the RX Buffer
(DR2) register.
2
Clock Phase
0
1
Data is latched on the leading clock edge. Data changes on the trailing edge (modes 0, 1).
Data changes on the leading clock edge. Data is latched on the trailing edge (modes 2, 3).
1
Clock Polarity
0
1
Non-inverted, clock idles low (modes 0, 2).
Inverted, clock idles high (modes 1, 3).
0
Enable
0
1
SPI function is not enabled.
SPI function is enabled.
142
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
AMUX_CFG
0,61h
20.3.6
AMUX_CFG
Analog Mux Configuration Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,61h
AMUX_CFG : 0,61h
7
6
5
4
Access : POR
Bit Name
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
RW : 0
ICAPEN[1:0]
INTCAP[1:0]
This register configures the integration capacitor pin connections to the analog global bus.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 82 in the IO
Analog Mux chapter.
Bits
Name
Description
3:2
ICAPEN[1:0]
Bits connect internal capacitance to the analog global bus.
00b
No capacitance
01b
Approximately 25 pF connected
10b
Approximately 50 pF connected
11b
Approximately 100 pF connected
1:0
INTCAP[1:0]
Select pins to enable connection of external integration capacitor in the charge integration mode.
00b
01b
10b
11b
Neither P0[3] or P0[1] enabled
P0[1] pin enabled
P0[3] pin enabled
Both P0[3] and P0[1] pins enabled
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
143
[+] Feedback
CMP_RDC
0,78h
20.3.7
CMP_RDC
Comparator Read/Clear Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
CMP_RDC : 0,78h
0,78h
7
6
5
3
2
1
0
R:0
R:0
RC : 0
RC : 0
CMP1D
CMP0D
CMP1L
CMP0L
Access : POR
Bit Name
4
This register is used to read the state of the comparator data signal, and the latched state of the comparator.
In the table above, reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below. Always write
reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 84 in the Comparators
chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
5
CMP1D
Read-only bit that returns the dynamically changing state of comparator 1. This bit reads zero whenever the comparator is disabled.
4
CMP0D
Read-only bit that returns the dynamically changing state of comparator 0. This bit reads zero whenever the comparator is disabled.
1
CMP1L
Bit reads the latch output for comparator 1. This bit is cleared by either a write of ‘0’ to this bit, or by a
rising edge of the comparator 0 LUT, depending on the state of the CRST1 bit in the CMP_CR1 register.
0
CMP0L
Bit reads the latch output for comparator 0. This bit is cleared by either a write of ‘0’ to this bit, or by a
rising edge of the comparator 1 LUT, depending upon the state of the CRST0 bit in the CMP_CR1
register.
144
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CMP_MUX
0,79h
20.3.8
CMP_MUX
Comparator Multiplexer Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,79h
CMP_MUX : 0,79h
7
Access : POR
Bit Name
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
INP1[1:0]
INN1[1:0]
INP0[1:0]
INN0[1:0]
This register contains control bits for input selection of comparators 0 and 1.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 84 in the Comparators chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:6
INP1[1:0]
Comparator 1 Positive Input Select
00b
Analog Global Mux Bus
01b
Reserved
10b
P0[1] pin
11b
P0[3] pin
5:4
INN1[1:0]
Comparator 1 Negative Input Select
00b
VREF (1.3V)
01b
Ref Lo (approximately 0.9V)
10b
Ref Hi (approximately 1.8V)
11b
Reserved
3:2
INP0[1:0]
Comparator 0 Positive Input Select
00b
Analog Global Mux Bus
01b
Reserved
10b
P0[1] pin
11b
P0[3] pin
1:0
INN0[1:0]
Comparator 0 Negative Input Select
00b
VREF (1.3V)
01b
Ref Lo (approximately 0.9V)
10b
Ref Hi (approximately 1.8V)
11b
Reserved
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
145
[+] Feedback
CMP_CR0
0,7Ah
20.3.9
CMP_CR0
Comparator Control Register 0
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,7Ah
CMP_CR0 : 0,7Ah
5
4
1
0
Access : POR
7
6
RW : 0
RW : 0
3
2
RW : 0
RW : 0
Bit Name
CMP1R
CMP1EN
CMP0R
CMP0EN
This register enables and configures the input range of the comparators.
In the table above, reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below. Always write
reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 84 in the Comparators
chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
5
CMP1R
0
1
Comparator 1 set to rail-to-rail input range, with approximately 20 μA cell current.
Comparator 1 set to limited input range (Vss to Vdd - 1V), with approximately 10 μA cell current.
4
CMP1EN
0
1
Comparartor 1 disabled, powered off.
Comparartor 1 enabled.
1
CMP0R
0
1
Comparator 0 set to rail-to-rail input range, with approximately 20 μA cell current.
Comparator 0 set to limited input range (Vss to Vdd - 1V), with approximately 10 μA cell current.
0
CMP0EN
0
1
Comparartor 0 disabled, powered off.
Comparartor 0 enabled.
146
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CMP_CR1
0,7Bh
20.3.10
CMP_CR1
Comparator Control Register 1
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,7Bh
CMP_CR1 : 0,7Bh
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Access : POR
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
Bit Name
CINT1
CPIN1
CRST1
CDS1
CINT0
CPIN0
CRST0
CDS0
This register is used to configure the comparator output options.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 84 in the Comparators chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
CINT1
This bit selects comparator 1 for input to the analog interrupt. Note that if both CINT1 and CINT0 are
set high, a rising edge on either comparator output may cause an interrupt.
0
Comparator 1 does not connect to the analog interrupt.
1
Comparartor 1 connects to the analog interrupt. A rising edge will assert that interrupt, if it is
enabled in the INT_MSK0 register.
6
CPIN1
This bit selects the Comparator 1 signal for possible connection to the GPIO pin. Connection to the
pin also depends on the configuration of the OUT_P1 register.
0
Select Comparator 1 LUT output
1
Select Comparator 1 Latch output
5
CRST1
This bit selects the source for resetting the Comparator 1 latch.
0
Reset by writing a ‘0’ to the CMP_RDC register’s CMP1L bit
1
Reset by rising edge of Comparator 0 LUT output
4
CDS1
This bit selects the data output for the comparator 1 channel, for routing to the capacitive sense logic
and comparator 1 interrupt.
0
Select the Comparator 1 LUT output
1
Select the Comparator 1 latch output
3
CINT0
This bit selects comparator 0 for input to the analog interrupt. Note that if both CINT1 and CINT0 are
set high, a rising edge on either comparator output may cause an interrupt.
0
Comparator 0 does not connect to the analog interrupt.
1
Comparartor 0 connects to the analog interrupt. A rising edge will assert that interrupt, if it is
enabled in the INT_MSK0 register.
2
CPIN0
This bit selects the Comparator 0 signal for possible connection to the GPIO pin. Connection to the
pin also depends on the configuration of the OUT_P1 register.
0
Select Comparator 0 LUT output
1
Select Comparator 0 Latch output
1
CRST0
This bit selects the source for resetting the Comparator 0 latch.
0
Reset by writing a ‘0’ to the CMP_RDC register’s CMP0L bit
1
Reset by rising edge of Comparator 1 LUT output
(continued on next page)
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
147
[+] Feedback
CMP_CR1
0,7Bh
20.3.10
0
148
CDS0
CMP_CR1 (continued)
This bit selects the data output for the comparator 0 channel, for routing to the capacitive sense logic
and comparator 0 interrupt.
0
Select the Comparator 0 LUT output
1
Select the Comparator 0 latch output
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CMP_LUT
0,7Ch
20.3.11
CMP_LUT
Comparator LUT Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,7Ch
CMP_LUT: 0,7Ch
7
6
5
Bit Name
4
3
2
1
RW : 0
RW : 0
LUT1[3:0]
LUT0[3:0]
Access : POR
0
This register selects the logic function.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 84 in the Comparators chapter.
Bits
Name
Description
7:4
LUT1[3:0]
Select 1 of 16 logic functions for output of comparator bus 1. A = Comp1 output, B = Comp0 output.
Function
0h
FALSE
1h
A AND B
2h
A AND B
3h
A
4h
A AND B
5h
B
6h
A XOR B
7h
A OR B
8h
A NOR B
9h
A XNOR B
Ah
B
Bh
A OR B
Ch
A
Dh
A OR B
Eh
A NAND B
Fh
TRUE
3:0
LUT0[3:0]
Select 1 of 16 logic functions for output of comparator bus 0. A = Comp0 output, B = Comp1 output.
Function
0h
FALSE
1h
A AND B
2h
A AND B
3h
A
4h
A AND B
5h
B
6h
A XOR B
7h
A OR B
8h
A NOR B
9h
A XNOR B
Ah
B
Bh
A OR B
Ch
A
Dh
A OR B
Eh
A NAND B
Fh
TRUE
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
149
[+] Feedback
CS_CR0
0,A0h
20.3.12
CS_CR0
CapSense Control Register 0
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,A0h
CS_CR0 : 0,A0h
7
Access : POR
Bit Name
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
CSOUT[1:0]
MODE[1:0]
EN
This register controls the operation of the CapSense counters.
Never write to bits [7:1] while the block is enabled.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 74 in the
CapSense Module chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:6
CSOUT[1:0]
CapSense Output
00b
Selected Input
01b
CapSense Interrupt
10b
Carry Out Low Byte
11b
Carry Out High Byte
2:1
MODE[1:0]
CapSense Counter Mode
00b
Event mode. Start in Enable, stop on interrupt event.
01b
Pulse Width mode. Start on positive edge of next input. Stop on negative edge of input.
10b
Period mode. Start on positive edge of input. Stop on next positive edge of input.
11b
Start in Enable, continuous operation until disable.
0
EN
0
1
150
Counting is stopped and all counter values are reset to ‘0’.
Counters are enabled for counting.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CS_CR1
0,A1h
20.3.13
CS_CR1
CapSense Control Register 1
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,A1h
CS_CR1 : 0,A1h
4
3
Access : POR
RW : 0
7
6
RW : 0
5
RW : 0
RW : 0
2
RW : 0
1
Bit Name
CHAIN
CLKSEL[1:0]
RLOSEL
INV
INSEL[2:0]
0
This register contains additional CapSense system control options.
Never write to this register while the block is enabled.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 74 in the CapSense Module chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
CHAIN
Counter Chain Control
0
8-bit high/low counters operate independently
1
High/low counters operate as a 16-bit synchronous block
6:5
CLKSEL[1:0]
CapSense Clock (CSCLK) Selection
00b
IMO
01b
IMO/2
10b
IMO/4
11b
IMO/8
4
RLOSEL
Relaxation Oscillator Clock (RLO) Select
0
High byte counter runs on the selected IMO-based frequency.
1
High byte counter runs on the RLO clock frequency.
3
INV
Input Invert
0
Selected input is not inverted.
1
Selected input is inverted.
2:0
INSEL[2:0]
Input Selection
000b
Comparator 0
001b
ILO
010b
Comparator 1
011b
RLO Timer Terminal Count
100b
Interval Timer
101b
RLO Timer IRQ
110b
Analog Global Mux Bus
111b
‘0’
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
151
[+] Feedback
CS_CR2
0,A2h
20.3.14
CS_CR2
CapSense Control Register 2
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,A2h
CS_CR2 : 0,A2h
7
Access : POR
Bit Name
5
4
RW : 0
6
RW : 0
RW : 0
3
RW : 0
2
1
RW : 0
0
IRANGE[1:0]
IDACDIR
IDAC_EN
PXD_EN
RO_EN
This register contains additional CapSense system control options.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 74 in the CapSense Module chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:6
IRANGE[1:0]
Bits scale the IDAC current output. The IDAC_D register sets the base current in the IDAC.
00
IDAC output scaled to 1X range.
01
IDAC output scaled to 2X range.
10
IDAC output scaled to 4X range.
11
IDAC output scaled to 8X range.
5
IDACDIR
Bit determines the source/sink state of the IDAC when enabled (IDAC_EN = 1 or PXD_EN = 1).
0
IDAC sources current to analog global bus.
1
IDAC sinks current from analog global bus.
4
IDAC_EN
Bit provides manual connection of the IDAC to the analog global bus. The IDAC is automatically connected when RO_EN = 1 or PXD_EN = 1.
0
No manual connection
1
IDAC is connected to analog global bus.
2
PXD_EN
0
1
No clock to I/O pins
Enabled pins switch between ground and the analog global bus. Clock rate selected by the
CLKSEL bits in the CS_CR1 register. Selected clock drives CapSense timer.
0
RO_EN
0
1
Relaxation oscillator disabled.
Relaxation oscillator enabled. Charging currents are set by the IRANGE bits and the
IDAC_D register value.
152
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CS_CR3
0,A3h
20.3.15
CS_CR3
CapSense Control Register 3
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,A3h
CS_CR3 : 0,A3h
7
6
5
4
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
IBOOST
REFMUX
REFMODE
REF_EN
LPFilt[1:0]
LPF_EN[1:0]
Access : POR
Bit Name
3
2
1
0
This register contains control bits primarily for the proximity detection algorithm.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 74 in the CapSense Module chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
IBOOST
This bit adds a fixed boost current to the IDAC output. This affects all functions using the IDAC, such
as the relaxation oscillator. The boost size is approximately equal to 200 (decimal) counts of the
IDAC_D register.
0
No boost current
1
Boost current is added to IDAC output.
6
REFMUX
This bit selects the reference voltage for the input of the reference buffer.
0
Select REFHI (1.8V)
1
Select VREF (1.3V)
5
REFMODE
This bit allows manual connection of the reference buffer output to the analog global bus. If either
CI_EN=1 or RO_EN=1 in the CS_CR2 register, this bit has no effect (reference buffer connection is
off or controlled by other settings).
0
No connection
1
Reference buffer connected to the analog global bus.
4
REF_EN
This bit enables the reference buffer to drive the analog global bus.
0
Reference buffer is disabled, powered down.
1
Reference buffer is enabled. Connection to the analog global bus is controlled by the REFMODE bit in this register, and by the CI_EN and RO_EN bits in the CS_CR2 register.
3:2
LPFilt[1:0]
Low pass filter approximate time constant.
00b
1 μs
01b
2 μs
10b
5 μs
11b
10 μs
1:0
LPF_EN[1:0]
These bits enable the low pass filter.
00b
No connection of either comparator channel to low pass filter
01b
Connect comparator channel 0 through the low pass filter
10b
Connect comparator channel 1 through the low pass filter
11b
Connect both comparator channel inputs together, and through the low pass filter
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
153
[+] Feedback
CS_CNTL
0,A4h
20.3.16
CS_CNTL
CapSense Counter Low Byte Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,A4h
CS_CNTL : 0,A4h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R : 00
Access : POR
Data[7:0]
Bit Name
This register contains the current count for the low byte counter.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 74 in the CapSense Module chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Data[7:0]
On a read of this register, the current count is returned. It is only read when the counter is stopped.
Note The counter must be stopped by the configured event. When the counter is disabled, the count
is reset to 00h.
154
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CS_CNTH
0,A5h
20.3.17
CS_CNTH
CapSense Counter High Byte Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,A5h
CS_CNTH : 0,A5h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R : 00
Access : POR
Data[7:0]
Bit Name
This register contains the current count value for the high byte counter.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 74 in the CapSense Module chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Data[7:0]
On a read of this register, the current count is returned. It is only read when the counter is stopped.
Note The counter must be stopped by the configured event. When the counter is disabled, the count
is reset to 00h.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
155
[+] Feedback
CS_STAT
0,A6h
20.3.18
CS_STAT
CapSense Status Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,A6h
CS_STAT : 0,A6h
Access : POR
Bit Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RC : 0
RC : 0
RC : 0
RC : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
INS
COLS
COHS
PPS
INM
COLM
COHM
PPM
This register controls the CapSense counter options.
Never modify the interrupt mask bits while the block is enabled. If modification to bits 3 to 0 is necessary while the block is
enabled, then pay attention to ensure that the status bits, bits 7 to 4, are not accidentally cleared. This is done by writing a ‘1’
to all of the status bits when writing to the mask bits.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 74 in the CapSense Module chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
INS
Input Status
0
No event detected
1
A rising edge on the selected input was detected. Cleared by writing a ‘0’ to this bit.
6
COLS
Counter Carry Out Low Status
0
No event detected
1
A carry out from the low byte counter was detected. Cleared by writing a ‘0’ back to this bit.
5
COHS
Counter Carry Out High Status
0
No event detected
1
A carry out from the high byte counter was detected. Cleared by writing a ‘0’ back to this bit.
4
PPS
Pulse Width/Period Measurement Status
0
No event detected
1
A pulse width or period measurement was completed. Cleared by writing a ‘0’ back to this
bit.
3
INM
Input Interrupt/Mask
0
Disabled
1
Input event is enabled to assert the block interrupt.
2
COLM
Counter Carry Out Low Interrupt Mask
0
Disabled
1
Counter carry out low is enabled to assert the block interrupt.
1
COHM
Counter Carry Out High Interrupt Mask
0
Disabled
1
Counter carry out high is enabled to assert the block interrupt.
0
PPM
Pulse Width/Period Measurement Interrupt Mask
0
Disabled
1
Completion of a pulse width or period measurement is enabled to assert the block interrupt.
156
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CS_TIMER
0,A7h
20.3.19
CS_TIMER
CapSense Timer Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,A7h
CS_TIMER : 0,A7h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 00
Access : POR
Timer Count Value[5:0]
Bit Name
This register sets the timer count value.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 74 in the
CapSense Module chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
5:0
Timer Count Value[5:0]
Holds the timer count value.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
157
[+] Feedback
CS_SLEW
0,A8h
20.3.20
CS_SLEW
CapSense Slew Control Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,A8h
CS_SLEW : 0,A8h
7
6
5
Access : POR
Bit Name
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
RW : 0
FastSlew[6:0]
FS_EN
This register enables and controls a fast slewing mode for the relaxation oscillator.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 74 in the CapSense Module chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:1
FastSlew[6:0]
This 7-bit value sets a counter, clocked at the IMO frequency. While the counter is counting down
from this value, the relaxation oscillator edge slews at the maximum gain setting. During this interval,
the IRANGE bits in the CS_CR2 register are internally set to maximum (11b). At the end of the interval, the user-defined IRANGE level is restored, so that the relaxation oscillator continues slewing with
a slower edge rate to the target voltage threshold. If the FS_EN bit is low, the FastSlew setting has no
effect.
After each edge of the relaxation oscillator, the counter is re-loaded and the fast slewing interval reoccurs, followed by the slower edge rate at the end of the count down.
Note that the IRANGE bits in the CS_CR2 register will always read the user-defined setting. Because
the IRANGE value is forced to maximum during this interval, the increase in the edge rate can be 1X,
2X, 4X, or 8X, depending on the programmed value of the IRANGE bits.
0000000b
0000001b
…
1111111b
0
158
FS_EN
No fast edge rate interval
Minimum fast edge rate interval (1 IMO period)
Maximum fast edge rate interval (127 IMO period)
Enable bit for the Fast Slew mode
0
Fast slew mode disabled.
1
Fast slew mode enabled. After each relaxation oscillator transition, the relaxation oscillator
runs with a higher current for a time controlled by the FastSlew bits.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
PT_CFG
0,B0h
20.3.21
PT_CFG
Programmable Timer Configuration Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,B0h
PT_CFG : 0,B0h
7
6
5
Access : POR
Bit Name
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
RW : 0
One Shot
START
This register configures the programmable timer.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 131 in the
Programmable Timer chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
1
One Shot
0
1
0
START
0
1
Continuous count mode. Timer reloads the count value from the data registers at each terminal count, and continues counting.
One-shot mode. Timer goes through one complete count period and then stops. At completion, the START bit in this register is cleared.
Timer held in reset.
Timer counts down from a full count determined from its data registers (PT_DATA1,
PT_DATA0). When complete, it either stops or reloads and continues, based on the One
Shot bit in this register.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
159
[+] Feedback
PT_DATA1
0,B1h
20.3.22
PT_DATA1
Programmable Timer Data Register 1
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,B1h
PT_DATA1 : 0,B1h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 00
Access : POR
DATA[4:0]
Bit Name
This register provides the programmable timer with its upper 5 bits of the count value.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 131 in the
Programmable Timer chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
4:0
Data[4:0]
Holds upper 5 bits of 13-bit count value.
160
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
PT_DATA0
0,B2h
20.3.23
PT_DATA0
Programmable Timer Data Register 0
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,B2h
PT_DATA0 : 0,B2h
7
6
5
4
3
Access : POR
RW : 00
Bit Name
Data[7:0]
2
1
0
This register is used to provide the programmable timer with its lower 8 bits of the count value.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 131 in the Programmable Timer chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Data[7:0]
Holds lower 8 bits of 13-bit count value.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
161
[+] Feedback
CUR_PP
0,D0h
20.3.24
CUR_PP
Current Page Pointer Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,D0h
CUR_PP: 0,D0h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
Access : POR
Page Bit
Bit Name
This register sets the effective SRAM page for normal memory accesses in a multi-SRAM page PSoC device.
This register is only used when a device has more than one page of SRAM.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 34 in the
RAM Paging chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
0
Page Bit
This bit determines which SRAM page is used for generic SRAM access. See the RAM
Paging chapter on page 31 for more information.
0b
1b
SRAM Page 0
SRAM Page 1
Note A value beyond the available SRAM, for a specific PSoC device, should not be set.
162
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
STK_PP
0,D1h
20.3.25
STK_PP
Stack Page Pointer Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,D1h
STK_PP: 0,D1h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
Access : POR
Page Bit
Bit Name
This register sets the effective SRAM page for stack memory accesses in a multi-SRAM page PSoC device.
This register is only used when a device has more than one page of SRAM.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 34 in the
RAM Paging chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
0
Page Bit
This bit determines which SRAM page is used to hold the stack. See the RAM Paging chapter on
page 31 for more information.
0b
1b
SRAM Page 0
SRAM Page 1
Note A value beyond the available SRAM, for a specific PSoC device, should not be set.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
163
[+] Feedback
IDX_PP
0,D3h
20.3.26
IDX_PP
Indexed Memory Access Page Pointer Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,D3h
IDX_PP: 0,D3h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
Access : POR
Page Bit
Bit Name
This register sets the effective SRAM page for indexed memory accesses in a multi-SRAM page PSoC device.
This register is only used when a device has more than one page of SRAM.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 34 in the
RAM Paging chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
0
Page Bit
This bit determines which SRAM page an indexed memory access operates on. See the Register
Definitions on page 34 for more information on when this register is active.
0b
1b
SRAM Page 0
SRAM Page 1
Note A value beyond the available SRAM, for a specific PSoC device, should not be set.
164
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
MVR_PP
0,D4h
20.3.27
MVR_PP
MVI Read Page Pointer Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,D4h
MVR_PP: 0,D4h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
Access : POR
Page Bit
Bit Name
This register sets the effective SRAM page for MVI read memory accesses in a multi-SRAM page PSoC device.
This register is only used when a device has more than one page of SRAM.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 34 in the
RAM Paging chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
0
Page Bit
This bit determines on which SRAM page an MVI Read instruction operates.
0b
1b
SRAM Page 0
SRAM Page 1
Note A value beyond the available SRAM, for a specific PSoC device, is not set.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
165
[+] Feedback
MVW_PP
0,D5h
20.3.28
MVW_PP
MVI Write Page Pointer Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,D5h
MVW_PP: 0,D5h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
Access : POR
Page Bit
Bit Name
This register sets the effective SRAM page for MVI write memory accesses in a multi-SRAM page PSoC device.
This register is only used when a device has more than one page of SRAM.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 34 in the
RAM Paging chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
0
Page Bit
This bit determines on which SRAM page aa MVI Write instruction operates.
0b
1b
SRAM Page 0
SRAM Page 1
Note A value beyond the available SRAM, for a specific PSoC device, should not be set.
166
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
I2C_CFG
0,D6h
20.3.29
I2C_CFG
I2C Configuration Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,D6h
I2C_CFG: 0,D6h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Access : POR
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
Bit Name
PSelect
Stop IE
Clock Rate[1:0]
Enable
This register sets the basic operating modes, baud rate, and selection of interrupts.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 98 in the I2C
Slave chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
6
PSelect
I2C Pin Select
0
P1[5] and P1[7]
1
P1[0] and P1[1]
Note Read the I2C Slave chapter for a discussion of the side effects of choosing the P1[0] and P1[1]
pair of pins.
4
Stop IE
Stop Interrupt Enable
0
Disabled
1
Enabled. An interrupt is generated on the detection of a Stop condition.
3:2
Clock Rate[1:0]
00b
01b
10b
11b
100K Standard Mode
400K Fast Mode
50K Standard Mode
Reserved
0
Enable
0
1
Disabled
Enabled
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
167
[+] Feedback
I2C_SCR
0,D7h
20.3.30
I2C_SCR
I2C Status and Control Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,D7h
I2C_SCR: 0,D7h
5
4
3
2
1
0
RC : 0
7
RC : 0
RW : 0
RC : 0
RW : 0
RC : 0
RC : 0
Bus Error
Stop Status
ACK
Address
Transmit
LRB
Byte Complete
Access : POR
Bit Name
6
The slave uses this register to control the flow of data bytes and to keep track of the bus state during a transfer.
Bits in this register are held in reset until one of the enable bits in I2C_CFG is set.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 98 in the I2C
Slave chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
Bus Error
0
1
5
Stop Status
0
1
Status bit. It must be cleared by firmware by writing a ‘0’ to the bit position. It is never
cleared by the hardware.
A misplaced Start or Stop condition was detected.
Status bit. It must be cleared by firmware with write of ‘0’ to the bit position. It is never
cleared by the hardware.
A Stop condition was detected.
4
ACK
Acknowledge Out. Bit is automatically cleared by hardware on a Byte Complete event.
0
NACK the last received byte.
1
ACK the last received byte
3
Address
0
1
2
Transmit
This bit is set by firmware to define the direction of the byte transfer. Any Start detect or a write to the
Start or Restart generate bits, when operating in Master mode, will also clear the bit.
0
Receive mode
1
Transmit mode
1
LRB
This is the Last Received Bit. The value of the 9th bit in a Transmit sequence, which is the acknowledge bit from the receiver. Any Start detect or a write to the Start or Restart generate bits, when operating in Master mode, will also clear the bit.
0
Last transmitted byte was ACK’ed by the receiver.
1
Last transmitted byte was NACK’ed by the receiver.
0
Byte Complete
Transmit/Receive Mode:
0
No completed transmit/receive since last cleared by firmware. Any Start detect or a write to
the Start or Restart generate bits, when operating in Master mode, will also clear the bit.
Status bit. It must be cleared by firmware with write of ‘0’ to the bit position.
The received byte is a slave address.
Transmit Mode:
1
Eight bits of data were transmitted and an ACK or NACK has been received.
Receive Mode:
1
Eight bits of data were received.
168
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
I2C_DR
0,D8h
20.3.31
I2C_DR
I2C Data Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,D8h
I2C_DR: 0,D8h
7
6
5
4
3
Access : POR
RW : 00
Bit Name
Data[7:0]
2
1
0
This register provides read/write access to the Shift register.
This register is read only for received data and write only for transmitted data.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 98 in the I2C Slave chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Data[7:0]
Read received data or write data to transmit
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
169
[+] Feedback
INT_CLR0
0,DAh
20.3.32
INT_CLR0
Interrupt Clear Register 0
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,DAh
INT_CLR0: 0,DAh
Access : POR
Bit Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
I2C
Sleep
SPI
GPIO
Timer
CapSense
Analog
V Monitor
This register enables the individual interrupt sources’ ability to clear posted interrupts.
When bits in this register are read, a ‘1’ is returned for every bit position that has a corresponding posted interrupt. When bits
in this register are written with a ‘0’ and ENSWINT is not set, posted interrupts are cleared at the corresponding bit positions.
If there was not a posted interrupt, there is no effect. When bits in this register are written with a ‘1’ and ENSWINT is set, an
interrupt is posted in the interrupt controller.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 48 in the Interrupt Controller chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
I2C
Read 0
Read 1
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 1
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 1
No posted interrupt for I2C.
Posted interrupt present for I2C.
Clear posted interrupt if it exists.
No effect
No effect
Post an interrupt for I2C.
6
Sleep
Read 0
Read 1
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 1
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 1
No posted interrupt for sleep timer.
Posted interrupt present for sleep timer.
Clear posted interrupt if it exists.
No effect
No effect
Post an interrupt for sleep timer.
5
SPI
Read 0
Read 1
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 1
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 1
No posted interrupt for SPI.
Posted interrupt present for SPI.
Clear posted interrupt if it exists.
No effect
No effect
Post an interrupt for SPI.
4
GPIO
Read 0
Read 1
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 1
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 1
No posted interrupt for general purpose inputs and outputs (pins).
Posted interrupt present for GPIO (pins).
Clear posted interrupt if it exists.
No effect
No effect
Post an interrupt for general purpose inputs and outputs (pins).
(continued on next page)
170
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
INT_CLR0
0,DAh
20.3.32
INT_CLR0 (continued)
3
Time0r
Read 0
Read 1
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 1
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 1
No posted interrupt for Timer.
Posted interrupt present for Timer.
Clear posted interrupt if it exists.
No effect
No effect
Post an interrupt for Timer.
2
CapSense
Read 0
Read 1
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 1
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 1
No posted interrupt for CapSense.
Posted interrupt present for CapSense.
Clear posted interrupt if it exists.
No effect
No effect
Post an interrupt for CapSense.
1
Analog
Read 0
Read 1
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 1
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 1
No posted interrupt for analog.
Posted interrupt present for analog.
Clear posted interrupt if it exists.
No effect
No effect
Post an interrupt for analog.
0
V Monitor
Read 0
Read 1
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 0
Write 0 AND ENSWINT = 1
Write 1 AND ENSWINT = 1
No posted interrupt for supply voltage monitor.
Posted interrupt present for supply voltage monitor.
Clear posted interrupt if it exists.
No effect
No effect
Post an interrupt for supply voltage monitor.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
171
[+] Feedback
INT_MSK0
0,E0h
20.3.33
INT_MSK0
Interrupt Mask Register 0
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,E0h
INT_MSK0: 0,E0h
Access : POR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
I2C
Sleep
SPI
GPIO
Timer
CapSense
Analog
V Monitor
Bit Name
This register enables the individual sources’ ability to create pending interrupts.
When an interrupt is masked off, the mask bit is ‘0’. The interrupt still posts in the interrupt controller. Therefore, clearing the
mask bit only prevents a posted interrupt from becoming a pending interrupt.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 48 in the Interrupt Controller chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
I2C
0
1
Mask I2C interrupt
Unmask I2C interrupt
6
Sleep
0
1
Mask sleep interrupt
Unmask sleep interrupt
5
SPI
0
1
Mask SPI interrupt
Unmask SPI interrupt
4
GPIO
0
1
Mask GPIO interrupt
Unmask GPIO interrupt
3
Timer
0
1
Mask Timer interrupt
Unmask Timer interrupt
2
CapSense
0
1
Mask CapSense interrupt
Unmask CapSense interrupt
1
Analog
0
1
Mask analog interrupt
Unmask analog interrupt
0
V Monitor
0
1
Mask voltage monitor interrupt
Unmask voltage monitor interrupt
172
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
INT_SW_EN
0,E1h
20.3.34
INT_SW_EN
Interrupt Software Enable Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,E1h
INT_SW_EN: 0,E1h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
Access : POR
ENSWINT
Bit Name
This register enables software interrupts.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 48 in the
Interrupt Controller chapter.
Bit
Name
0
ENSWINT
Description
0
1
Disable software interrupts
Enable software interrupts
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
173
[+] Feedback
INT_VC
0,E2h
20.3.35
INT_VC
Interrupt Vector Clear Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,E2h
INT_VC: 0,E2h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RC : 00
Access : POR
Pending Interrupt[7:0]
Bit Name
This register returns the next pending interrupt and clears all pending interrupts when written.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 48 in the Interrupt Controller chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Pending Interrupt[7:0]
Read
Returns vector for highest priority pending interrupt.
Write
Clears all pending and posted interrupts.
174
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
RES_WDT
0,E3h
20.3.36
RES_WDT
Reset Watchdog Timer Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,E3h
RES_WDT: 0,E3h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
W : 00
Access : POR
WDSL_Clear[7:0]
Bit Name
This register clears the watchdog timer alone, or clear both the watchdog timer and the sleep timer together.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 63 in the Sleep and Watchdog chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
WDSL_Clear[7:0]
Any write clears the watchdog timer. A write of 38h clears both the watchdog and sleep timers.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
175
[+] Feedback
CPU_F
x,F7h
20.3.37
CPU_F
M8C Flag Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
x,F7h
CPU_F: x,F7h
7
Access : POR
Bit Name
2
1
0
RL : 0
6
5
RL : 0
4
3
RL : 0
RL : 0
RL : 0
PgMode[1:0]
XIO
Carry
Zero
GIE
This register provides read access to the M8C flags.
The AND f, expr; OR f, expr; and XOR f, expr flag instructions can be used to modify this register.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 30 in the
M8C chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:6
PgMode[1:0]
00b
Direct Address mode and Indexed Address mode operands are referred to RAM Page 0,
regardless of the values of CUR_PP and IDX_PP. Note that this condition prevails on entry
to an Interrupt Service Routine when the CPU_F register is cleared.
01b
Direct Address mode instructions are referred to Page 0.
Indexed Address mode instructions are referred to the RAM page specified by the stack
page pointer, STK_PP.
10b
Direct Address mode instructions are referred to the RAM page specified by the current
page pointer, CUR_PP.
Indexed Address mode instructions are referred to the RAM page specified by the index
page pointer, IDX_PP.
11b
Direct Address mode instructions are referred to the RAM page specified by the current
page pointer, CUR_PP.
Indexed Address mode instructions are referred to the RAM page specified by the stack
page pointer, STK_PP.
Normal register address space
Extended register address space. Primarily used for configuration.
4
XIO
0
1
2
Carry
Set by the M8C CPU Core to indicate whether there has been a carry in the previous logical/arithmetic operation.
0
No carry
1
Carry
1
Zero
Set by the M8C CPU Core to indicate whether there has been a zero result in the previous logical/
arithmetic operation.
0
Not equal to zero
1
Equal to zero
0
GIE
0
1
176
M8C processes no interrupts.
Interrupt processing enabled.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
IDAC_D
0,FDh
20.3.38
IDAC_D
Current DAC Data Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
0,FDh
IDAC_D : 0,FDh
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 00
Access : POR
IDACDATA[7:0]
Bit Name
This register specifies the 8-bit multiplying factor that determines the output IDAC current.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 74 in the CapSense Module chapter.
Bits
Name
Description
7:0
IDACDATA[7:0]
The eight-bit value that selects the number of current units that combine to form the IDAC current.
This current then drives the analog mux bus when IDAC mode is enabled. For example, a setting of
80h means that the charging current is 128 current units.
The current size also depends upon the IRANGE setting in the CS_CR2 register. This setting supplies the charging current for the relaxation oscillator. This current and the external capacitance connected to the analog global bus determines the RO frequency.
This register is also used to set the charging current in the proximity detect mode.
Step size is approximately 330 nA/bit for default IRANGE state 00b.
00h
Smallest current (nominally zero unless IBOOST bit is set in the CS_CR3 register).
FFh
Largest current
Note At very low currents a low frequency noise exists on the IDAC output. To avoid generating this
low frequency noise, do not use IDAC_D settings equal to or less than three for capacitive sensing
applications.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
177
[+] Feedback
CPU_SCR1
x,FEh
20.3.39
CPU_SCR1
System Status and Control Register 1
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
x,FEh
CPU_SCR1: x,FEh
7
Access : POR
Bit Name
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R:0
RW : 0
RW : 0
IRESS
SLIMO
IRAMDIS
This register conveys the status and control of events related to internal resets and watchdog reset.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section. Always
write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 108 in the System
Resets chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
IRESS
This bit is read only.
0
Boot phase only executed once.
1
Boot phase occurred multiple times.
4
SLIMO
This bit reduces frequency of the internal main oscillator (IMO) and is reserved on PSoC devices that
do not support the slow IMO (see the Architectural Description on page 57).
0
IMO produces 12 MHz
1
Slow IMO (6 MHz)
0
IRAMDIS
0
1
178
SRAM is initialized to 00h after POR, XRES, and WDR.
Addresses 03h - D7h of SRAM Page 0 are not modified by WDR.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
CPU_SCR0
x,FFh
20.3.40
CPU_SCR0
System Status and Control Register 0
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
x,FFh
CPU_SCR0: x,FFh
5
4
3
Access : POR
R:0
7
6
RC : 0
RC : 1
RW : 0
2
1
RW : 0
0
Bit Name
GIES
WDRS
PORS
Sleep
STOP
This register conveys the status and control of events for various functions of a PSoC device.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section. Always
write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 108 in the System
Resets chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
GIES
Global Interrupt Enable Status. It is recommended that the user read the Global Interrupt Enable Flag
bit from the CPU_F register on page 176. This bit is read only for GIES. Its use is discouraged,
because the Flag register is now readable at address x,F7h (read only).
5
WDRS
Watchdog Reset Status. This bit may not be set by user code; however, it may be cleared by writing
a ‘0’.
0
No Watchdog reset has occurred.
1
Watchdog reset has occurred.
4
PORS
Power On Reset Status. This bit may not be set by user code; however, it may be cleared by writing a
‘0’.
0
Power On Reset has not occurred and watchdog timer is enabled.
1
Will be set after external reset or Power On Reset.
3
Sleep
Set by the user to enable the CPU sleep state. CPU will remain in Sleep mode until any interrupt is
pending.
0
Normal operation
1
Sleep
0
STOP
0
1
M8C is free to execute code.
M8C is halted. Can only be cleared by POR, XRES, or WDR.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
179
[+] Feedback
PRTxDM0
1,00h
20.4
Bank 1 Registers
The following registers are all in bank 1 and are listed in address order. Registers that are in both Bank 0 and Bank 1 are
listed in address order in the section titled Bank 0 Registers on page 138.
20.4.1
PRTxDM0
Port Drive Mode Bit Register 0
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
PRT0DM0 : 1,00h
1,00h
PRT1DM0 : 1,04h
7
6
PRT2DM0 : 1,08h
5
4
3
PRT3DM0 : 1,0Ch
2
1
0
RW : 00
Access : POR
Drive Mode 0[7:0]
Bit Name
This register is one of two registers whose combined value determines the unique drive mode of each bit in a GPIO port.
In register PRTxDM0 there are four possible drive modes for each port pin. Two mode bits are required to select one of these
modes, and these two bits are spread into two different registers (PRTxDM0 and PRTxDM1 on page 181). The bit position of
the affected port pin (for example, Pin[2] in Port 0) is the same as the bit position of each of the two Drive Mode register bits
that control the Drive mode for that pin (for example, bit[2] in PRT0DM0 and bit[2] in PRT0DM1). The two bits from the two
registers are treated as a group. These are referred to as DM1 and DM0, or together as DM[1:0].
All Drive mode bits are shown in the subtable below ([10] refers to the combination (in order) of bits in a given bit position);
however, this register only controls the least significant bit (LSb) of the Drive mode.
The upper nibble of the PRT3DM0 register returns the last data bus value when read and should be masked off before using
this information.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 55 in the GPIO chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Drive Mode 0[7:0]
Bit 0 of the Drive mode, for each of 8-port pins, for a GPIO port.
[10]
00b
01b
10b
Pull up
Strong
ITIZ
Pin Output High
Resistive
Strong
High-Z
11b
Open Drain Low
High-Z
Pin Output Low Notes
Strong
Strong
High-Z
Reset state. Digital input
disabled for zero power.
Strong
I2C compatible mode. For digital
inputs, use this mode with data
bit PRTxDR register) set high.
Note A bold digit, in the table above, signifies that the digit is used in this register.
180
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
PRTxDM1
1,01h
20.4.2
PRTxDM1
Port Drive Mode Bit Register 1
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
PRT0DM1 : 1,01h
1,01h
PRT1DM1 : 1,05h
7
6
PRT2DM1 : 1,09h
5
4
PRT3DM1 : 1,0Dh
3
2
1
0
RW : FF
Access : POR
Drive Mode 1[7:0]
Bit Name
This register is one of three registers whose combined value determines the unique Drive mode of each bit in a GPIO port.
In register PRTxDM1 there are four possible drive modes for each port pin. Two mode bits are required to select one of these
modes, and these two bits are spread into two different registers (PRTxDM1 and PRTxDM0 on page 180). The bit position of
the effected port pin (for example, Pin[2] in Port 0) is the same as the bit position of each of the two Drive Mode register bits
that control the Drive mode for that pin (for example, bit[2] in PRT0DM0 and bit[2] in PRT0DM1). The two bits from the two
registers are treated as a group. These are referred to as DM1 and DM0, or together as DM[1:0].
All Drive mode bits are shown in the subtable below ([10] refers to the combination (in order) of bits in a given bit position);
however, this register only controls the most significant bit (MSb) of the Drive mode.
The upper nibble of the PRT3DM1 register returns the last data bus value when read and should be masked off prior to using
this information.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 55 in the GPIO chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Drive Mode 1[7:0]
Bit 1 of the Drive mode, for each of 8-port pins, for a GPIO port.
[10]
00b
01b
10b
Pull up
Strong
ITIZ
Pin Output High
Resistive
Strong
High-Z
Pin Output Low
Strong
Strong
High-Z
11b
Open Drain Low
High-Z
Strong
Notes
Reset state. Digital input
disabled for zero power.
I2C compatible mode.
For digital inputs, use this
mode with data bit
(PRTxDR register) set high.
Note A bold digit, in the table above, signifies that the digit is used in this register.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
181
[+] Feedback
SPI_CFG
1,29h
20.4.3
SPI_CFG
SPI Configuration Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,29h
SPI_CFG : 1,29h
7
Access : POR
Bit Name
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
6
5
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
Clock Sel[2:0]
Bypass
SS_
SS_EN_
Int Sel
Slave
This register configures the SPI.
Do not change the values in this register while the block is enabled.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 117 in the SPI chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:5
Clock Sel[2:0]
SYSCLK in Master mode
000b
/2
001b
/4
010b
/8
011b
/ 16
100b
/ 32
101b
/ 64
110b
/ 128
111b
/ 256
4
Bypass
Bypass Synchronization
0
All pin unputs are doubled, synchronized
1
Input synchronization is bypassed.
3
SS_
Slave Select in Slave mode
0
Slave selected
1
Slave not selected
2
SS_EN_
Internal Slave Select Enable
0
Slave selection determined from SS_ bit.
1
Slave selection determined from external SS_ pin.
1
Int Sel
Interrupt Select
0
Interrupt on TX Reg Empty.
1
Interrupt on SPI Complete.
0
Slave
0
1
182
Operates as a master.
Operates as a slave.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
MUX_CRx
1,D8h
20.4.4
MUX_CRx
Analog Mux Port Bit Enables Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
MUX_CR0 : 1,D8h
1,D8h
MUX_CR1 : 1,D9h
7
6
MUX_CR2 : 1,DAh
5
4
MUX_CR3 : 1,DBh
3
2
1
0
RW : 00
Access : POR
ENABLE[7:0]
Bit Name
This register controls the connection between the analog mux bus and the corresponding pin.
Port 3 is a 4-bit port, so the upper 4 bits of the MUX_CR3 register are reserved and returns an undefined value when read.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 82 in the IO Analog Multiplexer chapter.
Bits
Name
Description
7:0
ENABLE[7:0]
Each bit controls the connection between the analog mux bus and the corresponding port pin. For
example, MUX_CR2[3] controls the connection to bit 3 in Port 2. Any number of pins may be connected at the same time. Note that if a discharge clock is selected in the AMUX_CFG register, the
connection to the mux bus will be switched on and off under hardware control.
0
No connection between port pin and analog mux bus.
1
Connect port pin to analog mux bus.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
183
[+] Feedback
IO_CFG
1,DCh
20.4.5
IO_CFG
Input/Output Configuration Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,DCh
IO_CFG : 1,DCh
7
6
5
4
3
2
Access : POR
Bit Name
1
0
RW : 0
RW : 0
REG_EN
IOINT
This register configures the Port 1 output regulator and set the interrupt mode for all GPIO.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section. Always
write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 82 in the GPIO
chapter.
Bits
Name
Description
1
REG_EN
Controls the regulator on Port 1 outputs.
0
Regulator disabled, so Port 1 strong outputs drive to Vdd.
1
Regulator enabled, so Port 1 strong outputs drive to approximately 3V (for Vdd > 3V).
0
IOINT
Sets the GPIO interrupt mode for all pins in the PSoC device. GPIO interrupts are also controlled at
each pin by the PRTxIE registers, and by the global GPIO bit in the INT_MSK0 register.
0
GPIO interrupt configured for interrupt when pin is low.
1
GPIO interrupt configured for interrupt when pin state changes from last time port was read.
184
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
OUT_P1
1,DDh
20.4.6
OUT_P1
Output Override to Port 1 Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,DDh
OUT_P1: 1,DDh
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Access : POR
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
Bit Name
P16D
P16EN
P14D
P14EN
P12D
P12EN
P10D
P10EN
This register enables specific internal signals to be output to Port 1 pins.
Note that the GPIO drive modes must be specified to support the desired output mode (registers PRT1DM1 and PRT1DM0).
If a pin is enabled for output by a bit in this register, the corresponding signal has priority over any other internal function that
may be configured to output to that pin.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 92 in the Digital Clocks chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7
P16D
This bit selects the data output to P1[6] when P16EN is high.
0
Select Timer output (TIMEROUT)
1
Select CLK32
6
P16EN
This bit enables pin P1[6] for output of the signal selected by the P16D bit.
0
No internal signal output to P1[6]
1
Output the signal selected by P16D to P1[6]
5
P14D
This bit selects the data output to P1[4] when P14EN is high.
0
Select Relaxation Oscillator (RO)
1
Select Comparator 1 Output (CMP1)
4
P14EN
This bit enables pin P1[4] for output of the signal selected by the P14D bit.
0
No internal signal output to P1[4]
1
Output the signal selected by P14D to P1[4]
3
P12D
This bit selects the data output to P1[2] when P12EN is high.
0
Select Main System Clock (SYSCLK)
1
Select CapSense output signal (CS). This signal is selected by the CSOUT[1:0] bits in the
CS_CR0 register.
2
P12EN
This bit enables pin P1[2] for output of the signal selected by the P12D bit.
0
No internal signal output to P1[2]
1
Output the signal selected by P12D to P1[2]
1
P10D
This bit selects the data output to P1[0] when P10EN is high.
0
Select Sleep Interrupt (SLPINT)
1
Select Comparator 0 Output (CMP0)
0
P10EN
This bit enables pin P1[0] for output of the signal selected by the P10D bit.
0
No internal signal output to P1[0]
1
Output the signal selected by P10D to P1[0]
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
185
[+] Feedback
OSC_CR0
1,E0h
20.4.7
OSC_CR0
Oscillator Control Register 0
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,E0h
OSC_CR0: 1,E0h
7
Access : POR
Bit Name
6
5
RW : 0
RW : 0
4
RW : 0
3
2
RW : 001b
1
Disable Buzz
No Buzz
Sleep[1:0]
CPU Speed[2:0]
0
This register configures various features of internal clock sources and clock nets.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section. Always
write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 92 in the Digital
Clocks chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
6
Disable Buzz
This bit has lower priority than the No Buzz bit. Therefore if No Buzz = 1, the Disable Buzz bit has no
effect.
0
No effect on buzz modes
1
Buzz is disabled during sleep, with bandgap powered down. No periodic wakeup of the
bandgap during sleep.
5
No Buzz
0
1
4:3
Sleep[1:0]
Sleep Interval
00b
1.95 ms (512 Hz)
01b
15.6 ms (64 Hz)
10b
125 ms (8 Hz)
11b
1 s (1 Hz)
2:0
CPU Speed[2:0]
Bits set the CPU clock speed, based on the system clock (SYSCLK). SYSTOLE is 12 MHz by default,
but it can optionally be set to 6 MHz or be driven from an external clock.
000b
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
186
BUZZ bandgap during power down
Bandgap is always powered even during sleep.
6 MHz IMO
750 kHz
1.5 MHz
3 MHz
6 MHz
375 kHz
187.5 kHz
46.9 kHz
23.4 kHz
12 MHz IMO
1.5 MHz
3 MHz
6 MHz
12 MHz
750 kHz
375 kHz
93.7 kHz
46.8 kHz
External Clock
EXTCLK/8
EXTCLK/4
EXTCLK/2
EXTCLK/1
EXTCLK/16
EXTCLK/32
EXTCLK/128
EXTCLK/256
Reset State
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
OSC_CR2
1,E2h
20.4.8
OSC_CR2
Oscillator Control Register 2
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,E2h
OSC_CR2: 1,E2h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
RW : 0
RW : 0
EXTCLKEN
IMODIS
Access : POR
Bit Name
0
This register configures various features of internal clock sources and clock nets.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 92 in the
Digital Clocks chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
2
EXTCLKEN
External Clock Mode Enable
0
Disabled. Operate from internal main oscillator.
1
Enabled. Operate from clock supplied at P1[4].
1
IMODIS
Internal Oscillator Disable. Set this bit to save power when using an external clock on P1[4].
0
Enabled. Internal oscillator enabled.
1
Disabled.
Note This bit must not be set high in the same instruction that sets EXTCLKEN high, but it
can be set in the next instruction. Also, this bit must not be set high if the external clock frequency is less than 6 MHz.
When switching from external clock to internal clock, enable the IMO for at least 10 μs
before the transition to internal clock. Refer to Switch Operation on page 90.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
187
[+] Feedback
VLT_CR
1,E3h
20.4.9
VLT_CR
Voltage Monitor Control Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,E3h
VLT_CR: 1,E3h
7
6
5
Access : POR
Bit Name
4
3
2
1
RW : 0
RW : 0
RW : 0
PORLEV[1:0]
LVDTBEN
VM[2:0]
0
This register sets the trip points for the POR and LVD.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section. Always
write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 113 in the POR and
LVD chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
5:4
PORLEV[1:0]
These bits set the POR level per the DC electrical specifications in the PSoC device data sheet.
00b
POR level for 2.4 V operation (refer to the PSoC device data sheet)
01b
POR level for 2.7V operation (refer to the PSoC device data sheet)
10b
POR level for 3.0V operation
11b
Reserved
3
LVDTBEN
This bit enables reset of CPU speed register by LVD comparator output.
0
Disables CPU speed throttle-back.
1
Enables CPU speed throttle-back.
2:0
VM[2:0]
These bits set the LVD levels according to the DC electrical specifications in the PSoC device data
sheet, for those PSoC devices with this feature.
000b
Lowest voltage setting
001b
010b
.
011b
.
100b
.
101b
110b
111b
Highest voltage setting
188
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
VLT_CMP
1,E4h
20.4.10
VLT_CMP
Voltage Monitor Comparators Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,E4h
VLT_CMP: 1,E4h
7
6
5
4
Access : POR
Bit Name
1
0
R:0
3
2
R:0
R:0
NoWrite
LVD
PPOR
This register reads the state of internal supply voltage monitors.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section. Always
write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 113 in the POR and
LVD chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
3
NoWrite
This bit reads the state of the Flash write voltage monitor.
0
Sufficient voltage for Flash write.
1
Insufficient voltage for Flash write.
1
LVD
This bit reads state of LVD comparator.
0
Vdd is above LVD trip point.
1
Vdd is below LVD trip point.
0
PPOR
This bit reads state of Precision POR comparator. This is only useful with PPOR reset disabled, with
PORLEV[1:0] in the VLT_CR register set to 11b.
0
Vdd is above PPOR trip voltage.
1
Vdd is below PPOR trip voltage.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
189
[+] Feedback
IMO_TR
1,E8h
20.4.11
IMO_TR
Internal Main Oscillator Trim Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,E8h
IMO_TR: 1,E8h
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
W : 00
Access : POR
Trim[7:0]
Bit Name
This register manually centers the Internal Main Oscillator’s (IMO) output to a target frequency.
It is strongly recommended that the user not alter this register’s values unless Slow IMO mode is used. Do not
change the value in this register.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 58 in the Internal Main Oscillator chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:0
Trim[7:0]
The value of this register is used to trim the Internal Main Oscillator. Its value is set to the best value
for the device during boot.
The value of these bits should not be changed unless Slow IMO mode is used.
00h
Lowest frequency setting
01h
...
...
7Fh
80h
Design center setting
81h
...
...
FEh
FFh
Highest frequency setting
190
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
ILO_TR
1,E9h
20.4.12
ILO_TR
Internal Low Speed Oscillator Trim Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,E9h
ILO_TR: 1,E9h
7
6
5
Access : POR
Bit Name
4
3
2
1
W:0
W:0
Bias Trim[1:0]
Freq Trim[3:0]
0
This register sets the adjustment for the Internal Low Speed Oscillator (ILO).
It is strongly recommended that the user not alter this register’s values. The trim bits are set to factory specifications
and should not be changed.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 59 in the
Internal Low Speed Oscillator chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
5:4
Bias Trim[1:0]
This bit is the device specific, best value during boot.
The value of these bits should not be changed.
00b
Medium bias
01b
Maximum bias (recommended)
10b
Minimum bias
11b
Intermediate Bias *
* About 15% higher than the minimum bias.
3:0
Freq Trim[3:0]
This bit is set to the device specific, best value during boot.
Do not change the these bit values.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
191
[+] Feedback
BDG_TR
1,EAh
20.4.13
BDG_TR
Bandgap Trim Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,EAh
BDG_TR: 1,EAh
7
6
5
4
3
2
Access : POR
RW : 2
RW : 10h
Bit Name
TC[2:0]
V[4:0]
1
0
This register adjusts the bandgap and add an RC filter to Agnd.
It is strongly recommended that the user not alter this register’s values.
For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 106 in the Internal Voltage References chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:5
TC[2:0]
These bits are set to the best value for the device during boot.
Do not change these bit values.
4:0
V[4:0]
These bits are set to the best value for the device during boot.
Do not change these bit values.
192
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
SLP_CFG
1,EBh
20.4.14
SLP_CFG
Sleep Configuration Register
Individual Register Names and Addresses:
1,EBh
SLP_CFG: 1,EBh
7
Access : POR
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RW : 0
PSSDC[1:0]
Bit Name
This register sets the sleep duty cycle.
It is strongly recommended that the user not alter this register’s values. The trim bits are set to factory specifications
and should not be changed.
In the table above, note that reserved bits are grayed table cells and are not described in the bit description section below.
Always write reserved bits with a value of ‘0’. For additional information, refer to the Register Definitions on page 63 in the
Sleep and Watchdog chapter.
Bit
Name
Description
7:6
PSSDC[1:0]
These bits set the sleep duty cycle. They control the ratios (in numbers of 32.768 kHz clock periods)
of “on” time versus “off” time for PORLVD4, bandgap reference.
Do not change these bit values.
00b
01b
10b
11b
1 / 256 (8 ms)
1 / 1024 (31.2 ms)
1 / 64 (2 ms)
1 / 16 (500 ms)
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
193
[+] Feedback
Register Reference
194
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
The Glossary section explains the terminology used in this technical reference manual. Glossary terms are characterized in
bold, italic font throughout the text of this manual.
A
accumulator
In a CPU, a register in which intermediate results are stored. Without an accumulator, it would be
necessary to write the result of each calculation (addition, subtraction, shift, and so on.) to main
memory and read them back. Access to main memory is slower than access to the accumulator,
which usually has direct paths to and from the arithmetic and logic unit (ALU).
active high
1. A logic signal having its asserted state as the logic 1 state.
2. A logic signal having the logic 1 state as the higher voltage of the two states.
active low
1. A logic signal having its asserted state as the logic 0 state.
2. A logic signal having its logic 1 state as the lower voltage of the two states: inverted logic.
address
The label or number identifying the memory location (RAM, ROM, or register) where a unit of
information is stored.
algorithm
A procedure for solving a mathematical problem in a finite number of steps that frequently
involve repetition of an operation.
ambient temperature
The temperature of the air in a designated area, particularly the area surrounding the PSoC
device.
analog
As opposed to digital, signals that are on or off or ‘1’ or ‘0’. Analog signals vary in a continuous
manner. See also analog signals.
analog blocks
The basic programmable opamp circuits. These are SC (switched capacitor) and CT (continuous
time) blocks. These blocks can be interconnected to provide ADCs, DACs, multi-pole filters, gain
stages, and much more.
analog output
An output that is capable of driving any voltage between the supply rails, instead of just a logic 1
or logic 0.
analog signals
A signal represented in a continuous form with respect to continuous times, as contrasted with a
digital signal represented in a discrete (discontinuous) form in a sequence of time.
analog-to-digital (ADC)
A device that changes an analog signal to a digital signal of corresponding magnitude. Typically,
an ADC converts a voltage to a digital number. The digital-to-analog (DAC) converter performs
the reverse operation.
AND
See Boolean Algebra.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
195
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
API (Application Programming Interface)
A series of software routines that comprise an interface between a computer application and
lower-level services and functions (for example, user modules and libraries). APIs serve as
building blocks for programmers that create software applications.
array
An array, also known as a vector or list, is one of the simplest data structures in computer programming. Arrays hold a fixed number of equally-sized data elements, generally of the same
data type. Individual elements are accessed by index using a consecutive range of integers, as
opposed to an associative array. Most high level programming languages have arrays as a builtin data type. Some arrays are multi-dimensional, meaning they are indexed by a fixed number of
integers; for example, by a group of two integers. One- and two-dimensional arrays are the most
common. Also, an array can be a group of capacitors or resistors connected in some common
form.
assembly
A symbolic representation of the machine language of a specific processor. Assembly language
is converted to machine code by an assembler. Usually, each line of assembly code produces
one machine instruction, though the use of macros is common. Assembly languages are considered low level languages; where as C is considered a high level language.
asynchronous
A signal whose data is acknowledged or acted upon immediately, irrespective of any clock signal.
attenuation
The decrease in intensity of a signal as a result of absorption of energy and of scattering out of
the path to the detector, but not including the reduction due to geometric spreading. Attenuation
is usually expressed in dB.
B
bandgap reference
A stable voltage reference design that matches the positive temperature coefficient of VT with
the negative temperature coefficient of VBE, to produce a zero temperature coefficient (ideally)
reference.
bandwidth
1. The frequency range of a message or information processing system measured in hertz.
2. The width of the spectral region over which an amplifier (or absorber) has substantial gain (or
loss). It is sometimes represented more specifically as, for example, full width at half maximum.
bias
1. A systematic deviation of a value from a reference value.
2. The amount by which the average of a set of values departs from a reference value.
3. The electrical, mechanical, magnetic, or other force (field) applied to a device to establish a
reference level to operate the device.
bias current
The constant low level DC current that is used to produce a stable operation in amplifiers. This
current can sometimes be changed to alter the bandwidth of an amplifier.
binary
The name for the base 2 numbering system. The most common numbering system is the base
10 numbering system. The base of a numbering system indicates the number of values that may
exist for a particular positioning within a number for that system. For example, in base 2, binary,
each position may have one of two values (0 or 1). In the base 10, decimal, each position may
have one of ten values (0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, and 9).
bit
A single digit of a binary number. Therefore, a bit may only have a value of ‘0’ or ‘1’. A group of 8
bits is called a byte. Because the PSoC's M8C is an 8-bit microcontroller, the PSoC's native data
chunk size is a byte.
196
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
bit rate (BR)
The number of bits occurring per unit of time in a bit stream, usually expressed in bits per second
(bps).
block
1. A functional unit that performs a single function, such as an oscillator.
2. A functional unit that may be configured to perform one of several functions, such as a digital
PSoC block or an analog PSoC block.
Boolean Algebra
In mathematics and computer science, Boolean algebras or Boolean lattices, are algebraic
structures which “capture the essence” of the logical operations AND, OR and NOT as well as
set the theoretic operations union, intersection, and complement. Boolean algebra also defines a
set of theorems that describe how Boolean equations can be manipulated. For example, these
theorems are used to simplify Boolean equations which will reduce the number of logic elements
needed to implement the equation.
The operators of Boolean algebra may be represented in various ways. Often they are simply
written as AND, OR, and NOT. In describing circuits, NAND (NOT AND), NOR (NOT OR), XNOR
(exclusive NOT OR), and XOR (exclusive OR) may also be used. Mathematicians often use +
(for example, A+B) for OR and for AND (for example, A*B) (since in some ways those operations are analogous to addition and multiplication in other algebraic structures) and represent
NOT by a line drawn above the expression being negated (for example, ~A, A_, !A).
break-before-make
The elements involved go through a disconnected state entering (‘break”) before the new connected state (“make”).
broadcast net
A signal that is routed throughout the microcontroller and is accessible by many blocks or systems.
buffer
1. A storage area for data that is used to compensate for a speed difference, when transferring
data from one device to another. Usually refers to an area reserved for IO operations into
which data is read or from which data is written.
2. A portion of memory set aside to store data, often before it is sent to an external device or as
it is received from an external device.
3. An amplifier used to lower the output impedance of a system.
bus
1. A named connection of nets. Bundling nets together in a bus makes it easier to route nets
with similar routing patterns.
2. A set of signals performing a common function and carrying similar data. Typically represented using vector notation; for example, address[7:0].
3. One or more conductors that serve as a common connection for a group of related devices.
byte
A digital storage unit consisting of 8 bits.
C
C
A high level programming language.
capacitance
A measure of the ability of two adjacent conductors, separated by an insulator, to hold a charge
when a voltage differential is applied between them. Capacitance is measured in units of Farads.
capture
To extract information automatically through the use of software or hardware, as opposed to
hand-entering of data into a computer file.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
197
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
chaining
Connecting two or more 8-bit digital blocks to form 16-, 24-, and even 32-bit functions. Chaining
allows certain signals such as Compare, Carry, Enable, Capture, and Gate to be produced from
one block to another.
checksum
The checksum of a set of data is generated by adding the value of each data word to a sum. The
actual checksum can simply be the result sum or a value that must be added to the sum to generate a pre-determined value.
chip
A single monolithic Integrated Circuit (IC). See also integrated circuit (IC).
clear
To force a bit/register to a value of logic 0.
clock
The device that generates a periodic signal with a fixed frequency and duty cycle. A clock is
sometimes used to synchronize different logic blocks.
clock generator
A circuit that is used to generate a clock signal.
CMOS
The logic gates constructed using MOS transistors connected in a complementary manner.
CMOS is an acronym for complementary metal-oxide semiconductor.
comparator
An electronic circuit that produces an output voltage or current whenever two input levels simultaneously satisfy predetermined amplitude requirements.
compiler
A program that translates a high level language, such as C, into machine language.
configuration
In a computer system, an arrangement of functional units according to their nature, number, and
chief characteristics. Configuration pertains to hardware, software, firmware, and documentation. The configuration will affect system performance.
configuration space
In PSoC devices, the register space accessed when the XIO bit, in the CPU_F register, is set to
‘1’.
crowbar
A type of over-voltage protection that rapidly places a low resistance shunt (typically an SCR)
from the signal to one of the power supply rails, when the output voltage exceeds a predetermined value.
crystal oscillator
An oscillator in which the frequency is controlled by a piezoelectric crystal. Typically a piezoelectric crystal is less sensitive to ambient temperature than other circuit components.
cyclic redundancy
check (CRC)
A calculation used to detect errors in data communications, typically performed using a linear
feedback shift register. Similar calculations may be used for a variety of other purposes such as
data compression.
D
data bus
A bi-directional set of signals used by a computer to convey information from a memory location
to the central processing unit and vice versa. More generally, a set of signals used to convey
data between digital functions.
data stream
A sequence of digitally encoded signals used to represent information in transmission.
data transmission
The sending of data from one place to another by means of signals over a channel.
198
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
debugger
A hardware and software system that allows the user to analyze the operation of the system
under development. A debugger usually allows the developer to step through the firmware one
step at a time, set break points, and analyze memory.
dead band
A period of time when neither of two or more signals are in their active state or in transition.
decimal
A base-10 numbering system, which uses the symbols 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8 and 9 (called digits)
together with the decimal point and the sign symbols + (plus) and - (minus) to represent numbers.
default value
Pertaining to the pre-defined initial, original, or specific setting, condition, value, or action a system will assume, use, or take in the absence of instructions from the user.
device
The device referred to in this manual is the PSoC chip, unless otherwise specified.
die
An unpackaged integrated circuit (IC), normally cut from a wafer.
digital
A signal or function, the amplitude of which is characterized by one of two discrete values: ‘0’ or
‘1’.
digital blocks
The 8-bit logic blocks that can act as a counter, timer, serial receiver, serial transmitter, CRC
generator, pseudo-random number generator, or SPI.
digital logic
A methodology for dealing with expressions containing two-state variables that describe the
behavior of a circuit or system.
digital-to-analog (DAC)
A device that changes a digital signal to an analog signal of corresponding magnitude. The analog-to-digital (ADC) converter performs the reverse operation.
direct access
The capability to obtain data from a storage device, or to enter data into a storage device, in a
sequence independent of their relative positions by means of addresses that indicate the physical location of the data.
duty cycle
The relationship of a clock period high time to its low time, expressed as a percent.
E
emulator
Duplicates (provides an emulation of) the functions of one system with a different system, so that
the second system appears to behave like the first system.
External Reset (XRES)
An active high signal that is driven into the PSoC device. It causes all operation of the CPU and
blocks to stop and return to a pre-defined state.
F
falling edge
A transition from a logic 1 to a logic 0. Also known as a negative edge.
feedback
The return of a portion of the output, or processed portion of the output, of a (usually active)
device to the input.
filter
A device or process by which certain frequency components of a signal are attenuated.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
199
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
firmware
The software that is embedded in a hardware device and executed by the CPU. The software
may be executed by the end user but it may not be modified.
flag
Any of various types of indicators used for identification of a condition or event (for example, a
character that signals the termination of a transmission).
Flash
An electrically programmable and erasable, non-volatile technology that provides users with the
programmability and data storage of EPROMs, plus in-system erasability. Non-volatile means
that the data is retained when power is off.
Flash bank
A group of Flash ROM blocks where Flash block numbers always begin with ‘0’ in an individual
Flash bank. A Flash bank also has its own block level protection information.
Flash block
The smallest amount of Flash ROM space that may be programmed at one time and the smallest amount of Flash space that may be protected. A Flash block holds 64 bytes.
flip-flop
A device having two stable states and two input terminals (or types of input signals) each of
which corresponds with one of the two states. The circuit remains in either state until it is made
to change to the other state by application of the corresponding signal.
frequency
The number of cycles or events per unit of time, for a periodic function.
G
gain
The ratio of output current, voltage, or power to input current, voltage, or power, respectively.
Gain is usually expressed in dB.
ground
1.
2.
3.
4.
The electrical neutral line having the same potential as the surrounding earth.
The negative side of DC power supply.
The reference point for an electrical system.
The conducting paths between an electric circuit or equipment and the earth, or some conducting body serving in place of the earth.
H
hardware
A comprehensive term for all of the physical parts of a computer or embedded system, as distinguished from the data it contains or operates on, and the software that provides instructions for
the hardware to accomplish tasks.
hardware reset
A reset that is caused by a circuit, such as a POR, watchdog reset, or external reset. A hardware
reset restores the state of the device as it was when it was first powered up. Therefore, all registers are set to the POR value as indicated in register tables throughout this manual.
200
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
hexadecimal
A base 16 numeral system (often abbreviated and called hex), usually written using the symbols
0-9 and A-F. It is a useful system in computers because there is an easy mapping from four bits
to a single hex digit. Thus, one can represent every byte as two consecutive hexadecimal digits.
Compare the binary, hex, and decimal representations:
bin
0000b
0001b
0010b
...
1001b
1010b
1011b
...
1111b
=
=
=
=
hex
0x0
0x1
0x2
=
=
=
=
dec
0
1
2
=
=
=
0x9
0xA
0xB
=
=
=
9
10
11
=
0xF
=
15
So the decimal numeral 79 whose binary representation is 0100 1111b can be written as 4Fh in
hexadecimal (0x4F).
high time
The amount of time the signal has a value of ‘1’ in one period, for a periodic digital signal.
I
I2C
A two-wire serial computer bus by Philips Semiconductors. I2C is an inter-integrated circuit. It is
used to connect low-speed peripherals in an embedded system. The original system was created in the early 1980s as a battery control interface, but it was later used as a simple internal
bus system for building control electronics. I2C uses only two bi-directional pins, clock and data,
both running at +5V and pulled high with resistors. The bus operates at 100 kbits/second in standard mode and 400 kbits/second in fast mode. I2C™ is a trademark of the Philips Semiconductors.
ICE
The in-circuit emulator that allows users to test the project in a hardware environment, while
viewing the debugging device activity in a software environment (PSoC Designer).
idle state
A condition that exists whenever user messages are not being transmitted, but the service is
immediately available for use.
impedance
1. The resistance to the flow of current caused by resistive, capacitive, or inductive devices in a
circuit.
2. The total passive opposition offered to the flow of electric current. Note the impedance is
determined by the particular combination of resistance, inductive reactance, and capacitive
reactance in a given circuit.
input
A point that accepts data in a device, process, or channel.
input/output (IO)
A device that introduces data into or extracts data from a system.
instruction
An expression that specifies one operation and identifies its operands, if any, in a programming
language such as C or assembly.
integrated circuit (IC)
A device in which components such as resistors, capacitors, diodes, and transistors are formed
on the surface of a single piece of semiconductor.
interface
The means by which two systems or devices are connected and interact with each other.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
201
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
interrupt
A suspension of a process, such as the execution of a computer program, caused by an event
external to that process and performed in such a way that the process can be resumed.
interrupt service routine (ISR)
A block of code that normal code execution is diverted to when the M8C receives a hardware
interrupt. Many interrupt sources may each exist with its own priority and individual ISR code
block. Each ISR code block ends with the RETI instruction, returning the device to the point in
the program where it left normal program execution.
J
jitter
1. A misplacement of the timing of a transition from its ideal position. A typical form of corruption
that occurs on serial data streams.
2. The abrupt and unwanted variations of one or more signal characteristics, such as the interval between successive pulses, the amplitude of successive cycles, or the frequency or
phase of successive cycles.
K
keeper
A circuit that holds a signal to the last driven value, even when the signal becomes un-driven.
L
latency
The time or delay that it takes for a signal to pass through a given circuit or network.
least significant bit
(LSb)
The binary digit, or bit, in a binary number that represents the least significant value (typically the
right-hand bit). The bit versus byte distinction is made by using a lower case “b” for bit in LSb.
least significant byte
(LSB)
The byte in a multi-byte word that represents the least significant value (typically the right-hand
byte). The byte versus bit distinction is made by using an upper case “B” for byte in LSB.
Linear Feedback Shift
Register (LFSR)
A shift register whose data input is generated as an XOR of two or more elements in the register
chain.
load
The electrical demand of a process expressed as power (watts), current (amps), or resistance
(ohms).
logic function
A mathematical function that performs a digital operation on digital data and returns a digital
value.
look-up table (LUT)
A logic block that implements several logic functions. The logic function is selected by means of
select lines and is applied to the inputs of the block. For example: A 2 input LUT with 4 select
lines can be used to perform any one of 16 logic functions on the two inputs resulting in a single
logic output. The LUT is a combinational device; therefore, the input/output relationship is continuous, that is, not sampled.
low time
The amount of time the signal has a value of ‘0’ in one period, for a periodic digital signal.
low voltage detect
(LVD)
A circuit that senses Vdd and provides an interrupt to the system when Vdd falls below a
selected threshold.
202
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
M
M8C
An 8-bit Harvard Architecture microprocessor. The microprocessor coordinates all activity inside
a PSoC by interfacing to the Flash, SRAM, and register space.
macro
A programming language macro is an abstraction whereby a certain textual pattern is replaced
according to a defined set of rules. The interpreter or compiler automatically replaces the macro
instance with the macro contents when an instance of the macro is encountered. Therefore, if a
macro is used 5 times and the macro definition required 10 bytes of code space, 50 bytes of
code space will be needed in total.
mask
1. To obscure, hide, or otherwise prevent information from being derived from a signal. It is usually the result of interaction with another signal, such as noise, static, jamming, or other forms
of interference.
2. A pattern of bits that can be used to retain or suppress segments of another pattern of bits in
computing and data processing systems.
master device
A device that controls the timing for data exchanges between two devices. Or when devices are
cascaded in width, the master device is the one that controls the timing for data exchanges
between the cascaded devices and an external interface. The controlled device is called the
slave device.
microcontroller
An integrated circuit chip that is designed primarily for control systems and products. In addition
to a CPU, a microcontroller typically includes memory, timing circuits, and IO circuitry. The reason for this is to permit the realization of a controller with a minimal quantity of chips, thus
achieving maximal possible miniaturization. This, in turn, will reduce the volume and the cost of
the controller. The microcontroller is normally not used for general-purpose computation as is a
microprocessor.
mixed signal
The reference to a circuit containing both analog and digital techniques and components.
mnemonic
1. A tool intended to assist the memory. Mnemonics rely on not only repetition to remember
facts, but also on creating associations between easy-to-remember constructs and lists of
data.
2. A two to four character string representing a microprocessor instruction.
mode
A distinct method of operation for software or hardware. For example, the Digital PSoC block
may be in either counter mode or timer mode.
modulation
A range of techniques for encoding information on a carrier signal, typically a sine-wave signal. A
device that performs modulation is known as a modulator.
Modulator
A device that imposes a signal on a carrier.
MOS
An acronym for metal-oxide semiconductor.
most significant bit
(MSb)
The binary digit, or bit, in a binary number that represents the most significant value (typically the
left-hand bit). The bit versus byte distinction is made by using a lower case “b” for bit in MSb.
most significant byte
(MSB)
The byte in a multi-byte word that represents the most significant value (typically the left-hand
byte). The byte versus bit distinction is made by using an upper case “B” for byte in MSB.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
203
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
multiplexer (mux)
1. A logic function that uses a binary value, or address, to select between a number of inputs
and conveys the data from the selected input to the output.
2. A technique which allows different input (or output) signals to use the same lines at different
times, controlled by an external signal. Multiplexing is used to save on wiring and IO ports.
N
NAND
See Boolean Algebra.
negative edge
A transition from a logic 1 to a logic 0. Also known as a falling edge.
net
The routing between devices.
nibble
A group of four bits, which is one-half of a byte.
noise
1. A disturbance that affects a signal and that may distort the information carried by the signal.
2. The random variations of one or more characteristics of any entity such as voltage, current,
or data.
NOR
See Boolean Algebra.
NOT
See Boolean Algebra.
O
OR
See Boolean Algebra.
oscillator
A circuit that may be crystal controlled and is used to generate a clock frequency.
output
The electrical signal or signals which are produced by an analog or digital block.
P
parallel
The means of communication in which digital data is sent multiple bits at a time, with each simultaneous bit being sent over a separate line.
parameter
Characteristics for a given block that have either been characterized or may be defined by the
designer.
parameter block
A location in memory where parameters for the SSC instruction are placed prior to execution.
parity
A technique for testing transmitting data. Typically, a binary digit is added to the data to make the
sum of all the digits of the binary data either always even (even parity) or always odd (odd parity).
path
1. The logical sequence of instructions executed by a computer.
2. The flow of an electrical signal through a circuit.
pending interrupts
An interrupt that has been triggered but has not been serviced, either because the processor is
busy servicing another interrupt or global interrupts are disabled.
204
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
phase
The relationship between two signals, usually the same frequency, that determines the delay
between them. This delay between signals is either measured by time or angle (degrees).
Phase-Locked Loop
(PLL)
An electronic circuit that controls an oscillator so that it maintains a constant phase angle relative to a reference signal.
pin
A terminal on a hardware component. Also called lead.
pinouts
The pin number assignment: the relation between the logical inputs and outputs of the PSoC
device and their physical counterparts in the printed circuit board (PCB) package. Pinouts will
involve pin numbers as a link between schematic and PCB design (both being computer generated files) and may also involve pin names.
port
A group of pins, usually eight.
positive edge
A transition from a logic 0 to a logic 1. Also known as a rising edge.
posted interrupts
An interrupt that has been detected by the hardware but may or may not be enabled by its mask
bit. Posted interrupts that are not masked become pending interrupts.
Power On Reset (POR)
A circuit that forces the PSoC device to reset when the voltage is below a pre-set level. This is
one type of hardware reset.
program counter
The instruction pointer (also called the program counter) is a register in a computer processor
that indicates where in memory the CPU is executing instructions. Depending on the details of
the particular machine, it holds either the address of the instruction being executed or the
address of the next instruction to be executed.
protocol
A set of rules. Particularly the rules that govern networked communications.
PSoC
Cypress Semiconductor’s Programmable System-on-Chip (PSoC) mixed-signal array. PSoC®
and Programmable System-on-Chip™ are trademarks of Cypress.
PSoC blocks
See analog blocks and digital blocks.
PSoC Designer
The software for Cypress’ Programmable System-on-Chip™ technology.
pulse
A rapid change in some characteristic of a signal (for example, phase or frequency) from a baseline value to a higher or lower value, followed by a rapid return to the baseline value.
pulse width modulator
(PWM)
An output in the form of duty cycle which varies as a function of the applied measurand.
R
RAM
An acronym for random access memory. A data-storage device from which data can be read out
and new data can be written in.
register
A storage device with a specific capacity, such as a bit or byte.
reset
A means of bringing a system back to a know state. See hardware reset and software reset.
resistance
The resistance to the flow of electric current measured in ohms for a conductor.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
205
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
revision ID
A unique identifier of the PSoC device.
ripple divider
An asynchronous ripple counter constructed of flip-flops. The clock is fed to the first stage of the
counter. An n-bit binary counter consisting of n flip-flops that can count in binary from 0 to 2n - 1.
rising edge
See positive edge.
ROM
An acronym for read only memory. A data-storage device from which data can be read out, but
new data cannot be written in.
routine
A block of code, called by another block of code, that may have some general or frequent use.
routing
Physically connecting objects in a design according to design rules set in the reference library.
runt pulses
In digital circuits, narrow pulses that, due to non-zero rise and fall times of the signal, do not
reach a valid high or low level. For example, a runt pulse may occur when switching between
asynchronous clocks or as the result of a race condition in which a signal takes two separate
paths through a circuit. These race conditions may have different delays and are then recombined to form a glitch or when the output of a flip-flop becomes metastable.
S
sampling
The process of converting an analog signal into a series of digital values or reversed.
schematic
A diagram, drawing, or sketch that details the elements of a system, such as the elements of an
electrical circuit or the elements of a logic diagram for a computer.
seed value
An initial value loaded into a linear feedback shift register or random number generator.
serial
1. Pertaining to a process in which all events occur one after the other.
2. Pertaining to the sequential or consecutive occurrence of two or more related activities in a
single device or channel.
set
To force a bit/register to a value of logic 1.
settling time
The time it takes for an output signal or value to stabilize after the input has changed from one
value to another.
shift
The movement of each bit in a word, one position to either the left or right. For example, if the
hex value 0x24 is shifted one place to the left, it becomes 0x48. If the hex value 0x24 is shifted
one place to the right, it becomes 0x12.
shift register
A memory storage device that sequentially shifts a word either left or right to output a stream of
serial data.
sign bit
The most significant binary digit, or bit, of a signed binary number. If set to a logic 1, this bit represents a negative quantity.
signal
A detectable transmitted energy that can be used to carry information. As applied to electronics,
any transmitted electrical impulse.
silicon ID
A unique identifier of the PSoC silicon.
206
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
skew
The difference in arrival time of bits transmitted at the same time, in parallel transmission.
slave device
A device that allows another device to control the timing for data exchanges between two
devices. Or when devices are cascaded in width, the slave device is the one that allows another
device to control the timing of data exchanges between the cascaded devices and an external
interface. The controlling device is called the master device.
software
A set of computer programs, procedures, and associated documentation concerned with the
operation of a data processing system (for example, compilers, library routines, manuals, and
circuit diagrams). Software is often written first as source code and then converted to a binary
format that is specific to the device on which the code will be executed.
software reset
A partial reset executed by software to bring part of the system back to a known state. A software reset will restore the M8C to a know state but not PSoC blocks, systems, peripherals, or
registers. For a software reset, the CPU registers (CPU_A, CPU_F, CPU_PC, CPU_SP, and
CPU_X) are set to 0x00. Therefore, code execution will begin at Flash address 0x0000.
SRAM
An acronym for static random access memory. A memory device allowing users to store and
retrieve data at a high rate of speed. The term static is used because, once a value has been
loaded into an SRAM cell, it will remain unchanged until it is explicitly altered or until power is
removed from the device.
SROM
An acronym for supervisory read only memory. The SROM holds code that is used to boot the
device, calibrate circuitry, and perform Flash operations. The functions of the SROM may be
accessed in normal user code, operating from Flash.
stack
A stack is a data structure that works on the principle of Last In First Out (LIFO). This means that
the last item put on the stack is the first item that can be taken off.
stack pointer
A stack may be represented in a computer’s inside blocks of memory cells, with the bottom at a
fixed location and a variable stack pointer to the current top cell.
state machine
The actual implementation (in hardware or software) of a function that can be considered to consist of a set of states through which it sequences.
sticky
A bit in a register that maintains its value past the time of the event that caused its transition has
passed.
stop bit
A signal following a character or block that prepares the receiving device to receive the next
character or block.
switching
The controlling or routing of signals in circuits to execute logical or arithmetic operations, or to
transmit data between specific points in a network.
Switch phasing
The clock that controls a given switch, PHI1 or PHI2, in respect to the switch capacitor (SC)
blocks. The PSoC SC blocks have two groups of switches. One group of these switches is normally closed during PHI1 and open during PHI2. The other group is open during PHI1 and
closed during PHI2. These switches can be controlled in the normal operation, or in reverse
mode if the PHI1 and PHI2 clocks are reversed.
synchronous
1. A signal whose data is not acknowledged or acted upon until the next active edge of a clock
signal.
2. A system whose operation is synchronized by a clock signal.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
207
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
T
tap
The connection between two blocks of a device created by connecting several blocks/components in a series, such as a shift register or resistive voltage divider.
terminal count
The state at which a counter is counted down to zero.
threshold
The minimum value of a signal that can be detected by the system or sensor under consideration.
transistors
The transistor is a solid-state semiconductor device used for amplification and switching, and
has three terminals. A small current or voltage applied to one terminal controls the current
through the other two. It is the key component in all modern electronics. In digital circuits, transistors are used as very fast electrical switches, and arrangements of transistors can function as
logic gates, RAM-type memory, and other devices. In analog circuits, transistors are essentially
used as amplifiers.
tri-state
A function whose output can adopt three states: 0, 1, and Z (high-impedance). The function does
not drive any value in the Z state and, in many respects, may be considered to be disconnected
from the rest of the circuit, allowing another output to drive the same net.
U
UART
A UART or universal asynchronous receiver-transmitter translates between parallel bits of data
and serial bits.
user
The person using the PSoC device and reading this manual.
user modules
Pre-build, pre-tested hardware/firmware peripheral functions that take care of managing and
configuring the lower level analog and digital PSoC blocks. User modules also provide high level
API (Application Programming Interface) for the peripheral function.
user space
The bank 0 space of the register map. The registers in this bank are more likely to be modified
during normal program execution and not just during initialization. Registers in bank 1 are most
likely to be modified only during the initialization phase of the program.
V
Vdd
A name for a power net meaning “voltage drain.” The most positive power supply signal. Usually
5 or 3.3 volts.
volatile
Not guaranteed to stay the same value or level when not in scope.
Vss
A name for a power net meaning “voltage source.” The most negative power supply signal.
208
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
W
watchdog timer
A timer that must be serviced periodically. If it is not serviced, the CPU will reset after a specified
period of time.
waveform
The representation of a signal as a plot of amplitude versus time.
X
XOR
See Boolean Algebra.
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
209
[+] Feedback
Section F: Glossary
210
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Index
#
16-Pin Part Pinout 19
24-pin part pinout 20
32 kHz clock selection 59
32-pin part pinout 21
48-pin OCD part pinout 22
A
ACK bit 168
acronyms 18
Address bits in I2C 168
address spaces, CPU core 25
AMUX_CFG register 82, 143
Analog bit
in INT_CLR0 register 171
in INT_MSK0 register 172
analog input, GPIO 52
architecture
CapSense system 69
PSoC core 23
system resources 87
top level 14
B
bank 0 registers 138
register mapping table 134
bank 1 registers 180
register mapping table 135
basic paging in RAM paging 31
BDG_TR register 106, 192
Bias Trim bits in ILO_TR register 191
Bus Error bit 168
Bypass bit 182
Byte Complete bit 168
C
Calibrate0 function in SROM 41
Calibrate1 function in SROM 42
capacitive sensing in IO analog multiplexer 81
CapSense bit in INT_MSK0 register 172
CapSense counter 72
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
CapSense module
architecture 71
counter 72
register definitions 74
timing diagram 79
types of approaches 71
CapSense system
architecture 69
overview 14, 69
register summary 70
Carry bit 176
CDSx bits 147
CHAIN bit 151
Checksum function in SROM 41
CLKSEL bits 151
Clock Phase bit 142
Clock Polarity bit 142
Clock Rate bits 167
Clock Sel bit 182
clock, external digital
switch operation 90
clocking
in SROM 42
clocks digital, See digital clocks
CMP_CR0 register 85, 146
CMP_CR1 register 86, 147
CMP_LUT register 86, 149
CMP_MUX register 85, 145
CMP_RDC register 84, 144
CMP0D bit 144
CMP0L bit 144
CMP1D bit 144
CMP1L bit 144
CMPx Range bits 146
CMPxEN bits 146
COHM bit 156
COHS bit 156
COLM bit 156
COLS bit 156
comparators
architecture 83
register definitions 84
configuration register in SPI 120
control register in SPI 119
conventions, documentation
acronyms 18
numeric naming 17
register conventions 17, 133, 137
units of measure 17
211
[+] Feedback
Index
core, See PSoC core
CPINx bits 147
CPU core
address spaces 25
instruction formats 28
instruction set summary 26–27
internal M8C registers 25
overview 25
register definitions 30
CPU Speed bits 186
CPU_F register 30, 176
CPU_SCR0 register 109, 179
CPU_SCR1 register 108, 178
CRSTx bits 147
CS_CNTH register 76, 155
CS_CNTL register 76, 154
CS_CR0 register 74, 150
CS_CR1 register 75, 151
CS_CR2 register 75, 152
CS_CR3 register 76, 153
CS_SLEW register 78, 158
CS_STAT register 77, 156
CS_TIMER register 77, 157
CSOUT bits 150
CUR_PP register 34, 162
current page pointer in RAM paging 32
Enable bits
in I2C_CFG register 167
in MUX_CRx registers 183
in SPI_CR register 142
ENSWINT bit 49, 173
EraseAll function in SROM 41
EraseBlock function in SROM 40
erasing
a block in Flash 40
user data in Flash 41
EXTCLKEN bit 187
external digital clock 90
external reset 110
F
FastSlew bits 158
Flash
checksum 41
clocking strategy 42
erasing a block 40
erasing user data 41
memory organization 39
protection 40
storing data 40
tables 41
Freq Trim bits for ILO_TR 191
FS_EN bit 158
D
Data bits
in CS_CNTH register 155
in CS_CNTL register 154
in I2C_DR register 169
in PRTxDR register 138
in PT_DATA0 register 161
in PT_DATA1 register 160
in SPI_RXR register 141
in SPI_TXR register 140
data bypass in GPIO 54
data registers in SPI 117
development kits 16
digital clocks
architecture 89
external clock 90
in internal low speed oscillator 89
internal main oscillator 89
register definitions 92
system clocking signals 89
digital IO, GPIO 52
documentation
conventions 17
history 16
overview 13
Drive Mode 0 bits 180
Drive Mode 1 bits 181
G
general purpose IO
analog and digital input 52
architecture 51
block interrupts 52
data bypass 54
digital IO 52
drive modes 56
interrupt modes 54
port 1 distinctions 52
register definitions 55
GIE bit 176
GIES bit 179
GPIO bit
in INT_CLR0 register 170
in INT_MSK0 register 172
GPIO block interrupts 52
GPIO, See general purpose IO
H
help, getting
development kits 16
support 16
upgrades 16
E
EN bit 150
212
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Index
I
I2C bit
in INT_CLR0 register 170
in INT_MSK0 register 172
I2C slave
application overview 96
architecture 95
basic data transfer 96
basic IO timing 102
clock generation timing 101
operation 96
register definitions 98
stall timing 103
status timing 102
I2C_CFG register 98, 167
I2C_DR register 101, 169
I2C_SCR register 99, 168
IBOOST bit 153
ICAPEN bit 143
IDAC_D register 78, 177
IDACDATA bits 177
IDACEN bit 152
IDX_PP register 35, 164
ILO, See internal low speed oscillator
ILO_TR register 59, 191
IMO, See internal main oscillator
IMO_TR register 58, 190
IMODIS bit 187
in internal main oscillator
in digital clocks 89
index memory page pointer in RAM paging 33
INM bit 156
INNx bits 145
INPx bits 145
INS bit 156
INSEL bit 151
instruction formats
1-byte instructions 28
2-byte instructions 28
3-byte instructions 29
instruction set summary 26–27
Int Sel bit 182
INT_CLR0 register 48, 170
INT_MSK0 register 49, 172
INT_SW_EN register 49, 173
INT_VC register 50, 174
INTCAP bits 143
internal low speed oscillator
32 kHz clock selection 59
architecture 59
in digital clocks 89
register definitions 59
internal M8C registers 25
internal main oscillator
architecture 57
engaging slow IMO 57
register definitions 58
trimming the IMO 57
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
internal voltage references
architecture 105
register definitions 106
interrupt controller
application overview 47
architecture 45
interrupt table 47
latency and priority 46
posted vs pending interrupts 46
register definitions 48
Interrupt Enables bits 139
interrupt modes in GPIO 54
interrupt table 47
interrupts in RAM paging 32
INV bit 151
IO analog multiplexer
application overview 81
architecture 81
capacitive sensing 81
register definitions 82
IO_CFG register 56, 184
IRAMDIS bit 178
IRANGE bit 152
IRESS bit 178
L
low voltage detect (LVD)
See POR and LVD
LPF_EN bit 153
LPFilt bit 153
LRB bit 168
LSb First bit 142
LUTx bits 149
LVD bit 189
LVDTBEN bits 188
M
M8C, See CPU core
mapping tables, registers 133
master function for SPI 116
measurement units 17
MODE bits 150
MUX_CRx register 82, 183
MVI instructions in RAM paging 32
MVR_PP register 35, 165
MVW_PP register 36, 166
N
No Buzz bit 186
NoWrite bit 189
numeric naming conventions 17
213
[+] Feedback
Index
O
One Shot bit 159
OSC_CR0 register 93, 186
OSC_CR2 register 94, 187
OUT_P1 register 92, 185
Overrun bit 142
overviews
CapSense system 69
Document 13
PSoC core 23
register tables 133
system resources 87
PRTxDM1 register 56, 181
PRTxDR register 55, 138
PRTxIE register 55, 139
PSelect bit 167
PSoC core
architecture 23
overview 14
register summary 24
See also CPU core
PSSDC bits 193
PT_CFG register 131, 159
PT_DATA0 register 131, 161
PT_DATA1 register 131, 160
PXD_EN bit 152
P
P10D bit 185
P10EN bit 185
P12D bit 185
P12EN bit 185
P14D bit 185
P14EN bit 185
P16D bit 185
P16EN bit 185
Page bits
in CUR_PP register 162
in IDX_PP register 164
in MVR_PP register 165
in MVW_PP register 166
in STK_PP register 163
Pending Interrupt bits 174
PgMode bits 176
pin behavior during reset 107
pin information, See pinouts
pinouts
16-pin part 19
24-pin part 20
32-pin part 21
48-pin OCD part 22
POR and LVD
architecture 113
register definitions 113
PORLEV bits 188
PORS bit 179
power modes
sleep and watchdog 67
system resets 112
power on reset (POR)
See POR and LVD
power on reset in system resets 110
PPM bit 156
PPOR bit 189
PPS bit 156
product upgrades 16
programmable timer
architecture 129
register definitions 131
ProtectBlock function in SROM 40
protocol function for SPI 115
PRTxDM0 register 56, 180
214
R
RAM paging
architecture 31
basic paging 31
current page pointer 32
index memory page pointer 33
interrupts 32
MVI instructions 32
register definitions 34
stack operations 32
ReadBlock function in SROM 39
REF_EN bit 153
reference of all registers 137
REFMODE bit 153
REFMUX bit 153
register conventions 17, 137
register definitions
CapSense module 74
comparators 84
CPU core 30
digital clocks 92
general purpose IO 55
I2C slave 98
internal low speed oscillator 59
internal main oscillator 58
internal voltage references 106
interrupt controller 48
IO analog multiplexer 82
POR and LVD 113
programmable timer 131
RAM paging 34
sleep and watchdog 63
SPI 117
supervisory ROM 42
system resets 108
register mapping tables
bank 0 registers 134
bank 1 registers 135
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback
Index
registers
bank 0 registers 138
bank 1 registers 180
CapSense register summary 70
core register summary 24
internal M8C registers 25
maneuvering around 137
mapping tables 133
reference of all registers 137
system resources register summary 88
RES_WDT register 63, 175
RLOCLK bit 151
RO_EN bit 152
RX Reg Full bit 142
S
serial peripheral interconnect, See SPI
Slave bit 182
slave function for SPI 116
slave operation, I2C 96
sleep and watchdog
application overview 62
architecture 61
bandgap refresh 66
power modes 67
register definitions 63
sleep sequence 64
sleep timer 61
timing diagrams 64
wake up sequence 65
watchdog timer 66
Sleep bits
in CPU_SCR0 register 179
in INT_CLR0 register 170
in INT_MSK0 register 172
sleep timer 61
SLIMO bit 178
slow IMO 57
SLP_CFG register 63, 193
SPI
architecture 115
configuration register 120
control register 119
data registers 117
master data register definitions 118
master function 116
protocol function 115
register definitions 117
slave data register definitions 118
slave function 116
timing diagrams 121
SPI bit
in INT_CLR0 register 170
in INT_MSK0 register 172
SPI Complete bit 142
SPI_CFG register 120, 182
SPI_CR register 119, 142
SPI_RXR register 117, 141
SPI_TXR register 117, 140
SRAM, See RAM paging
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
SROM, See supervisory ROM
SS_ bit 182
SS_EN_ bit 182
stack operations in RAM paging 32
START bit 159
start, how to 16
STK_PP register 34, 163
STOP bit 179
Stop IE bit 167
Stop Status bit 168
storing data in Flash 40
summary of registers
CapSense system 70
mapping tables 133
PSoC core 24
system resources 88
supervisory ROM
architecture 37
Calibrate0 function 41
Calibrate1 function 42
Checksum function 41
clocking 42
EraseAll function 41
EraseBlock function 40
function descriptions 38
KEY function variables 37
list of SROM functions 37
ProtectBlock function 40
ReadBlock function 39
register definitions 42
return code feature 38
SWBootReset function 38
TableRead function 41
WriteBlock function 40
SWBootReset function in SROM 38
switch operation in digital clocks 90
system resets
architecture 107
external reset 110
functional details 112
pin behavior 107
power modes 112
power on reset 110
register definitions 108
timing diagrams 110
watchdog timer reset 110
system resources
architecture 87
overview 14, 87
register summary 88
215
[+] Feedback
Index
T
TableRead function in SROM 41
TC bits 192
technical support 16
Timer IO bits
in INT_CLR0 register 171
in INT_MSK0 register 172
timing diagrams
CapSense module 79
I2C slave 101
sleep and watchdog 64
SPI 121
system resets 110
Transmit bit 168
Trim bits in IMO_TR register 190
trimming the IMO 57
TX Reg Empty bit 142
U
units of measure 17
upgrades 16
V
V bits 192
V Monitor bit
in INT_CLR0 register 171
in INT_MSK0 register 172
VLT_CMP register 114, 189
VLT_CR register 113, 188
VM bits 188
W
watchdog timer reset 110
WDRS bit 179
WDSL_Clear bits 175
WriteAndVerify function in SROM 42
WriteBlock function in SROM 40
X
XIO bit 176
XRES reset 110
Z
Zero bit 176
216
Spec. # 001-13033 Rev. *A, February 19, 2008
[+] Feedback